TECHNICAL BULLETIN
    EVALUATION OF SLUDGE
    MANAGEMENT  SYSTEMS
        EVALUATION CHECKLIST
    AND SUPPORTING  COMMENTARY
         U.I ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY
           Office of Water Program Operations
             Washington, DUC. 20460
                                 MCD-61

-------
                                                October  1979
     EVALUATION OF SLUDGE MANAGEMENT  SYSTEMS

 Evaluation Checklist and Supporting  Commentary
                       by

                 Gordon L. Gulp
                Justine A. Faisst
               Daniel J. Hinrichs
                 Bruce R. Winsor

                Culp/Wesner/Culp
              Consulting Engineers
        El Dorado Hills, California 95630
             Contract No. 68-01-4833
                Project Officers
                Sherwood C. Reed
               Corps of Engineers
Cold Regions Research and Engineering Laboratory
          Hanover, New Hampshire 03755

                Robert K.  Bastian
       Office of Water Programs Operations
             Washington, D.C. 20460
       OFFICE OF WATER PROGRAMS OPERATIONS
      U.S.  ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY
             WASHINGTON, D.C. 20460
                                                        MCD-61

-------
                                    DISCLAIMER
This report  has  been reviewed  by  the Office  of  Water Programs  Operations,  U.S.
Environmental Protection  Agency,  and approved for publication.  Approval  does not
signify that the contents  necessarily reflect the views and  policies  of  the U.S.
Environmental Protection  Agency,  nor  does mention  of  trade names  or  commercial
products constitute endorsement or  recommendation for use.

-------
                                TABLE  OF  CONTENTS

                                                                             Page

Figures
Tables
     Introduction                                                              1
          Purpose                                                              1
          Report Organization                                                  1
          Use                                                                  1
          Scope                                                                2
     I.   Facility Planning
          Introduction                                                         5
          Checklist                                                            7
               A.   Project Objectives                                         7
               B.   Characteristics  of  Sludge                                  7
               C.   Existing Facilities                                        7
               D.   Environmental Considerations                               7
               E.   Sludge Transport                                           7
               F.   Land Application                                           8
               G.   Landfill                                                   9
               H.   Combustion                                                10
               I.   Sludge For Off-Site Use  by  Others                         11
               J.   Cost-Effectiveness  Analysis                               12
               K.   Reliability                                               14
               L.   Energy Analysis                                           .1-i
               M.   Environmental Assessment                                  1^
               N.   Implementation Program                                    15
          Supporting Commentary                                               17
               A.   Project Objectives                                        17
               B.   Characteristics  of  Sludge                                 13
               C.   Existing Facilities                                       27
               D.   Environmental Considerations                              27
               E.   Sludge Transport                                          30
               F.   Land Application                                          36
               G.   Landfill                                                  52
               H.   Combustion                                                59
               I.   Sludge For Off-Site Use by  Others                         76
               J.   Cost-Effectiveness  Analysis                               87
               K.   Reliability                                               9r
               L.   Energy Analysis                                           93
               M.   Environmental Assessment                                  9-
               N.   Implementation Program                                    99
    II.   Design and Specifications
          Introduction                                                       103
          Checklist                                                          105
               A.   Agreement With Facilities Plan                           105
               B.   Sludge Transport                                         105
               C.   Land Application                                         105
               D.   Landfill                                                 107
               E.   Combustion                                               108
                                        iii

-------
                          TABLE OF CONTENTS  (Continued)

                                                                             Page

               F.   Sludge For Off-Site Use  by Others                        112
          Supporting Commentary
               A.   .Agreement With Facilities Plan                           115
               B.   Sludge Transport                                         115
               C.   Land Application                                         125
   III.    Operation and Maintenance Manual
          Introduction                                                       173
          Checklist                                                          175
               A.   Sludge Transport                                         175
               B.   Land Application                                         176
               C.   Landfill                                                 177
               D.   Combustion                                               178
               E.   Process for Off-Site Use  of  Sludge  By  Others             179
          Supporting Commentary                                              181
               A.   Sludge Transport                                         181
               B.   Land Application                                         186
               C.   Landfill                                                 192
               D.   Combustion                                               200
               E.   Process for Off-Site Use  of  Sludge  By  Others             205

Bibliography
Appendices
     A.    Design of Land Application Systems  For Agricultural Utilization
          of Sewage Sludge
     3.    Landfill Design
References
                                      IV

-------
                                     TABLES
Number                                                                       Page

  1     Qualitative Comparison of Municipal Sludge With
          Municipal Solid Waste                                                IS
  2     Normal Quantities of Sludge Produced by Different
          Treatment Processes                                                  29
  3     Major Components of Stabilized Sludge                                  21
  4     Typical Heat of Combustion of Sludge (Total  Dry Solids  Basis)          26
  5     Pipeline Size and Flow Rates                                           31
  6     Pipeline Sludge Pumping Characteristics                                32
  7     Pipeline Pumping Station Energy                                        32
  8     Plant Nutrient Utilization by Various Crops                            ^
  9     Suggested Total Amount of Sludge Metals Added  to
          Agricultural Land                                                    -6
 10     Typical Sludge Dewatering Performance                                  59
 11     Sludge and Site Conditions                                            134
 12     Landfill Design Criteria                                              136
 13     Landfill Equipment Performance Characteristics                        139
 14     Multiple Hearth Furnace Loading Rates                                 l^S
 15     Standard Sizes of Multiple Hearth Furnace Units                       1^5
 16     Fluidized Bed Furnace Loading Rates                                   151
 17     Typical Composting Design Criteria                                    159
 18     Composting Equipment                                                  I? 2
 19     Dry Bed Loading Rates                                                 lAi
 20     Drying Bed Design Parameters                                          i;;5
 21     Drying Lagoon Design Parameters

-------
                                      FIGURES
Number

  1     Facility  planning  decision making process                               3
  2     Basic sludge management  alternatives                                    -
  3     Heat required  to sustain combustion of sludge                          60
  4     Cross section  of a  typical multiple hearth incinerator                 62
  5     Cross section  of a  fluid bed  reactor                                   63
  6     Wet air oxidation  system schematic                                     67
  7     Impact of  excess air  on  the araount of auxiliary fuel for
          sludge  incineration                                                  69
  8     Potential  heat  recovery  from  incineration of sludge                    72
  9     Cage mill  flash dryer system                                            81
 10     Rotary kiln  dryer                                                       82
 11     Static pile  composting                                                 85
 12     Multiple  hearth furnace  area  vs.  design capacity                      144
 13     Multiple  hearth air supply vs.  design capacity                        146
 14     Multiple  hearth furnace  heatup  and standby fuel consumption  rate      147
 15     Fluidized  bed  furnace hearth  area vs. capacity                        150
 16     Typical sludge  dry  bed construction                                   163
 17     Typical multiple hearth  furnace  monitoring program                    202
                                       VI

-------
NTRODUCT1ON

-------
                                   INTRODUCTION
PURPOSE

Evaluation  of  Sludge Management  Systems  is intended  to  be an aid  for  review  of
facility  plans,  design and specifications,  and  operation and maintenance manuals
which  deal  with sludge  management  systems.  While   this  document  is  primarily
intended  for use by  Environmental Protection Agency evaluators,  it  is anticipated
that it will also be  of  use  to  public officials, planners, and engineers.

The checklists  and accompanying commentary included are  to be used  by the evalua-
tor to  check the completeness  of  the  work being reviewed.  Data  included are  for
illustrative purposes  to  aid in assessing the  reasonableness of  a plan or design.
This document  is not  a  design manual and should not  be  used  as  such.  In  the
reference  section of  this  document  and  throughout  the  text  are  listed  many
sources of  additional  information on  the selection and  design  of sludge manage-
ment  systems  which   should  be   consulted when  more  information  is  needed.
Specifically,  the reader  is  referred to  the  latest   edition  of  the  EPA Process
Design Manual for Sludge  Treatment and Disposal.

REPORT ORGANIZATION

This report  is  divided into three parts:  Facility Planning  (Part  I),  Design  and
Specifications  (Part  II) and Operation and Maintenance  Manuals  (Part  III).  This
reflects  the normal  sequence in the planning and  design  of municipal facilities.
Each part  is independent of  the  others.  It is  only  necessary to  use  those  por-
tions relevant to the  project under  review.

USE

When reviewing a plan  or  design the  evaluator  should  mark off items on the check-
list as he comes  across  them. Items  can be marked  off  for  both  presence  and  fea-
sibility  as  determined by the  supporting commentary   and  referenced naterial.   It
is not  the  intent of  this report  to  limit  alternatives  to  those discussed.  If a
process is  not  included in  the checklist,  it  does not  mean it  is  unacceptable.
Conversely,  there will  be items so obviously inapplicable  to  the specific situa-
tion that no mention need  be made  in  planning  or design.

Under the authority  of the Resource  Conservation and Recovery  Act  (P.L.  94-580)
(2) the EPA is   currently  preparing  proposed guidelines  for the utilization and
disposal  of  sewage sludge.  The  requirements of  these guidelines will  affect  the
selection, design and  evaluation  of  all  the sludge management  systems  discussed
herein. When available,   these  guidelines  should  be  consulted by  the  evaluator,
planner,  designer or  operation   and  maintenance  manual  author  in  using  this
publication. The information contained herein  should  be  interpreted  in  light  of
the proposed and final guidelines.

It should be kept in mind by  the  evaluator  that  facility  planning and design  of a
sludge  management system are  not  conducted  as  straight  line  procedures,  but

-------
instead  involve  several  interlocking  sets   of  decision  loops,  each  of  which
affects  others.  Figure  1  is  a flowchart  which  illustrates  the decision-making
process.

At all  times  during  the  facility planning,  design and specifications preparation,
and operations and maintenance manual preparation stages  it  must be kept in mind
that the sludge  management  system is a  part  of  the  overall wastewater management
system.

SCOPE

V.'ith very few exceptions,  alternatives  for  sewage sludge management result  in the
ultimate disposal  of the  sludge in or  on  the land.  Dumping of  sludge  in large
bodies  of  water, especially  ocean dumping,  is  currently  practiced but  national
environmental policy  calls  for the cessation  of  water dumping in the near future.
Disposal of  sludge  by dumping  in  large bodies of water will,  therefore,  not  be
considered in this report.

Sludge management systems  consist  of  components  which perform some  combination of
the following functions:

          Thickening
          Digestion
          Disinfection
          Conditioning
          Dewatering
          Combustion
          Drying
          Composting
          Land application
          Landfilling
          Off-site use
          Storage
          Transportation

Figure  2 illustrates  the most  common  combinations  of these  elements.  There are,
of course,  many  other possible  combinations which may be applicable in a specific
situation,  but the vast  majority of plants will  fit  into one of  the  patterns  in
Figure  2. Sludge transport  and storage  can occur at  any point  in  the  system and
are not shown. Sludge management systems are  generally divided into sludge treat-
ment and sludge  disposal stages. Sludge  treatment  includes thickening,  digestion,
disinfection, conditioning  and dewatering.  Sludge disposal includes off-site  use
by others,  landfill, and  land application.  Combustion,  composting, and drying,
are generally considered  to  be disposal  processes  although they  are,  strictly
speaking, treatment  processes.  This publication deals with evaluating  the selec-
tion and design  of the  disposal method, and  those processes  generally considered
to be disposal methods; and sludge transport.  It  does not discuss in detail eval-
uating  the  selection and  design  of  sludge treatment processes, except  as they
relate  directly  to the selection of the disposal method.  This report  is  aimed  at
evaluating facility  plans,  designs and  specifications,  and operation  and mainte-
nance manuals for raedium-to-large  sludge management  systems.  The evaluator should
use discretion in applying  the  checklists included herein to  smaller systems.

-------
Definition of Project
    Objectives
Evaluation of Sludge
   Characteristics
Evaluation of Existing
      Facilities
Evaluation of Environ-
mental  Factors
Selection of Technically
Feasible Alternatives
Cost—Effectiveness
   Analysis
Feasibility Assessment
Reliability Assessment
Energy - Effectiveness
     Analysis
         I
Environmental Impact
    Assessment
         I
Selection of Sludge
Management System
Design of Implementation
       Program
Design and Specification
      Stage
           Not suited to
           Project Objectives
                               No Feasible
                               Alternatives
Figure  1.    Facility planning decision
               making  process.

-------
SLUDGE

1
X
-<
1 	 ^

COMBUS-
TION
fc/
*"\
                                                                                  •o
                                                                                   6
                                                                       SCOPE OF THIS
                                                                       PUBLICATION
                                 Figure 2.  Basic sludqe management  alternatives.

-------
   PART !

 FACILITY
PLANNING

-------
                                 FACILITY PLANNING

                                   INTRODUCTION
The sludge management  plan  recommended in the facility  plan  must be the apparent
best  alternative derived  from detailed  evaluation of  the  technically feasible
alternatives. Factors  to  be considered and  weighed against  each other in deter-
mining the best  alternative  are:

          Cost-effectiveness
          Energy-effectiveness
          Reliability
          Flexibility
          Environmental impacts

Part  1 emphasizes  the  careful preparation of  a facility  plan  for sludge manage-
ment  and a thorough  evaluation of  that plan. It must  be used in conjunction with
Guidance for  Preparing a Facility  Plan (3). The  facility plan  should reflect a
careful analysis of  the merits of  the technically feasible  alternatives as well
as  the necessary tradeoffs  among  the  goals  of  cost-effectiveness,  energy-effec-
tiveness, high  reliability,  high  flexibility and environmental acceptability.  The
facility plan should  present  the final  system selection in definitive  form so
that  design plans and  specifications may  easily follow.

It  is not  the  intent  of  this document  to  favor one  management  approach over
another, as each system will  have  a  combination of characteristics and criteria
which  are  unique  to  that  system. Certain  specific  sludge management systems,
cyclonic incinerators  for  example, are not  discussed  in detail primarily because
they  are  not in common use for  sewage sludge  management in the United States.
Where such systems appear  to have merit for the  specific situation  under consid-
erations,  the  facility planner  and  evaluator  should  explore  them  in greater
detail.

The decision-making  process involved  in  the preparation  of  a  facility plan does
not readily  lend itself to  evaluation by rigid  adherence to a  checklist  due to
the many interlocking  relationships among the  decisions  to  be  made.  This check-
list  can be  of value, however,  if  the  user  recognizes  the  complexity  of  the
interrelationships among  the steps  in  the decision-making process.  It  should also
be  recognized by the evaluator that certain alternatives  can frequently be  elim-
inated  from  consideration  without detailed engineering  analysis  due  to   their
obvious inapplicability to  the case at hand. An example would be consideration of
sludge transport by  barge where no  navigable waterways exist. This  obviously does
not merit evaluation and need  not  be  considered.

There are 14  major categories  in  the Facility  Plan Checklist:

      A.   Project Objectives
      B.   Characteristics of Sludge
      C.   Existing Facilities
      D.   Environmental Considerations
      E.   Sludge Transport

-------
     F.   Land Application
     G.   Landfill
     H.   Combustion
     I.   Off-Site Use of Sludge  by  Others
     J.   Cost-Effectiveness Analysis
     K.   Reliability
     L.   Energy Analysis
     M.   Environmental Assessment
     N.   Implementation Program

Within  each  category  are  numerous  sub-elements.  All  of  the  major  categories
should usually be  included  to  insure selection of  the  most  feasible alternative.
It  is  not  necessary  that all  the  sub-elements  be  included.   Sufficient  detail
should be  provided to  support  the  rejection of unfeasible alternatives  and  to
insure that all critical factors  in  the  proposed  method were considered.

-------
                                FACILITY PLANNING
                                    CHECKLIST

A.  PROJECT OBJECTIVES
    1.  ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION
    2.  SLUDGE UTILIZATION
    3.  SLUDGE DISPOSAL
    4.  CO-DISPOSAL WITH  SOLID  WASTE

B.  CHARACTERISTICS OF SLUDGE
    1.  QUANTITY, PRESENT AND PROJECTED
        a.  Present, Projected, and Peak Flows
        b.  Sludge Concentration
        c.  Present, Projected, and Peak Solids
    2.  ANALYSIS, PRESENT AND PROJECTED
        a.  Physical Characteristics
        b.  Organic Matter  (VS, BOD,  COD,  TOG)
        c.  Nutrients (Nitrogen,  Phosphorus,  Potassium)
        d.  Sulfur
        e.  Inorganic Ions, Heavy Metals
        f.  Pathogen Content
        g.  Heat Content
        h.  pH
        i.  Toxic Organic Compounds
    3.  INDUSTRIAL CONTRIBUTIONS

C.  EXISTING FACILITIES
    1.  THICKENING
    2.  DEWATERING
    3.  STORAGE
    4.  STABILIZATION
    5.  COMBUSTION
    6.  TRANSPORT
    7.  DISPOSAL

D.  ENVIRONMENTAL CONSIDERATIONS
    1.  CLIMATE
        a.  Precipitation Analysis
        b.  Evapo-transpiration Potential
        c.  Temperature Analysis
        d.  Wind Analysis
    2.  LAND CHARACTERISTICS
        a.  Topography
        b.  Soils
        c.  Geology
        d.  Groundwater
        e.  Surface Water

E.  SLUDGE TRANSPORT
    1.  PIPELINE
        a.  Route
        b.  Size and Material

-------
        c.  Pumping Requirements
    2.  TRUCK
        a.  Route and Travel Time
        b.  Size and Number of Trucks
        c.  Fuel Requirements
        d.  Manpower Requirements
        e.  Loading, Unloading, and Vehicle  Service  Facilities
    3.  BARGE
        a.  Route and Travel Time
        b.  Size and Number of Barges
        c.  Fuel Requirements
        d.  Manpower Requirements
        e.  Loading, Unloading, and Vehicle  Service  Facilities
        f.  Tow Tariffs
    4.  RAILROAD
        a.  Route and Travel Time
        b.  Size and Number of Cars
        c.  Fuel Requirements
        d.  Manpower Requirements
        e.  Loading, Unloading, and Service  Facilities
        f.  Tariffs

F.  LAND APPLICATION
    1.  PURPOSE
        a.  Dedicated Disposal
        b.  Agricultural Utilization
        c.  Reclamation of Disturbed or Marginal Lands
        d.  Combinations
    2.  EVALUATION OF POTENTIAL SITES
        a.  Geographical Location
            (Proximity to surface and groundwaters,  distance
            from treatment plant, proximity  to  transportation)
        b.  Compatibility with Land Use Plans
            (Current and proposed future  use, zoning and  adjacent  land
            use, proximity to current or  proposed  developed areas,
            room for future expansion)
        c.  Method of Land Acquisition
            (Purchase, Lease, Purchase w/lease  back,  Contract
            w/user, Combination aquisition-lease)
    3.  STABILIZATION PROCESS
        a.  Anaerobic Digestion
        b.  Aerobic Digestion
        c.  Heat Treatment
        d.  Chemical Stabilization
    4.  AGRICULTURAL MANAGEMENT PLAN
        a.  Crops to be Grown, Rotation Plan and Markets
        b.  Farming by Municipal Agency or Contract
        c.  Long Range Plan
    5.  NUTRIENT BALANCE
        a.  Nitrogen
            (1) Forms of Nitrogen in the  Sludge
            (2) Mineralization Rate of Organic  Nitrogen

                                       8

-------
             (3)  Future Application  Rate  Adjustments  for
                 Mineralized  Organic Nitrogen
             (4)  Additional Nitrogen Needed  for  Crop  (if any)
        b.   Phosphorus
        c.   Potassium
    6.  HEAVY METAL LOADINGS
        a.   Cation Exchange  Capacity
        b.   Sludge and Soil  pH
        c.   Cadmium
             Annual rate and  total projected accumulation (Ibs/acre)
        d.   Nickel
             Annual rate and  total projected accumulation (Ibs/acre)
        e.   Copper
             Annual rate and  total projected accumulation (Ibs/acre)
        f.   Molybdenum
             Annual rate and  total projected accumulation (Ibs/acre)
        g.   Zinc
             Annual rate and  total projected accumulation (Ibs/acre)
        h.   Lead
             Annual rate and  total projected accumulation (Ibs/acre)
    7.  SLUDGE APPLICATION RATES
        (Maximum annual rate  tons per acre wet  or  dry,  limiting
        factors, variations for crops, daily maximums)
    8.  SITE CONSIDERATIONS
        a.   Site Size
             (1)  Application Area
             (2)  Wet Weather Plan for Stockpile  Storage  or
                 Alternative Disposal
             (3)  Buffer Area
             (4)  Expansion or  Replacement Area
        b.   Compatiblity with Future Expansion
             (Future process changes, changes in  constituent  levels,
             capacity increases.)
    9.  RUNOFF CONTROL
        (Containment,  recycle, or disposal)
   10.  STORAGE  (Days of storage at  design sludge  production  rate)
        a.   Capacity
        b.   Odor Control (Prior stabilization, mixing and/or
             aeration)
        c.   Drainage or Leachate Control
   11.  MONITORING PROGRAM
        a.  Monitoring Wells  and Tests (Type and frequency)
        b.   Soil Tests (Type and frequency)
        c.   Sludge Tests (Type and  frequency)
        d.   Crop Tissue Analysis

G.   LANDFILL
    1.  METHOD
        a.   Sludge Only Trench Fill
             (1) Narrow Trench
             (2) Wide Trench

-------
        b.  Sludge Only  Area  Fill
            (1) Mound
            (2) Layer
            (3) Diked Containment
        c.  Co-disposal  With  Refuse
            (1) Sludge refuse mixture
            (2) Sludge soil mixture
    2.  SITE SELECTION
        a.  Identify Potential Sites
        b.  Public Participation Program
        c.  Technical Considerations
            (1) Haul Distance
            (2) Site Life and Size
            (3) Topography
            (4) Surface  and Groundwater
            (5) Soils and Geology
            (6) Vegetation
            (7) Environmentally Sensitive  Areas
            (8) Archaeological and Historical  Significance
            (9) Site Access
           (10) Land Use
    3.  LEACHATE CONTROLS
        a.  Adequate Surface Drainage
        b.  Natural Attenuation
        c.  Containment
            (Soil or membrane liner, leachate  collection
            and treatment)
    4.  GAS CONTROL
        (Permeable or impermeable methods  and/or extraction)
    5.  RUNOFF CONTROL
    6.  MONITORING

H.  COMBUSTION
    1.  METHOD
        a.  Incineration
            (1) Multiple Hearth
            (2) Fluidized Bed
            (3) Cyclonic Reactors, and Electric Incinerators
        b.  Pyrolysis
        c.  Wet Air Oxidation
        d.  Co-disposal with Solid Waste
            (1) Total Co-disposal
            (2) Refuse Derived Fuel
    2.  MASS BALANCE
        a.  Inputs
            (1) Dry Solids and Moisture in Sludge
            (2) Air Required for Combustion
            (3) Other Factors
                (auxiliary fuel, makeup sand,  steam)
        b.  Outputs
            (Ash,  combustible gas, tar, char,  water, C02> CO,
            N,  sand,  excess air)

                                       10

-------
    3.  ENERGY BALANCE
        a.  Inputs
            (Solids heat of combustion,  auxiliary  fuel  heat  of  com-
            bustion including afterburner)
        b.  Outputs
            (Latent heat of free noisture and moisture  of  combustion.
            Sensible heat of gases of combustion,  excess  air,  and mois-
            ture. Sensible heat of ash,  radiation  and  conduction,  sen-
            sible heat of shaft cooling  air and  recovered  energy.)
    4.  USE OF RECOVERED ENERGY
        a.  On-site Use
            (Combustion air preheating,  space conditioning,  sludge
            thermal conditioning, sludge digester  heating,  steam tur-
            bines, gas turbines, pyrolysis reactor  heating.)
        b.  Off-site use
            (Combustible gas, tar (oil), char, steam,  electricity.)
    5.  ASH DISPOSAL
        a.  Transport
        b.  Dewatering
        c.  Land Application
        d.  Landfill
        e.  Off-site Use By Others
    6.  AIR QUALITY CONTROL
        (Scrubbers, afterburners, electrostatic  precipitators.)
    7.  FUELS
        (Gas, oil, refuse derived fuel,  powdered coal.)

I.   SLUDGE FOR OFF-SITE USE BY OTHERS
    1.  MARKET ANALYSIS
        a.  Intended market
            (1) Governmental Agencies
                (Highway departments, municipal  parks,  golf  courses,
                and stadiums, forestry departments.)
            (2) Wholesalers or processors
            (3) Private users
                (Golf courses and stadiums, nurseries,  agriculture,
                individuals. )
        b.  Capacity of Market to Absorb Product
        c.  Market Value of Product
        d.  Packaging Requirement
    2.  PROCESSING METHOD
        a.  Drying
            (1) Drying beds
            (2) Drying lagoons
            (3) Heat drying
                (a) Flash drying
                (b) Rotary kiln drying
        b.  Composting
            (1) Windrow
            (2) Static Pile
                                       11

-------
            (3) Mechanical System
        c.  Co-disposal with Solid Waste
            (1) Refuse as Bulking Agent
            (2) Sludge as Nutrient and Moisture Source
        d.  Nutrient Enrichment Considered
    3.  PACKAGING AND DELIVERY
        (Pick up by user, bulk delivery to user, bagged)

J.  COST-EFFECTIVENESS ANALYSIS
    1.  GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS
        a.  Planning Period
        b.  Discount Rate
        c.  Construction or Other Cost Indices
        d.  Service Lives of Facility and Equipment
        e.  Capital Costs and Credits
        f.  Fixed Annual Costs
        g.  Variable Annual Costs and Credits
    2.  SLUDGE TREATMENT
        a.  Capital Costs
            (1) Land Acquisition
            (2) Facility Construction
            (3) Filtrate, Centrate, or Supernatant Treatment
                Facilities
            (4) Impact of Chemical Addition on Other Treatment Process
        b.  Fixed annual costs
            (1) Labor
            (2) Maintenance
            (3) Monitoring
            (4) Supplies
        c.  Variable Annual Costs and Credits
            (1) Power
            (2) Auxiliary Fuel
            (3) Chemicals
            (4) Filtrate, Centrate, or Supernatant Treatment
            (5) Impact of Chemical Addition on Other
                Treatment Processes
            (6) Value of Recovered Digester Gas
    3.  SLUDGE TRANSPORT
        a.  Capital Costs
            (1) Right-of-way Acquisition
            (2) Vehicle Purchase
            (3) Pipeline Construction
            (4) Facilities Construction
        b.  Fixed Annual Costs
            (1) Labor
            (2) Maintenance
            (3) Vehicle Leasing
            (4) Supplies
        c.  Variable Annual Costs
            (1) Pumping Energy
            (2) Vehicle Fuel
            (3) Contract Haul Costs

                                       12

-------
LAND APPLICATION
a.  Capital Costs
    (1) Land Acquisition
    (2) Equipment Purchase
    (3) Site Preparation
    (4) Facilities Construction
    (5) Value of Reclaimed Land
b.  Fixed Annual Costs
    (1) Land Leasing
    (2) Labor
    (3) Maintenance
    (4) Equipment Leasing
    (5) Monitoring
    (6) Supplies
c.  Variable Annual Cost or Credit
    (1) Equipment Fuel
    (2) Supplemental Fertilizer
    (3) Credit for Sale or Cost for Disposal of Crop
LANDFILL
a.  Capital Costs or Credits
    (1) Land Acquisition
    (2) Equipment Purchase
    (3) Site Preparation
    (4) Facilities Construction
    (5) Runoff and Leachate Treatment Facilities
    (6) Value of Reclaimed Land
b.  Fixed Annual Costs
    (1) Land Leasing
    (2) Labor
    (3) Maintenance
    (4) Equipment Leasing
    (5) Runoff Treatment
    (6) Monitoring
    (7) Supplies
c.  Variable Annual Costs or Credits
    (1) Equipment Fuel
    (2) Leachate Treatment
    (3) Value of Collected Gas
COMBUSTION
a.  Capital Costs
    (1) Reduction Facility Construction
    (2) Scrubber Effluent Treatment Facilities
    (3) Liquor Treatment Facilities
    (4) Ash Disposal Facilities
b.  Fixed Annual Costs
    (1) Labor
    (2) Maintenance
    (3) Monitoring
    (4) Supplies
c.  Variable Annual Costs or Credits
    (1) Auxiliary Fuel
    (2) Power

                               13

-------
             (3) Ash Handling  and  Disposal
             (4) Value of Residues
                (a) Gas
                (b) Tar
                (c) Char
                (d) Ash
             (5) Value of Energy Recovered
             (6) Scrubber Effluent  Treatment
             (7) WAO Liquor Treatment
    7.  SLUDGE FOR OFF-SITE USES  BY OTHERS
        a.   Capital Costs
             (1) Land Acquisition
             (2) Equipment Purchase
             (3) Facility Construction
        b.   Fixed Annual Costs
             (1) Labor
             (2) Maintenance
             (3) Monitoring
             (4) Supplies
        c.   Variable Annual Cost  or Credit
             (1) Equipment Fuel
             (2) Power
             (3) Packaging
             (4) Bulking Agent
             (5) Value of Product

K.  RELIABILITY
    1.  MECHANICAL DOWNTIME
        a.   Standby Power Supply
        b.   Standby Fuel Supply
        c.   Storage
        d.   Duplicate Equipment
        e.   Backup Equipment
             (1) At Site
             (2) At Other Sites
             (3) Leaseable
        f.   Alternative Management Techniques
    2.  AVAILABILITY OF NEEDED RESOURCES
        a.   Electric Power
        b.   Fuel
        c.   Chemicals
        d.  Manpower
        e.  Replacement Parts
    3.  FACTORS OF SAFETY

L.  ENERGY ANALYSIS

M.  ENVIRONMENTAL ASSESSMENT
    1.  ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACTS
        a.   Soil and Vegetation
        b.   Groundwater
        c.   Surface Water
                                       14

-------
        d.  Animal and Insect Life
        e.  Air Quality
        f.  Climate
    2.  PUBLIC HEALTH IMPACTS
        a.  Disease Vectors
        b.  Soil and Vegetation
        c.  Groundwater Quality
        d.  Surface Water Quality
        e.  Air Quality
    3.  SOCIAL IMPACTS
        a.  Relocation of Residents
        b.  Greenbelts and Open  Spaces
        c.  Recreational Activity
        d.  Community Growth
        e.  Noise and Odor
    4.  ECONOMIC IMPACT
        a.  Property Values
        b.  Overall Local Economy
        c.  Taxation
        d.  Conservation of Resources and Energy

N.  IMPLEMENTATION PROGRAM
    1.  PUBLIC PARTICIPATION PROGRAM
        a.  Planning Stage
        b.  Design Stage
        c.  Construction Stage
        d.  Operational Stage
    2.  POTENTIAL ROADBLOCKS
    3.  LAND ACQUISITION PROGRAM
        a.  Purchase
        b.  Lease
        c.  Condemnation
        d.  Land Dedication
    4.  IMPLEMENTATION SCHEDULE
        a.  Facility Plan Approval
        b.  Land Acquisition
        c.  Design
        d.  Design Approval
        e.  Construction
        f.  Operation
    5.  STAFFING PLAN
        a.  Operations
        b.  Maintenance
        c.  Supervisory
        d.  Laboratory
        e.  Administrative
    6.  COMPATIBILITY WITH REGULATIONS
        a.  Zoning and Land Use
        b.  Solid Waste Disposal
        c.  Air Pollution Control
        d.  Water Pollution Control
        e.  Public Health

                                        15

-------
                                FACILITY PLANNING
                              SUPPORTING COMMENTARY


Section A - PROJECT OBJECTIVES

The  basic  project goal is  to provide  for  sludge  management  in  a cost-effective
and  environmentally acceptable manner.  In order  to  accomplish this  goal, the
specific  objectives  and goals  of the  sludge  management  system must  be clearly
defined in  the  facility plan.  The  successful  implementation  of  the  plan depends
primarily on  the  formulation  and appropriateness of these goals. It is  imperative
that the  goals  relative to sludge  reuse  and co-disposal with solid  waste estab-
lished in the initial  phase  of facility  planning be  re-evaluated  throughout the
planning process.


A.I.  ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION

The  facility  plan should  establish goals  for  the environmentally  sound manage-
ment of sludge. These  goals should  take into account  the following factors,  which
are discussed in  greater detail in  the  appropriate sections of this document.

    •    Groundwater protection
    •    Surface  water protection
    •    Air  quality protection
    •    Land protection


A.2.  SLUDGE  UTILIZATION

The  facility  plan must  establish goals  for utilization  or  disposal  of sludge.
In many, but  not  all instances, consideration of  the  sludge as a resource rather
than as a material to  be  disposed  of  can  result  in  a more cost-effective  solu-
tion  to  the  sludge  management  problem.  Among  the  utilization  operations  which
have been proposed or  implemented are:

         Use  of sludge as  a soil conditioner or fertilizer
         Use  of sludge as  fill  material for land reclamation
         Use  of sludge as  an  energy source
         Use  of sludge (ash)  as a concrete  or  asphalt additive
         Use  of sludge as  a raw material  for manufacture of activated carbon


A.3.  SLUDGE  DISPOSAL

Where  sludge  utilization  is  not  feasible,  sludge  disposal  must be   practiced.
Sludge  disposal  alternatives  include  landfill and  lagoon  operations  and  land
application of  sludge  to a dedicated site.  Incinerator ash  is most often disposed
of rather than  utilized.


                                                 Environmental Protection  Agency
                                                 Library                Room 2404
                                        17       401 M Street,  SW, WSM  PM-213
                                                 WfMbtegton, D.C.

-------
A.4.  CO-DISPOSAL WITH SOLID WASTE

Consideration  should  be  given  (4)  to  co-disposal of  sludge  with  solid  wastes.
This  may  result  in  significant  improvements  in  the  cost-effectiveness  of  dis-
posal of both materials. In considering co-disposal alternatives, it is important
to remember the differences as  well as the similarities  between  sludge and solid
waste. These differences are summarized in Table 1.

TABLE 1. QUALITATIVE COMPARISON OF  MUNICIPAL SLUDGE WITH MUNICIPAL SOLID WASTE

    Property	Comparison	

Volume                     The per  capita  volume of solid waste is much greater
                           than sludge  (typically 5.72 Ib/cap/day vs 0.14
                           Ib/cap/day)  (5,  6).

Moisture content           The moisture content  of sludge is  typically higher
                           than that  of solid  waste.

Heat content               Solid  waste  has  a higher heat content  than sludge

Homogeneity                Sludge is  much  more homogeneous than solid waste.

Nutrient content           Sludge has  a higher concentration  of the nutrients
                           required for biological growth than solid waste.
These differences present  opportunities  for improving disposal cost-effectiveness
as  well as  problems  involved  in  combining the  materials.   Typical  co-disposal
techniques include:

          Co-incineration  or  co-pyrolysis
          Co-disposal  by landfill
          Use of refuse as an auxiliary  fuel in sludge incineration
          Use of refuse as a  bulking  agent  in sludge  composting
          Use  of  sludge  as  a  moisture   and  nutrient  source  in  solid  waste
          composting
     •    Use of sludge as a  soil  conditioner for  solid waste landfill cover


Section B - CHARACTERISTICS OF SLUDGE

An  evaluation of  the  characteristics  of   the  sludge  is  an  essential  step  in
selecting sludge management  alternatives,  and may provide  a  basis  of  preliminary
screening of methods.  The  best  available data should  be  used  in  establishing the
sludge  characteristics. Actual  flow data and laboratory  analyses  are  always pre-
ferrable,  but it  is  often  necessary  to  estimate  sludge  characteristics  based
                                        18

-------
on  typical  values  or  on  the  experiences  of  similar  treatment  plants.  This  is
always true in the  case  of a new  or  upgraded wastewater treatment facility.


B.I.  QUANTITY, PRESENT  AND PROJECTED

A detailed analysis of the future sludge flow is required  on  both  liquid and dry
solids  basis. The  analysis  should  include  data  or  estimates  describing  the
following:

     •    Initial sludge flow, concentration and dry solids production
     •    Future sludge  flow, concentration and  dry  solids  production
     •    Seasonal  variations in  sludge  flow,  concentration and dry solids
          production

Future  sludge quantities  should  be  estimated   from  population  and  industrial
growth  projections.  Consideration  should  also  be  given  to  planned  process
modifications that  will  affect sludge  production.

It is generally possible to control  short-term peaks in sludge and  solids produc-
tion  by  storage  within  wastewater and  sludge  treatment  process units,  reducing
their effect  on  the sludge management system.  Consideration  should  be  given  to
peaks which are in  excess  of those which can be  successfully stored.

Table 2  is  a summary  of typical  sludge production  rates  for various  treatment
processes. The EPA  Process Design Manual for Sludge  Treatment  and Disposal (1,  7)
contains  additional   information   useful  for   estimating   sludge   production
quantities.


B.2.  ANALYSIS, PRESENT  AND PROJECTED

The  analysis  of   the  sludge  will have  as  great an  impact on  the  selection  of
sludge management techniques as  will the quantity.  Sludge  analysis  varies widely
from  plant-to-plant  due  to  such  factors  as  wastewater  treatment  processes,
industrial contributions,  water  supply  quality, and the  presence  or absence  of
storm water in the  collection system.  Table 3  summarizes  typical  chemical compon-
ents  of  sewage  sludges in 150  treatment plants   in  the northcentral  and  eastern
United States.
B.2.a.  Physical Characteristics

Because the  nature  of sludges  resulting from  the  treatment of municipal  waste-
waters varies so greatly  from one  locale to  another,  generalized statements about
their physical  characteristics  are of  limited  value. However,  some  observations
which are usually true follow.
                                        19

-------
                  TABLE 2.   NORMAL QUANTITIES OF SLUDGE PRODUCED  BY  DIFFERENT TREATMENT PROCESSESl(5)
ro
o

Normal quantity of
sludge



Gal/
million

Treatment process
Primary sedimentation:
Undigested
Digested in separate tanks
Digested and dewatered on sand beds
Digested and dewatered on vacuum filters
Trickling filter
Chemical precipitation :
Dewater on vacuum filters
Primary sedimentation and activated sludge:
Undigested
Undigested and dewatered on vacuum filters
Digested in separate tanks
Digested and dewatered on sand beds
Digested and dewatered on vacuum filters
Activated sludge:
Wet sludge
Dewatered on vacuum filters
Dried by heat dryers
Septic tanks, digested
Imhoff tanks, digested
gal
of
sewage

2
1



5


6
1
2



19





,950
,450
-
-
745
,120
-

,900
,480
,700
-
-

,400
-
-
900
500


Tons/
million
gal
of
sewage

12.
6.
0.
1.
3.
22.
6.

29.
5.
11.
1.
3.

75.
5.
1.
-
—

5
25
94
36
17
0
0

25
85
67
75
5

0
62
17



Cu

ft/
1,000
persons


Mois-
ture,
daily %

39
19
5
4
9
68
19

92
20
36
18
11

258
19
3
12
6

.0
.0
.7
.3
.9
.5
.3

.0
.0
.0
.0
.7

.0
.0
.0
.0
.7

95
94
60
72.5
92.5
92.5
72.5

96
80
94
60
80

98.5
80
4
90
85
Specific
gravity
of
sludge
solids

1.40
-
-
-
1.33
1.93
-

-
-
-
-
-

1.25
-
-
1.40
1.27

Specific
gravity
of
sludge

1.02
1.03
-
1.00
1.025
1.03
-

1.02
0.95
1.03
-
0.95

1.005
0.95
1.25
1.04
1.04
Dry solids

Lb/
million
gal of
sewage

1,250
750
750
750
476
3,300
3,300

2,340
2,340
1,400
1,400
1,400

2,250
2,250
2,250
810
690

Lb/
1,000
persons
daily

125
75
75
75
48
330
330

234
234
140
140
140

225
225
225
81
69
-i 	 	 	 _
         Based on a sewage flow of 100 gpcd and 300 ppm, or 0.25  Ib per  capita daily,  of suspended solids  in

         sewage.

-------
               TABLE 3.  MAJOR COMPONENTS OF STABILIZED SLUDGE (8)*

Component


N03-N,
mg/1


NH4-N,
mg/1


Total N, %



Organic C,
%


Total P,
%


Total S,
%


K, %



Na, %



Ca, %



Mg, %



Sauip.
Type


Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Le
Number


35
8
3
45
67
33
3
103
85
38
68
191
31
31
60
101
86
38
65
189
19
9
—
28
86
37
69
192
73
36
67
176
87
37
69
193
87
37
65
189

RJ


2 -
7 -
—
2 -
120 -
30 -
5 -
5 -
0.5 -
0.5 -
0.1 -
0.1 -
18
27
6.5 -
6.5 -
0.5 -
1.1 -
0.1 -
0.1 -
0.8 -
0. 6 -
—
0. 6 -
0.02-
0.08-
0.02-
0.02-
0.01-
0.03-
0.01-
0.01-
1.9 -
0.6 -
0.1 -
0.1 -
0.03-
0.03-
0.03-
0.03-

inge


4,900
830
	
4,900
67,600
11,300
12,500
67 , 600
17.6
7.6
10.0
17.6
39
37
48
48
14.3
5.5
3.3
14.3
1.5
1.1
—
1.5
2.64
1.10
0.87
2.64
2.19
3.07
0.96
3.07
20.0
13.5
25.0
25.0
1.92
1.10
1.97
1.97

Median

-mg/1 -
79
180
	
140
1,600
400
80
920
%_
	
4.2
4.8
1.8
3.3
26.8
29.5
32.5
30.4
3.0
2.7
1.0
2.3
1.1
0.8
—
1.1
0.30
0.38
0.17
0.30
0.73
0.77
0.11
0.24
4.9
3.0
3.4
3.9
0.48
0.41
0.43
0.45

Mean


520
300
780
490
9,400
950
4,200
6,540
5.0
4.9
1.9
3.9
27.6
31.7
32.6
31.0
3.3
2.9
1.3
2.5
1.2
0.8
—
1. 1
0.52
0.46
0.20
0.40
0.70
1.11
0.13
0.57
5.8
3.3
4.6
4.9
0.58
0.52
0.50
0.54
(Continued)
                                       21

-------
TABLE 3.  (Continued)

Component

Ba, %



Fe, %



Al, %





Mn, mg/kg



B, mg/kg



As, mg/kg



Co, mg/kg



Mo, mg/kg



Hg, mg/kg



Pb, mg/kg



Sample
Type

Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All


Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All

Number

27
10
23
60
96
38
31
165
73
37
23
133


81
38
24
143
62
29
18
109
3
—
7
10
4
—
9
13
9
3
17
29
35
20
23
78
98
57
34
189

Ra

0.01-
0.01-
0.01-
0.01-
0.1 -
0.1 -
0.1 -
0.1 -
0.1 -
0.1-
0.1 -
0.1 -


58 -
55 -
18 -
18 -
12 -
17 -
4 -
4 -
10 -
—
6 -
6 -
3 -
—
1 -
1 -
24 -
30 -
5 -
5 -
0.5 -
1.0
2.0 -
0.5 -
58 -
13 -
72 -
13 -

inge

0.90
0.03
0.44
0.90
15.3
4.0
4.2
15.3
13.5
2.3
2.6
13.5


7,100
1,120
1,840
7,100
760
74
700
760
230
—
18
230
18
—
11
18
30
30
39
39
10,600
22
5,300
10,600
19,730
15,000
12,400
19,700

Median
-7
0.05
0.02
0.01
0.02
1.2
1.0
0.1
1.1
0.5
0.4
0.1
0.4
t -L
- mg/Kg- —
280
340
118
260
36
33
16
33
116
	
9
10
7.0
	
4.0
4.0
30
30
30
30
5
5
3
5
540
300
620
500

Mean

0.08
0.02
0.04
0.06
1.6
1.1
0.8
1.3
1.7
0.7
0.3
1.2


400
420
250
380
97
40
69
77
119
	
11
43
8.8
	
4.3
5.3
29
30
27
28
1,100
7
810
733
1,640
720
1,630
1,360
(Continued)
                                       22

-------
TABLE 3.   (Continued)
Sample
Component
Type
Number

Range
Median
Mean

mg/kg
Zn,



Cu,



Ni,



Cd,



Cr,



mg/kg



mg/kg



mg/kg



mg/kg



mg/kg



Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
Anaerobic
Aerobic
Other
All
108
58
42
208
108
58
39
205
85
46
34
165
98
57
34
189
94
53
33
180
108
109
101
101
85
85
84
84
2
2
15
2
3
5
4
3
24
10
22
10
- 27,800
- 14,900
- 15,100
- 27,800
- 10,100
- 2,900
- 10,400
- 10,400
- 3,520
- 1,700
- 2,800
- 3,800
- 3,410
- 2,170
520
- 3,410
- 28,850
- 13,600
- 99,000
- 99,000
1,890
1,800
1,100
1,740
1,000
970
390
850
85
31
118
82
16
16
14
16
1,350
260
640
890
3,380
2,170
2,140
2,790
1,420
940
1,020
1,210
400
150
360
320
106
135
70
110
2,070
1,270
6,390
2,620
*Dissolved  substances  reported  as  weight  per  unit  volume  of  sludge  of  mg/1;
 particulates  are reported  as weight  per  unit sludge  either  as  a  percent  of
 total  solids  for major  constituents,  or  as mg  per kg  total solids  for  trace
 constituents.
Raw  primary  sludges settle,  thicken  and dewater  with relative ease  compared to
secondary  biological  sludges due  to  their  coarse, fibrous  nature.  Generally, at
least 30%  of  the  solids are  larger than  30  mesh in size.  These  coarse particles
permit rapid  formation  of  a sludge cake with sufficient structural matrix to  per-
mit  good  solids  capture  and rapid  dewatering.  Anaerobic  digestion  of  primary
sludges  frequencly  makes them more difficult to thicken and dewater. However, the
dewatering results  attainable at  relatively  low costs  are still generally good.

Activated  sludges  show  much greater variation  in  dewatering characteristics  than
do primary sludges.  These  variations may  even be substantial  from  day-to-day at
the  same plant. The sludges are much finer  than primary sludges  and  are largely
cellular organic material  with  a  density very nearly  the same  as  water.  They are
much more difficult to  dewater  than primary  sludges.
                                        23

-------
The  nature  of sludges  resulting  from chemical  coagulation of  sewage  depends on
the  nature  of the  coagulant  used.  Generally,  alum  and iron  coagulants  produce
gelatinous  floe which  is  difficult to dewater.  Lime coagulation produces a sludge
which readily  thickens  and  dewaters  in most cases.  Estimates of sludge character-
istics  from a  variety of  wastewater  processes may  be found  in  EPA's  Process
Design Manual  for Sludge  Treatment and Disposal (1).

The  physical  characteristics  of  the  sludge will affect the selection  of  sludge
treatment  processes and  ultimate disposal.  The difficulty  of  dewatering  waste
activated  sludge,  for  example, may  preclude the use  of incineration  because it
may  not  be  possible to obtain a  sludge  cake capable of  sustaining  autogenous or
economical  burning.


B.2.b.  Organic Matter  (VS, BOD,  COD,  TOG)

The  organic content of  sludge  is  expressed in terms of  its  Volatile Solids (VS),
biochemical oxygen  demand (BOD),   chemical  oxygen demand (COD),  or  total  organic
carbon (TOG).  Methods  for determining these values are  given  in Standard  Methods
(9). Another  measure  of  organic  content which  is  useful  in  the evaluation  and
design of  combustion  processes is the  theoretical  oxygen demand  (THOD).  This is
the  oxygen  required to completely oxidize  the  major constituents of  the  sludge,
based on stochioraetric  relationships.  The  organic content of sludge  affects:

     •    Biological decomposition rate
     •    Heat value
     •    Potential for odor
     •    Value as a soil conditioner


B.2.c.  Nutrients (Nitrogen, Phosphorus,  Potassium)

Nitrogen  is present in sludge in the  form of  organic  nitrogen, ammonium  ions,
nitrates and  nitrites.  The  concentrations  of all forms  are  customarily expressed
as equivalent  nitrogen; that  is,  a sludge  with an  actual nitrate  ion  concentra-
tion of  2,000 mg/kg (ppm) would  be  said to  have a concentration of 2,000  mg/kg
x 14 (molecular  weight of N)  ^ 62 (molecular  weight  of NOg)  = 452 mg/kg as N.
Nitrogen  in the nitrate  form  is   important because it  is  highly mobile and  can
contaminate groundwater at land  application and landfill  sites. Nitrogen is an
essential nutrient  for  all  forms  of  life  and,  as such,  will affect the  decomposi-
tion  rate  of  sludge,  its value  as  a fertilizer,  and  its  potential for  surface
water contamination.

Phosphorus  is  found in  sludges  in many forms,  including  the phosphate  and  ortho-
phosphate  ions. Concentrations  of phosphorus or  any  of its constituent ions  are
normally  expressed  as   phosphorus,  although they may  be expressed  as  phosphoric
acid,  ^2^5'  which  is a method sometimes  used  in  the   fertilizer   industry.
Phosphorus  is  an essential  nutrient  for  bacterial decomposition  and  for  plant
growth, and can affect  both the rate  of  sludge  decomposition and the value  of  the
sludge as  fertilizer.  Additionally,  the nutrient value  of  the  phosphorus  affects
the  potential  for  surface  water  pollution  from  sludge disposal  or utilization.
Excess phosphorus applications  can result  in phytotoxicity  in  some plants.

                                        24

-------
The  potassium concentration  is  often  expressed in  terms  of  potash  1^0  rather
than  potassium  as  that  is a  method often  used by  the  fertilizer  industry for
expressing potassium  concentrations. Potassium  is a  vital  plant  nutrient,  but is
rarely found  in commercially  usable  concentrations  in sludge.
B.2.d.  Sulfur

Sulfur  is present  in  sludge  in  the  form  of  sulfates  and  sulfides,  usually
expressed  as  sulfur.  Sulfur  is of  importance  because of  its  role  in anaerobic
decomposition of  sludge and  in  the  production of  odors  (hydrogen  sulfide).   An
additional problem  associated with  sulfur  is  the possible  formation of sulfuric
acid and  resultant  corrosion. If  combustion  of sludges with high sulfur content
is  contemplated,  the  possibility of  sulfur  dioxide  production  should  also  be
explored.


B.2.e.  Inorganic Ions, Heavy Metals

Inorganic  ion concentrations  are significant because  of  their  potential for air,
land, and  water pollution  and their  potentially  toxic  effect on  plants, animals,
and humans. Not to be neglected,  however,  is the fact  that  most  of  the inorganic
ions which may be toxic in high concentrations are  also  essential micronutrients
required by plants and  animals.

Among the  possible deleterious  effects  of  inorganic  ions  are:

     •     Increases in  soil,  groundwater,  and  surface water salinity.
     •     Toxic effects on  crops from high  concentrations of such heavy metals as
           zinc,  boron,  copper,  and nickel.
     •     Toxic effects on  humans  and animals  due to excess plant uptake of such
           heavy metals  as cadmium, molybdenum,  and  zinc.
     •    Air pollution from  volatilization of  lead  and mercury in combustion
           processes.
     •     Groundwater pollution  by leaching of  heavy metals from sludge.


B.2.f.  Pathogen Content

Pathogen  content  measured  by  the  fecal  coliform,   salmonella,  and ascaris  egg
tests,  is  normally quite  low  in  well   stabilized   sludges.  Pathogen  content  of
sludge  is  of  particular concern in any  sludge management  alternative involving
food chain crops, use of a  sludge  product by the public,  or potential  contamina-
tion of ground or surface waters.


B.2.g.  Heat Content

The heat  content  (heat  of  combustion) of  the  sludge is  of  importance  in evalua-
ting sludge combustion  techniques. Typical  values are shown in  Table 4.
                                        25

-------
TABLE 4.  TYPICAL HEAT  OF  COMBUSTION OF SLUDGES (TOTAL DRY SOLIDS BASIS)  (10)
Material
Grease and scum
Raw sewage solids
Fine screenings
Ground garbage
Digested sewage solids
and ground garbage
Digested sludge
Grit
Combustibles
%
88.5
74.0
86.4
84.8

49.6
59.6
33.2
Ash
(%)
11.5
26.0
13.6
15.2

50.4
40.4
69.8
Average
BTU/pound
16,800
10,300
9,000
8,200

8,000
5,300
4,000
If  the  available heat of  combustion  from the sludge  equals or  exceeds  the heat
required to dry  and  ignite  the  sludge and to compensate  for heat losses from the
system,  then  the sludge  incineration process is  autogenous  (self-burning),  and
very little external  energy  is  required,  except  for furnace start-up. If the heat
or  moisture  content  of  the  sludge is  such  that  autogenous burning  is  not pos-
sible, operating costs must  include auxiliary  fuel requirements for combustion.

The heat  content of  the  sludge  can  be approximated  by the heat  released  in the
oxidation  of  the primary  constituents of  the  sludge,  given estimates  of  their
concentrations  (11).  Several other  methods  of  calculation which  have  been pro-
posed  give similar,  but  varying results  (11-13). The  accuracy of  heat  content
calculation is questionable, however,  and actual calorimeter tests should be used
whenever possible (10).


B.2.h.  pH

The pH  of  the sludge has  an impact  on the  availability of heavy  metals  and the
pathogen concentration  of the sludge.  High  pH  (above  10), in.  general,  promotes
the destruction  of  pathogens and  inhibits  the  movement  of heavy  metals  through
the soil and  the uptake of heavy metals by plants.


B.2.i.  Toxic Organic Compounds

Toxic organic compounds,  which  are  persistent in  the environment,  such  as  pesti-
cides and  polychlorinated  biphenyls (PCB's), are of concern where the sludge man-
agement  system  may  result  in  discharge  of  these  substances  to  the  atmosphere,
groundwater,  or  surface  waters, or allow their  entry  into human  or  animal food
chains.
                                        26

-------
B.3. INDUSTRIAL CONTRIBUTIONS

The  industrial  contributions  to  the  wastewater  should  be analyzed  to  determine
their  effects  on  the sludge  production  rate   (both  average  quantity  and  peak
quantities,  especially  seasonal peaks)  and on  the  sludge analysis.  Some  indus-
tries are a  major  potential  source  of toxic substances such  as  heavy metals.  The
facilities plan  should  evaluate whether  pretreatment  is  required  for industrial
wastes  by  the  "Federal  Pretreatment  Standards"  (40CFR128)  (14) or any  state  or
local pretreatment standard  for removal  of  toxic substances.


Section C -  EXISTING FACILITIES

The  existing sludge  treatment and  management  facilities will  be an  important
factor  in  the economics  of sludge  management  alternative  selection.  Extensive
existing facilities will,  of course,  tend to favor  those  alternatives which make
effective use  of  those  facilities. Existing facilities must be evaluated  as  to
their  reasonable  future   life and  continued  effectiveness.  Sludge  processing
facilities  which  perform  some  combination  of  the  following  functions  may  be
present:

          Thickening
          Dewatering
          Storage
          Stabilization
          Combustion
          Transport
          Disposal


Section D -  ENVIRONMENTAL  CONSIDERATIONS

Environmental  considerations are  those features  of  the environment  which  affect
the selection of a sludge  management  system.
D.I.  CLIMATE

A climatalogical  analysis  is important  in the selection  of  most  sludge  manage-
ment  alternatives.  While certain  factors  are  of  more  concern  for some  systems
than  others, all  factors should be  considered  to aid  the decision-making process.
The possibility of climatalogical  variations within  the  planning  area  should also
be considered. Sources of climatalogical data  include (15):

      •    National Weather Service  local offices
      •    Climatalogical Data, Published by  the National Weather  Service,
          Department of Commerce
      •    Airports
      •    Universities
      •    Military installations
      •    Agricultural extension services
      •    Agricultural experiment  stations

                                        27

-------
     •    Agencies managing large  reservoirs
     •    American Society of Heating  and  Refrigeration Engineers publications


D.I.a. Precipitation Analysis

The precipitation  analysis will affect  the choice  of ultimate  disposal  method,
the selection of crops  for  land  application,  and the  scheduling  of  land applica-
tion and landfill operations, as well  as many other features  of  land application
and landfill  systems.   The  precipitation  analysis  should  include the  following
minimum information:

     •    Mean annual rainfall
     •    Seasonal distribution
     •    Storm intensity
D.l.b.  Evapotranspiration Potential

The evapotranspiration potential affects  crop  selection  and  application rates for
agricultural  utilization  of  sludge.  Evaporation  rates  effect sludge  processing
methods such  as  composting,  sandbed drying and lagoon drying.  Analysis of evapo-
ration rates  and evapotranspiration potentials  should  include:

     •    Mean annual rates
     •    Seasonal variations
D.I.e.  Temperature Analysis

The temperature analysis  is  important  in the selection of crops  in  land  applica-
tion systems and  in  scheduling of  landfill  and land application  operations.  The
temperature analysis should  include:

     •    Mean annual temperature
     •    Seasonal variations
     •    Number  of frost-free  days
     •    Number  of freezing days
D.l.d.  Wind Analysis

The wind  analysis will affect  the design  of  incinerator  stacks  and  the  siting
and design of  landfill  and land application sites.  Wind data should  include  the
average and design maximum velocities, and  the  prevailing  direction.
D. 2.  LAND CHARACTERISTICS

Land characteristics are  of  critical  importance in the selection  of  the  ultimate
disposal method.
                                        28

-------
Sources  of  land  characteristics data include (15):

         U.S.  Department  of  Agriculture - Commodity Stabilization Program
         U.S.  Department  of  Agriculture - Soil Conservation Service
         U.S.  Department  of  Agriculture - Extension Service
         U.S.  Geological  Survey
         U.S.  Environmental  Protection Agency (STORET)
         Local planning departments
         U.S.  Corps of Engineers  offices
         Private photogrammetry and  mapping companies
         State mine and geology agencies
         State water  resources  agencies
         Local water  conservation  districts
         Groundwater  users (municipalities, water companies,  individuals, etc.)


D.2.a.  Topography

The  topography will,   to  a  large  extent,  determine  the design  of the  ultimate
disposal system  and affects  the potential  of  the site for runoff  and  subsequent
surface and groundwater pollution.

D.Z.b.  Soils

The data describing soils should  include the following:

          Depth
          Texture
          Structure
          Bulk densities
          Porosity
          Permeability
          Moisture
          Ease of excavation
          Stability
          pH
          Cation exchange capacity

D.2.c.  Geology

The geologic data should  include the  following:

     •    Depth
     •    Type
     •    Fractures
     •    Surface outcrops


D.2.d.  Groundwater

Groundwater  data  are important  because  of  the  necessity  of  protecting  the
aquifers from  leachate pollution. Groundwater  data  should include:

                                        29

-------
          Depth  to groundwater
          Depth  of aquifer
          Direction  of  flow
          Hydraulic  gradeline
          Quality
          Location of recharge  zones
          Present and future uses
D.2.e.  Surface Water
Surface water data should  include:
          Location of surface waters
          Direction of flow
          Rate of flow
          Quality
          Present and intended  uses
Section E - SLUDGE TRANSPORT

The  evaluation  of sludge  transport  systems  requires  the examination  of  several
factors.  The  quantity and  type  of sludge  and degree  of processing  it  receives
influence  the  means  of  transport  as  does  the  method of  ultimate  disposal.
Environmental considerations  and  the  availability  of  transport  facilities  also
influence  the  decision-making process.  Barging,  for example,  will  be  precluded
from consideration  if  there is  no appropriate watercourse  between the processing
and  disposal  sites.  In  the preliminary  analysis  of alternatives,  it should  be
readily apparent  that  certain transport  modes are  unsuitable  for the particular
local conditions.

There are four  basic methods  of  sludge  transport-pipeline,  truck, barge and rail-
road. In  certain instances,  the  methods  may be combined and  in  others  they  may
not  be  required at all.  An  example  of  the  latter  would  be  if  local  residents
hauled  processed  sludge  from the  treatment  plant  themselves.  With  the  exception
of  short  loading and  unloading  pipelines  in  combination  with  truck,  barge  or
railroad  transport, combined  systems  are  rarely  the  best  choice. The EPA publica-
tion Transport  of Sewage Sludge  (16) has  a  great  deal  of  information on the plan-
ning of sludge  transport systems.


E.I. PIPELINE

Headloss  through a sludge  pipeline  is determined  by  the  solids content  of  the
sludge. Sludges greater  than  10  percent can be pumped, but it  may not be  econom-
ically  feasible.  In general,  pipeline  transport  is  appropriate for sludges 4 per-
cent or less (16). Liquid  sludges  with  higher solids content  can be diluted prior
to transport through pipeline.
                                        30

-------
E.I.a.  Route

Alternative  pipeline  routes must  be  evaluated.  The  terrain  and  distance between
the treatment  and  disposal sites  for  various routes will  influence  the facility
costs. Pipeline crossings  such  as  highways,  railroads and waterways may pose con-
struction and  maintenance  problems. Subsurface considerations  such as  soil types
and the locations  of  other utility lines  must also  be  evaluated.  Health consid-
erations may prevent  routing  sludge pipelines in  the close proximity of domestic
water supply lines due  to  potential for  cross-connections.  The allowable distance
will  vary  from a requirement  that pipes not  be  installed  in  the  same  trench to
requiring several feet  of  separation,  depending  on local regulations.


S.l.b.  Size and Material

Preliminary  sizing is  required  in  the planning of  pipelines.  Table 5 gives pipe-
line  sizes   and  flow  rates  for liquids.  Typically,  cement-lined  cast  iron  or
ductile iron pipe  is  used  for sludge pipelines.  Depending  on local conditions,
other materials may be  more suitable.
                     TABLE  5.   PIPELINE  SIZE AND FLOW RATES

Pipeline
size, in.
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
18
20
Sludge flow rate
gpm @ 3 fps
velocity
120
280
500
800
1,100
1,400
2,000
2,500
3,000
Pipeline capacity
various daily hourly
4
0.03
0.06
0.11
0.18
0.25
0.35
0.45
0.57
0.70
8
0.06
0.13
0.24
0.38
0.53
0.67
0.96
1.20
1.44
at 3 fps velocity for
operating periods, mgd
12
0.09
0.20
0.36
0.58
0.79
1.01
1.44
1.80
2.16
20
0.14
0.34
0.60
0.96
1.32
1.68
2.40
3.00
3.60
E.l.c.  Pumping Requirements

Pipeline  pump station  information is  presented in  Tables  6 and  7.  The  former
gives the  sludge  pumping  characteristics and the latter,  the  energy required for
different  operating times.
                                        31

-------
              TABLE 6.  PIPELINE SLUDGE PUMPING CHARACTERISTICS  (16)
Approximate head
Hydraulic available each Pump
Pipeline
size, in.
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
18
20
Flow,
gpm
120
280
500
800
1,100
1,400
2,000
2,500
3,000
loss, ft/ pumping station
100 ft (090)
2.10
1.40
1.02
0.82
0.61
0.45
0.45
0.39
0.33
ft1
4002
4502
260
230
230
210
2103
2253
2003
, efficiency,
percent
45
50
50
64
73
78
70
76
78
Pumping station
spacing-level
terrain, ft
19,048
32,143
25,490
28,049
37,705
46,667
46,667
57,179
60,606
* Based on non-clog, centrifugal, 1,780 rpm pumps.
  Pumps in series for additional head.
3 Pumps in parallel for additional capacity.






Pipeline
size, in.









4
6
8
10
12
14
16
18
20
TABLE 7.

Power, kw/
1,000 gph
ft head
0.0078
0.0070
0.0070
0.0055
0.0048
0.0045
0.0050
0.0046
0.0045
PIPELINE PUMPING

for
STATION ENERGY
Annual
daily
energy,
hours of
(16)
kwh/ft head




operation shown
Total station
4
90
-
-
0
-
-
-
-
-





1
1
1
2
2
8
180
378
675
843
,016
,211
,927
,219
,594
12
270
567
1,012
1,265
1,525
1,816
2,891
3,328
3,891



1
2
2
3
4
5
6
20
450
944
,686
,108
,541
,027
,818
,547
,486
Victor efficiency = 90%; pump efficiency = 80%; kw/11,000 gph-ft head =

       	0.00315	
       (pump eff) (Motor eff)
                                       32

-------
E.2.  TRUCK

Truck  transport  is  appropriate  for liquid  sludge with  at  least  four  percent
solids and for  dewatered  sludge.  Truck  transport is normally feasible for one-way
haul distances  up  to 80 miles.


E.2.a.  Route and  Travel  Time

Travel time  can be determined  from  the transport  distance  and  traffic patterns.
Average speeds  of  25  mph for the first  20  miles and 35 mph  for  the  remainder of
the  trip  can be  used to approximate  the  total  travel  time per  truck  load of
sludge (16).


E.2.b.  Size and Number of  Trucks

The  size  and number of  trucks  can  be  determined  from  the  type and  quantity of
sludge  to be transported and  the  distance  between the  treatment  and  disposal
sites. Local traffic regulations  may govern the maximum size of  trucks.  Informa-
tion for  determining  truck  requirements are given  in reference  16.  For example a
10 mgd secondary treatment  plant  with a 20  mile haul distance,  with trucks opera-
ting 8 hours a day 360 days  per year,   would  require a  total  of  6  2,500 gallon
trucks for liquid  sludge  or one 15 cubic yard  truck for  dewatered sludge.


E.2.C.  Fuel Requirements

Unit fuel requirements for  various   types  and sizes of  sludge   transport  trucks
are  given in reference 16. The fuel use for  the  trucks  in  the  previously  cited
example would be 4.5 miles  per  gallon.


E.2.d.  Manpower Requirements

Manpower  requirements  for truck  transport  are given in  reference 16  for liquid
and  dewatered sludges. These are  based  on the  truck operating hours plus ten per-
cent. For  the 10  mgd  example cited previously  approximately 16,000 man-hours per
year of  truck  operator time would  be required  for  liquid  sludge  and  2,600  man-
hours for dewatered sludge.


E.2.e.  Loading, Unloading, and Vehicle Service Facilities

Auxiliary  facilities  for  truck transport  of  sludge include  elevated  storage for
dewatered  sludge,  loading  equipment and  unloading  equipment.   These  should  be
planned  in  conjunction  with the  specific  sludge processing  systems  they  will
serve.  Other facilities may be  necessary,  depending on  local conditions.
                                        33

-------
E.3.  BARGE

Barging,  although not a  common method  of sludge  transport,  is  appropriate  for
liquid  sludge with  four  to  ten  percent solids.  Practical  transport  distances
range from 20 to  320 miles  and,  of course, a  suitable waterway must be available.
Conceivably,  barging  could be combined with  other  methods  of  transport; however,
it is generally preferable  to use  only  one.


E.3.a.  Route and Travel  Time

The  route  for barging is  confined to local  waterways.  It  is unlikely  that more
than one, or possibly  two,  alternatives  for barging sludge  will be available.

The average speed of barges is  about  4  mph although speeds of up  to  7 mph can be
achieved in open  waterways. Transit times will be  variable  depending on traffic,
draw  bridges,  locks,  tides,  currents,  and  other  factors  (16).  For  the  10  mgd
plant cited in the earlier  example, with a 80 mile  barging  distance approximately
2,600 hours of hauling time would  be  required for  a  300,000 gallon barge, carry-
ing 4 percent solids sludge.


E.3.b.  Size and Number of  Barges

The  barge requirements vary with  the type of sludge produced and  the processing
it receives prior to  disposal.  Barge  requirements  are given in  reference  16.  For
the example cited above  one 300,000 capacity   barge would suffice,  assuming stor-
age at the plant is available while the  barge is  in transit.


E.3.c.  Fuel Requirements

Fuel  is  required for  operating the  barge  tow boat. Estimates  for the  tow boat
size and  fuel consumption are  given  in reference  16.  In general,  larger barges
and  tow boats are more efficient  than smaller ones since fewer trips  are needed
to  transport  the same  quantity of  sludge.   For  the 300,000  gallon  barge  cited
above, a  tow  boat of  approximately 1,200  horsepower  would  be needed  with a fuel
consumption of 2,000 gallons  per day.


E.3.d.  Manpower Requirements

The  annual  labor requirements  for barging  operations  are  approximately twelve
man-hours/barge  load.  Maintenance   requirements  are approximately  680  man-hours/
year for plants up to  10  mgd, 1,640 man-hours/year for plants up  to  100 mgd,  and
2,400 man-hours/year  for plants up to  500 mgd  (16).  Towed  barges are  generally
unmanned during  transit,  therefore they have   lower labor requirements  than self-
propelled barges.
                                        34

-------
E.3.e.  Loading, Unloading,  and  Vehicle Service Facilities

Auxiliary  facilities  for barge  transport include  loading storage  and  equipment
(pumps  and a  pipeline),  a  dock and  control  building,  and  unloading  equipment
(pipeline).  Towing  equipment  servicing  is  the   responsibility  of  the  towing
company  unless self-propelled  barges  are  used,  in which  case  a  shop  will  be
needed.
E.3.f.  Tow Tariffs

Tow charges are  normally based on  total  tow boat billing  times,  including round
trips and  idling time. Tow  tariffs are a function  of  tow boat size  rather than
barge size, so it is important  to  carefully  match the two for maximum economy.


E.4.  RAILROAD

Railroad transport  is  suitable for dewatered sludge and liquid sludge.   Trans-
port distances generally  range  from 20 to 320 miles. Railroad  transport is not a
common method of transporting  sludge.


E.4.a.  Route and Travel  Time

Rail transport of sludge is  constrained  by  the  established rail lines  and their
routes. It is unlikely that  more  than  one or two options would  be  available in a
particular area. Transit  times  for  transporting  sludge  by rail are  usually on the
order of several days,  even  for relatively  short haul  distances.  The possibility
of  nuisance   conditions  arising   because   of  putrifying   sludge   should   be
considered.
E.4.b.  Size and Number of Cars

Tank  cars  used  for rail  transport  of  liquid  sludge must  be  supplied  by  the
shipper. These can  be  acquired from the manufacturer  by  purchase,  lease, or con-
tract.  The  demand  requirements  are given  in  reference  16.  Hopper or  side dump
cars  for  dewatered sludge may be  available  from the  railroad.  A  20,000  gallon
capacity tank car is the  normal  capacity.  For a  10 mgd  secondary plant producing
15 mg of sludge per year  approximately 13  tank cars would  be  required  of 2 loads
per day. For dewatered sludge  50  cy hopper  cars  are  used.


E.4.c.  Fuel Requirements

While the  fuel  demands will be  met by the  rail  company and will  be  included in
the  tariffs,  the fuel consumed  in  transporting the  sludge  should  be estimated
for inclusion in the energy effectiveness analysis.
                                        35

-------
E.4.d.  Manpower Requirements

Typical  labor  requirements for  loading  and unloading  the  railroad cars  and for
maintenance  are  given in  reference  16.  For the  10 mgd example cited  above, O&M
labor would  be approximately 4,400 man-hours  per year for liquid sludge and 3,600
man-hours per year for dewatered  sludge.


E.4.e.  Loading, Unloading, and  Service  Facilities

Railroad  transport  of sludge  typically  requires loading  storage  and  equipment
(pumps and  piping  for liquid sludge  and  hoppers for dewatered  sludge),  railroad
sidings  and unloading   equipment.   Unloading   is   ordinarily  accomplished  by
gravity.


E.4.f.  Tariffs

Costs for  railroad  transport vary widely and should be  obtained  as a  result  of
close consultation  with  the  carrier  in  question.  In  addition  to distance and
weight carried,  the  ownership of  the cars,  and  regional variations will  affect
the tariffs. If  the cars  are to  be leased,  consideration  must be given  to leasing
costs.
Section - F LAND APPLICATION

Land application includes  those  projects  where  sludge is applied to land for dis-
posal, crop  utilization,  or reclamation  of  spoiled areas.  Land  application does
not  include  trenching or landfill  projects.  Land application  systems  frequently
involve utilization of sludge  for agricultural  production.

The  local farm  advisor,  i.e.   the state  agricultural extension  service  or  county
agent, can be of tremendous help in the planning and evaluation  of land applica-
tion  systems  involving  sludge application  to  cropland  and should  be  consulted
closely throughout the planning, design  and  operational stages of a land applica-
tion system. A  typical  land application  design calculation is  shown in Appendix
A.
F.I.  PURPOSE

There are several possibilities  for  land  application  plans.  In order to determine
the proper  techniques and loading rates,  the land use  purpose must  be  defined.
The land may simply be a  dedicated disposal  site,  utilized for agriculture, util-
ized for reclaiming marginal  or  disturbed soils  or some  combination of the above.
Although annual  application  on  parks or forests is not  commonly  practiced appli-
cation  prior  to  planting provides  a  good  soil  conditioner  and  a slow  release
nitrogen source.  Discussions related to  reclaiming marginal  land  apply  to these
special systems.
                                        36

-------
F.I.a.  Dedicated Disposal

A  site  may be used  for  dedicated disposal  with  no crop grown.  This  should be a
modification  of  a  landfill  system.  Ultimate  land  use must  be  studied carefully
before  creating  a  dedicated land  disposal  area to avoid pollution of underlying
groundwater  or  the  buildup  of  excessive levels of  heavy metals  that  could make
the land unfit for agriculture.


F.l.b.  Agricultural Utilization

Sludge  applied  for agricultural  utilization  can  be  of  real benefit  to  fanners
when applications are  properly  controlled.  Agricultural use requires careful con-
trol  of application  rates  to  maximize  the  beneficial  use  of  organic  matter,
nitrogen,  phosphorus,   and  desired   trace   elements   (those   elements  which  are
essential  to  plant  growth but  lacking  in some soils,  such as  zinc  and copper.)
to insure  that heavy metals  are controlled  within  limits. Application rate deter-
minations  depend upon  various factors  such  as  soil  type,   crops to  be  grown,
method  of  application and regulatory  constraints.

Throughout this  section  and  in  later  sections  agricultural  utilization at maximum
rates on  sites  owned or controlled  by   the  operating  agency  is  emphasized.  This
does  not  preclude  utilization  on privately  owned land  or utilization  at  lower
rates.  It  is common practice for  farmers   to  use a  combination  of  organic  and
chemical fertilizers. For example,  sludge could be sold  to the  farmer and he may
use it  to  meet half  his  nitrogen  or  phosphorus needs and supplement with chemical
fertilizer to meet the rest  of  his needs. For more  information  refer  to the sec-
tion on off-site use by  others.


F.I.e.  Reclamation of Disturbed  or Marginal Lands

Another purpose  for  utilizing sludge is reclaiming marginal  or disturbed soils.
These projects are similar to agricultural  utilization projects  in terms of goals
and controls  required.  Higher application  rates may be  necessary  to  achieve the
desired results.
F.l.d.  Combinations

There may  be  several  purposes for an  area where sludge  is  applied.  Agricultural
operations or  climatic  constraints may  result  in an  area  being split  such that
some  acreage  is  used  for crops  and  some  is  used  for  dedicated  land  disposal.
Reclamation  sites  may  in  some  cases  be  converted  to  agricultural  production
areas.
F.2.  EVALUATION OF POTENTIAL  SITES

Site evaluation should  include a review of all potential  sites.  This review must
be through and timely  since  site acquisition or  contractual  agreements  with pri-
vate landowners can be  time-consuming and must begin well  in advance of facility

                                        37

-------
construction.  Site  acquisition  evaluation items should  be reviewed  on  a short-
term as well as long-term basis.
F.2.a.  Geographical Location

The location of  the site will  affect  economics-of the land application system as
well as the type system to  be  used. The  site must be located so that surface
water  is  not  contaminated.  The  minimum distance  between  the  site  and  surface
water is a function of the  application method to be used, the type of soil, crop,
and slope  of  the land adjacent  to the  surface  water.  Intermittent  or  ephemeral
streams should be considered as  surface  water systems.  A major  cost  item in land
application systems  is  transportation cost.  This cost  is a  function of distance
to transport and method of  transportation.  Also, in a given locale, some modes of
transportation are more readily  available  than others.  Condition and location of
the nearest  highways should be  determined.  In   some  instances  road  building  or
rebuilding may be required to  bring roads  up   to  standards  required  for  heavy
truck  traffic.   If  river  transportation systems or  barges  are  available,  then
their proximity  to proposed sites  should be determined.  In certain unusual situa-
tions a barge  transportation  system  may be combined with another  mode  of trans-
portation. For  example,  sludge  may be  barged from  the  plant  to  a  transfer  area
and then  trucked to  the  application  area.  Rail  systems can often  be found close
to  a  treatment  plant.  Railroad transport  availability  at  the  site  should  be
determined.  As  discussed  above  with barge  systems, railroad  transport  may  be
considered in conjunction with other  modes  of transportation.


F.2.b.  Compatibility with  Land  Use Plans

Regional  planners  or  the  planning commission  should  be consulted  to  determine
land use plans for potential sites. The  current  use  of  the  site should  be deter-
mined by visiting each site. Variations  during recent years should be noted, then
the compatibility of  the current use  with  the land  application  project  should be
determined. Regional  plans,  basic plans, and/or  master  plans  should  be  consulted
to determine the proposed  future use  of potential  sites.  Potential for  variation
in  these   plans  should  also   be determined.  Planners  should  be consulted  for
insights regarding these questions.

Current site zoning and adjacent area zoning and use should be determined. Actual
zoning may be  different  from current  use or  from planned use.  Adjacent  land use
may limit use of a site or  cause restrictive conditions  to  be placed on use  of a
particular site. For  example,  if a  nearby  area is  zoned  for  residential  use,
spraying of sludge may not  be  allowed.  Area  plans  or  zoning will  reflect general
planning  intentions   and  can  be  changed   with   good  justification.  However,  if
specific  development projects  have   been  approved  or  have been  initiated,  then
changes may  not  be  accepted.   Location  of  planned development projects  should  be
determined.  Selected  sites should be flexible so  that  there  is  room  for future
expansion. This  should be   considered even for  areas with  growth  controls since
sludge characteristics and  quantities per  capita can change. Also, the additional
space  will allow room if   application   rates  are  lowered from those  originally
proposed.


                                        38

-------
F.2.C. Method of Land Acquisition

There are several means  of  acquiring the land for  the  application site.  The best
method  will depend  upon the  local  agency  constraints,  local  regulatory agency
requirements, and current ownership  of  the  land.

Purchase  of a  site may take  several  years  especially if  the  owners   are  not
anxious  to  sell or are  asking a very high  price  for  the  property.  Condemnation
proceedings  may be  required which  cause  further  delay.   Site  purchase  has  the
major benefit of allowing maximum flexibility  to  the agency. Since  there are no
arguments  over  operations  with  land  owners and  contract  commitments are  less.
Purchase  price,  as  well as  potential  acquisition problems,  should  be determined
for potential sites.

Site lease agreements can be  advantageous when a  landowner  does  not want  to perm-
anently give up his  property or wants  to take advantage of improved soil charac-
teristics resulting  from the sludge addition. Lease  agreements  must be long-term
in nature  (10-20 years)  to  insure that the  agency  will have time  to  find alter-
native sites earlier than necessary. Lease  agreements should specify acreage, use
of land, and application procedures.

Some agencies may prefer to control  the site but not have  the  responsibility for
farming. This can be accomplished by purchasing  the property and then leasing the
site to a  farmer,  usually the previous owner.  The  farmer   will  then  continue the
farming  operation.   This approach  provides  the  flexibility  for  the agency  to
change operators at a later  date  or  to  operate  the  system  themselves.

Another approach to  obtaining a site is to  contract  with   a  user.  The advantages
of this approach are that land acquisition  problems are eliminated and the agency
does not  have  to operate  the farming  system.  Sludge  application may be  by  the
user or  by  the  agency.   The  agency should have contracts  with  users  with  10- to
20-year  terms unless adequate acreage  and  interest  in  the use  of  sludge assure
availability of alternate application sites.

Another  possible alternative is  a combination  of  land   acquisition and  lease
agreements. Application  rates  for crop  growth will be  lower  than  rates for dedi-
cated disposal  without  crops. With  the  combination approach, it  may  be  advanta-
geous for  an agency to  purchase adequate  area  for  dedicated  land disposal  and
still maintain  leases with  farmers  to  take  sludge  for soil  conditioner. This pro-
vides maximum flexibility.  The dedicated disposal area will  provide  the  site for
disposing of sludge when farming  operations  are not favorable for  sludge  applica-
tion.  Land leases are eligible  for grant participation  under certain conditions.

The land acquisition problem can  be  eliminated through direct sales  of sludge to
farmers. The farmer  could be charged for sludge delivered  (price  per  ton) and/or
for sludge applied  (price per acre). Sales   should  be through contract specifying
quantities, application  rates,  areas to  be  used, monitoring required,  and price.
                                        39

-------
F.3.  STABILIZATION PROCESS

Under  most  circumstances  before applying  sludge to  land  the  sludge  should  be
stabilized to reduce pathogenic  organisms and minimize odors and vector breeding.
There  are several  alternative  sludge  stabilization  processes discussed  below.
Some  treatment  plants  may  have  more than  one type  of  stabilization  process.  A
major impact of variation  in  the sludge stabilization process  used  is the change
in  the resulting  nutrient forms  and  concentrations.  The  potential  for  public
access to a site is usually directly  proportional to the  degree of sludge stabil-
ization that may be  required.  The processes  discussed below are anaerobic diges-
tion,  aerobic  digestion,  composting, incineration,  pasteurization,  and chemical
stabilization.  This  discussion describes  the expected results. Detailed discus-
sion of the process mechanisms is beyond  the  scope of  this document.

Some  stabilization  occurs  in storage lagoons.  The stabilization  rate and degree
of  stabilization are  unpredictable. Storage  lagoons are  normally designed  to  be
periodically drawn  down.  During  this time,  there would  be  no  stabilization.  The
design can  utilize several  parallel lagoons to  provide  continuous  storage  for
stabilization.  The  unpredictable lagoon  performance and  the potential  for  nui-
sance  conditions  with   raw   sludges  are   factors  which   must   be  thoroughly
considered.
F.3.a.  Anaerobic Digestion

Anaerobic digestion  reduces  pathogen concentrations significantly.  Nitrogen con-
centrations  can also  be greatly  impacted.  Typical nutrient  concentrations  in
anaerobically digested sludge are as  follows:

         COMPOSITION OF  REPRESENTATIVE  ANAEROBIC  SEWAGE  SLUDGES (17)

         Component                    Range*                Lb/Ton**

         Total  nitrogen                  1-5              20-100
         Ammonium nitrogen               1-3              20-60
         Total  phosphorus             1.5-3              30-60
         Total  potassium             0.27-0.8              4-16

* Percent of oven-dry solids
** Lb/ton dry sludge

F.3.b. Aerobic  Digestion

Pathogen destruction by  the aerobic  digestion process  is  similar  to that achieved
by  anaerobic digestion.  Aerobic digestion has  been  used  extensively at  small
activated  sludge  plants.  Many  extended  aeration  (including  oxidation  ditch)
plants dispose  of  sludge without further  digestion.  This sludge  will  be  similar
to  aerobically  digested  sludge  in terms  of both  nutrient  content and  degree  of
stabilization  (measured  by  reduction in  volatile solids,  which  averages  40-55
percent). Typical  nutrient  concentrations  in  aerobically digested sludge  are  as
follows:
                                        40

-------
         COMPOSITION  OF  REPRESENTATIVE AEROBIC SEWAGE SLUDGES (8)

         Component                     Range*               Lb/Ton**

         Total  nitrogen                  3-6              60-120
         Ammonium nitrogen               1-3              20-60
         Nitrate nitrogen              0.5-1.5            10-30
         Total  phosphorus              1.1-5.5            22-110
         Total  potassium              0.8-1.1            16-22

 * Percent of oven-dry solids
** Lb/ton dry sludge


F.3.C.  Heat Treatment
Pasteurization  is  generally  accomplished  by a  heat  treatment  conditioning  pro-
cess.  Pathogens will be  destroyed when the  sludge is  exposed  to  159°F  or  70°C
heat  for  30 to  60  minutes.  Higher  temperatures require  less  time  for  pathogen
destruction. Nutrient  concentrations in heat  treated  sludge  are  extremely vari-
able. One source (18) reports  the  following:


           NUTRIENT  CONTENTS  OF  HEAT  TREATED  SLUDGE CONCENTRATION, %

                          Total N                 2.8
                          NH3-N                   0.25
                          Total P                 0.46
                          K                        0.09

Generally, heat  treatment processes  reduce  nitrogen contents while phosphorus and
potassium content  remains unchanged  from  raw sludge values.  Heat  treatment  pro-
cesses do not significantly reduce volatile  organics  or  odors.


F.3.d.  Chemical Stabilization

There are three  main methods  of  chemical stabilization  used at  this  time.   They
are  stabilization  by lime or  lime and  ferric chloride  addition and  by  chlorine
addition through the patented  process "Purifax".  All  have  been effective  means of
pathogen destruction but  information regarding  nutrient contents and  the  poten-
tial for generating  toxic organics  is limited.  Ammonia  levels will  be reduced by
either of  these three  processes.  This  reduction  results  from  volatilization  of
ammonia at high pH values with lime treatment or  the  combination with chlorine :o
form chloramines. Lime  stabilization  can impact  the  phosphorus concentration  (19)
by  combining  some  of the  phosphorus with  calcium  to form  calcium  phosphate.  A
slight loss of total phosphorus  is also likely.
                                       41

-------
F.4.  AGRICULTURAL MANAGEMENT PLAN

Agricultural management  is  an essential part  of  planning a land application  pro-
ject.  Selection of  the  crop(s)  to be  grown is  necessary to  determine loading
rates  and timing  of  sludge  applications.  Coupled  with  these  considerations is
planning  the farming  operation.  Is the farming to be  done by  the agency or under
contract? Long  range  planning should provide  a flexible system.


F.4.a.  Crops to be Grown,  Rotation Plan,  and Markets

The  choice  of  crops  to  be grown  depends  primarily  on  local  considerations and
regulatory  constraints.  If  locally  grown   crops  are  not  suitable  for  sludge
amended  soils,  then  crops  should  be  chosen  which  would  be  adaptable  to  local
farming  practices.  Crop  selection  should  be  discussed  with  the  local   farm
advisor.  The crops  chosen should be high nutrient users  and have a cash value so
sales can help  offset  operating  costs. Field corn and  forage  crops are most  fre-
quently used. Sod  farms  are also excellent  for utilizing sludge.

In many  areas  it may  be advantageous  to develop  a  crop  rotation  plan where the
crop grown changes  periodically. Crop  rotation can be  an important factor in the
area  of   nutrient  utilization and  soil  fertility.   The   crop  rotation  plan  (if
appropriate) should be developed before  determining  sludge application rates.

If cash sales are  expected  with  crops  grown on the land  application site, then a
market analysis should be completed. This  analysis may be very brief if  the crops
grown are already  common to the  area.  If a new crop(s)  is to  be brought into the
area, the marketing analysis  may be more complex  since  new markets would have to
be developed. In either  case  some  market analysis work is required.


F.4.b.  Farming by Municipal  Agency or Contract

If the agency  or  authority responsible  for  operating  the  sewage treatment  plant
will  also be  responsible   for   the  farming   operation,   then  plans  must include
hiring a  staff  and  aquisition of equipment  for farming. This staff should include
equipment operators,  maintenance  staff  and  possibly additional  laboratory  tech-
nicians.  The  type  of farm  equipment is  determined by  the crop  grown  and sludge
application techniques.

There are several  options  regarding contract  farming.  One  would  provide for all
farming  to  be  done  by contract.  Another  option  is  to contract  for harvesting,
with the  agency accomplishing all  other  farming operations. Other options include
variations of responsibilities accomplished  by contract and by the agency.

Application to  private land would eliminate  this  responsibility with the munici-
pality providing transport, application, both,  or neither.
                                        42

-------
F.4.c.  Long Range Plan

Long  range  planning  should include  plans  to cover the management  of application
sites  directly  controlled by the  municipality where recommended  limitations  for
heavy  metal additions  are exceeded.  These  plans  may  include  non-agricultural
uses.  For  example,  the application  site may  change  from agricultural  to forest
land use.
F.5.  NUTRIENT BALANCE

The major nutrients  of  interest in  municipal  sludge from  an  agricultural stand-
point are  macronutrients,  or  nitrogen, phosphorus,  and potassium.  Agricultural
fertilizer requirements  are  expressed in terras of  nitrogen compounds as nitrogen
(%N),  phosphorous  compounds  as   phosphoric  acid   (%P2°^  or  phosphorus  (%P),
and  potassium  compounds as  potassium oxide or  potash  (l^O).  Once  the nutrient
contents in  the  sludge  are determined  and  crops  selected,  nutrient  balances  and
corresponding application  rates can  be  computed.


F.S.a.  Nitrogen

Nitrogen is  the  most  complex of the  three  nutrients. Plants  utilize nitrogen in
the ammonium and  nitrate forms. Organic  nitrogen  in the  soil must be converted or
mineralized  to the  nitrate form.   The mineralization rates  are  specific to indi-
vidual  areas  and soil  types.  Nitrogen  control  is  important  since  nitrates  can
create a potential problem if  excessive  levels  are  allowed  to  build up in ground-
water  supplies.   Table  8  shows  nitrogen  requirements  for  various  field  crops.
These requirements  will vary  at  different locations  and with  different  yields.
Note  that  the  values shown  are pounds  per acre  utilized.  This assumes  that  the
crop is harvested and not  plowed back into  the  soil.

F.S.a.(1)  Forms  of Nitrogen — Most  sludges have  nitrogen present in the ammonium
and  nitrate  forms  as  well  as  organic  nitrogen.  Each  nitrogen  form must  be
addressed when  planning a land  application system.  Nitrate nitrogen  is  readily
usable  by crops.  If  more nitrate   is available  than used by the  crop,  the excess
will leach into groundwater  supplies, potentially causing problems for the use of
this groundwater. Ammonia  in sludge is  found  in  the ammonium  ion form. Ammonium
is  usable  by crops.  Planning  for  the correct  application  rate should  take into
account ammonia losses  if  sludge is  applied and allowed  to  dry. If sludge is sur-
face applied and  allowed to  remain on the  surface,  some  of  the ammonium will con-
vert  to ammonia, volatilize,  and  be  lost to  the  atmosphere.  These  losses  can
amount  to  20 to   70 percent  depending on site  specific  conditions and  length of
time before  the  sludge  is  incorporated  into  the  soil.  The  most  complex nitrogen
form (in terms of planning a land  application  system) is  organic nitrogen. Plants
cannot  utilize  organic  nitrogen   until  it  has converted  or  mineralized  to  the
plant available forms.

F.S.a.(2)    Mineralization  Rate  of  Organic  Nitrogen  -  Organic  nitrogen  is
converted to usable  forms  at a variable rate,  which depends on  climate and soil
type. The mineralization rate  should be estimated  based on experiences at sites
with  similar soil types in  areas  with  similar  climates.  Usually,  15-25  percent

                                        43

-------
TABLE 8.   PLANT NUTRIENT UTILIZATION BY VARIOUS CROPS (20)
Crop
Field crops
Barley
Corn (grain)
Corn (silage)
Cotton (lint)
Grain sorghum
Oats
Rice
Saf flower
Soybeans
Sugar beets
Wheat
Vegetable crops
Asparagus
Beans (snap)
Broccoli
Cabbage
Celery
Lettuce
Potatoes (Irish)
Squash
Sweet potatoes
Tomatoes
Fruit and nut crops
Almonds (in shell)
Apples
Cantaloupes
Grapes
Oranges
Peaches
Pears
Prunes
Forage crops
Alfalfa
Bromegrass
Clover-grass
Orchardgrass
Sorghum-sudan
Timothy
Vetch
Turf crops
Bentgrass
Bermudagrass
Yield
per acre

2 1/2 t
5 t
30 t
1,500 Ibs
4 t
3,200 Ibs
7,000 Ibs
4,000 Ibs
3,600 Ibs
30 t
3 t

3,000 Ibs
10,000 Ibs
18,000 Ibs
35 t
75 t
20 t
500 cwt
10 t
12 t
30 t

3,000 Ibs
15 t
30 t
15 t
30 t
15 t
15 t
15 t

8 t
5 t
6 t
6 t
8 t
4 t
7 t

2 1/2 t
4 t

N

175
240
200
210
250
115
110
200
335
275
175

95
175
80
230
280
95
250
85
115
250

200
100
190
105
120
95
85
90

450
165
300
300
325
150
390

225
225
Pounds per acre
P2°5

65
100
80
90
80
40
60
50
65
85
80

50
35
30
65
165
30
115
20
45
80

75
45
60
45
40
40
25
30

80
65
90
100
125
25
105

80
40

K20

175
230
245
150
200
145
170
150
145
550
140

120
200
75
250
750
200
355
120
230
480

250
180
340
125
175
120
95
130

480
255
360
375
475
250
320

160
160
                            44

-------
of  the  organic  nitrogen  is  converted  the first  year of  application.   Lesser
amounts of  the  remaining organic nitrogen  are  converted  during subsequent years.
These amounts  range from  5-10  percent  the second year  and  from 2-3  percent  in
subsequent years  (20,  21).

F.5.a.(3)  Future Application Rate Adjustments  for Mineralized Organic Nitrogen -
Each year  the  application rate  should  be adjusted to  account  for mineralization
of previous applications.  This  means  that if  sludge is being used on cropland and
the nitrogen  balance is critical, then either acreages  must  be  increased  or  an
alternative crop which  uses higher nitrogen levels grown.

F.5.a.(4)   Additional  Nitrogen  Needed  for Crop (if  any)  - If  application  rates
are limited (by heavy  metals,  for example), crop  nitrogen  requirement  may not  be
met. There are two  alternatives to  solving this requirement.  One  is  to switch to
a crop  with a lower nitrogen  requirement. The other is  to provide  supplemental
nitrogen. When needed  supplemental  nitrogen can  be provided in  several ways for
each  of many  forms. The  best  method  depends on local  supplies  and  types  of
fertilization  equipment available.  Supplemental nitrogen  would be  provided only
where crops  have a  high market  value  and  are critical  in  terms of  offsetting
operating costs.


F.S.b.  Phosphorus

For most crops phosphorus  requirements  are much lower than nitrogen requirements.
Nitrogen and phosphorus  contents in sludge are  nearly the same. Therefore, appli-
cation  rates set  for nitrogen  utilization result  in more  phosphorus  being  added
to the  soil than will  be  used  by the  crop. While  there are  no  established limits
for phosphorus  addition  phytotoxic  reactions  can occur  in  plants  if excessive
phosphorus  is  applied.  Records  keeping should include phosphorus additions.  If
high levels of  phosphorus are  to be applied plans should be made  for  the future
management  of  the  application  site  if excessive  phosphorus  creates  a problem.
Actual  phosphorus  applications  should  be measured  or expressed  as  P2^5*  Crop
utilization  rates for  phosphorus are  shown  on Table 8.  These  rates  should  be
verified by the local  farm advisor before they  are used.


F.5.c.  Potassium

Potassium  concentrations  in  sludges  are  usually  much lower  than nitrogen  and
phosphorus  concentrations.  Crop potassium needs  are  generally higher  than  their
phosphorus  needs,  and  often equal  to  nitrogen requirements.   Therefore,  supple-
mental  potassium is frequently   required to  insure maximum crop  production,
Typically it is supplied in the  form  of potash. Some  areas  having high background
levels  of potash  in  the soil may not  require additions of  potassium.  Crop potas-
sium utilization  rates  are shown on Table 8.  When potash  additions  are required
the supplemental  requirements  are  determined  by  subtracting  that  added by  the
sludge  and that amount  available in the soil from  the crop  requirement.
                                        45

-------
F.6.  HEAVY METAL LOADINGS

There  is  much  controversy  about  heavy metal  applications  and  their  impact on
food chain  crops.  Essentially there  are  two criteria which  minimize the hazards
to metal uptake  by  crops. They are cation exchange  capacity  and  maintenance of a
soil pH greater  than  6.5.

EPA, USDA, and a number  of  state  agencies  and land grant universities have issued
guidance documents  to assist  project  planners in determining  sludge application
rates. A number  of these references  cite guidelines  or regulations  which limit
heavy metal additions  to cropland through  sludge  application (22 to 29). The most
current regulations  are  the EPA  40CFR257,  "Criteria for Classification of Solid
Waste  Disposal  Facilities  and  Practices"  (29).  Local and state  requirements
should be determined  of  the particular  area.

F.6.a.  Cation Exchange  Capacity

The level of  heavy  metals  in  soils that  begin to cause  crop production problems
can vary due  to  a number of soil  factors,  such as organic matter and clay content
of  the  soil,  which are  reflected by  the  soil's  cation  exchange  capacity  (CEC).
Suggested total  amounts  of  heavy  metals added to  agricultural land as provided in
EPA guidance  documents published  in  1978  are shown  on  Table 9.  These  suggested
values were based upon maintaining the  soil  pH at greater than 6.5.


           TABLE 9.   SUGGESTED TOTAL  AMOUNT  OF SLUDGE METALS  ADDED TO
                     AGRICULTURAL LAND  (30)
Soil cation exchange capacity (meq/100 g)
Metal

Pb
Zn
Cu
Ni
Cd
Determined by the
0-5
Maximum
500
250
125
125
5
pH 7 ammonium
5-15
Cumulative Amount of Metal
1,000
500
250
250
10
acetate procedure
15
(Ib/acre)
2,000
1,000
500
500
20

F.6.b.  Sludge and Soil pH

The  combined sludge-soil  pH should  be  maintained  above  6.5 and  when  lower  pH
values are found, lime should be  added  to  raise  the pH.  The metals  concentrations
are cumulative so previous additions  must  be  considered.


F.6.c.  Cadmium

Cadmium is generally  the  metal  that  causes  the  most concern  for sludge  applica-
tions to cropland. Both the  soil  and  food  chain  crops  can  be adversely affected.


                                        46

-------
The  US EPA  interim  final guidelines  provide  for  two approaches  to  controlling
land  application of  sludges  containing  cadmium.  The first  approach consists  of
three  requirements.   First,  the  pH of  the  sludge  and  soil  mixture  is  6.5  or
greater  at  the  time  of application, except  for sludge containing cadmium at  con-
centrations  of  2 mg/kg (dry weight) or  less.  Secondly,  the annual application  of
cadmium  from sludge  does  not  exceed 0.5 kg/ha  on  land used for the  production  of
tobacco,  leafy  vegetables, or root  crops grown for  human  consumption. For other
food chain  crops,  the annual  cadmium application rate does not exceed:

                                                 Annual Cd
       Time  period                            Application Rate
      	              (kg/ha)

       Present to June 30,  1984                      2.0
       July  1, 1984 to Dec.  31,  1986                1.25
       Beginning  Jan.  1,  1987                        0.5

Thirdly,  the cumulative application  of  cadmium from sludge does  not  exceed the
following levels:

Soil Cation                        Maximum Cumulative Application (kg/ha)	
Exchange Capacity            Background soil pH*          Background soil pH
   (meg/100  g)                 	<6.5	         	>6.5	

       <5                               55
    5-15                               5                           10
     >15                               5                           20

* If the  pH of  the sludge and soil  mixture  is adjusted to and  maintained at 6.5
  or greater whenever  food  chain  crops are  grown  then the  levels of  the  next
  column are allowed.
The second approach  consists  of  four  requirements.  These requirements are manage-
ment  oriented  rather than providing  specific cadmium levels.  The first require-
ment  is  that  the  only food-chain crop grown  is  animal feed.  Secondly,  the  pH of
the sludge  and soil  mixture  is  6.5  or  greater and  is  maintained at  this  level
during periods when  food-chain crops  are  grown.  Thirdly,  there must be a facility
operating plan which demonstrates how the animal feed will be distributed to pre-
clude ingestion by humans. Measures  required  to safeguard against possible health
hazards  from cadmium entering the  food chain should  be  included in the operating
plan. The  fourth  requirement consists  of notification of  future property owners
by a  stipulation  in  land record  or property  deed  that the  property  has received
sludge at high cadmium  application  rates  and that food chain  crops  should not be
grown.


F.6.d.   Nickel

Recommended maximum  addition levels  of nickel  by sludge  application  to cropland
are shown in Table 9 section F.6.a.   Presently,  toxicity  of nickel to  plants  has


                                        47

-------
only been observed  in  acid soils. If nickel  concentrations  are excessive then pH
adjustment  (upward)  by  lime  addition should lessen the chances of plant damage.


F.6.e.  Copper

Copper is useful  to  plants in small quantities but  can  be  hazardous in excessive
amounts  to  grazing animals  (especially   sheep).  Recommended  maximum  addition
levels by sludge  application to  cropland of copper are shown on Table 9.


F.6.f.  Molybdenum

Very small  amounts  of  molybdenum are necessary  for crop growth.  Plant  damage is
not  likely  but grazing  cattle and  other  animals  are susceptible  to  molybdenum
toxicity.  No  limits have  been  established  at  this  time.  Areas  near  natural
molybdenum  deposits  should be  aware  of  this potential problem.


F.6.g.  Zinc

Small amounts  of  zinc  are necessary for crop growth. Zinc  toxicity  in  plants is
uncommon,  occurring in  acid  soils.  Sheep  and  cattle  are  susceptible  to  zinc
toxicity  at high zinc  concentrations.   If  pH levels  are  maintained at  or  above
6.5, zinc toxicity  should  not  be  a  problem.


F.6.h.  Lead

Maximum recommended  addition levels  of  lead by sludge application to cropland are
shown in Table 9. Toxicity of  lead  to plants is likely  only when the soil/sludge
mixture  pH  is less  than  5.5.  Plant uptake  of  lead is  minimized  by  increased
soil/sludge pH, CEC, and  available  phosphorus (23).

F.7.  SLUDGE APPLICATION  RATES

The actual  sludge application rate  is  determined  based on  the  preceeding analy-
sis. This rate is expressed  in terms of annual  dry weight,  annual  and  daily wet
weights.  With  the  computed  nitrogen additions and  the known  concentration con-
tained  in  the sludge  a  maximum annual dry  application  is determined.  In some
instances this maximum will  be  limited  by heavy metal  limitations.  Usually this
is  only  a  concern  with liquid  sludge  applications  in  humid climates.  The rate
must not  exceed   the evaporation/percolation capability  of  the  site unless pro-
visions are made  for control of  surface  runoff.  To allow ease of acreage computa-
tions any variations in crop nutrient requirements,  the  total sludge application
rate should be computed  for  each crop.  Each  application  has a  limiting factor.
This  factor should  be  determined  early in  the  planning phase  so  that  process
changes  affecting  that  factor  can be  determined.   This  can  result  in  a  major
change  in  site   size  requirements.  The maximum  daily  application with  liquid
sludge is usually determined by  experience  with a  similar soil type.
                                        48

-------
As  discussed  previously annual applications  are usually  limited  by the nitrogen
balance.  Nitrogen  removal rates  should  be equal  to  or greater  than application
rates.  If the sludge  application  rate has been  set by  balancing  nitrogen removal
with application and  the  maximum  annual cadmium is exceeded  with  this rate, then
the rate must be reduced  to  that  allowable by  the  cadmium limitation. Phosphorus
and heavy metals  limitations discussed  previously are generally  maximum cumula-
tive application limits.


F.8.  SITE CONSIDERATIONS

Potential sites  should be  reviewed  for size  and flexibility  for  expansion  or
changing from one  type  of  system  to another. The  following  sections describe the
considerations to  be  included in  the  facilities plan.


F.S.a.  Site Size

The site size is a function  of  the net application area plus buffer area,  future
expansion, replacement  area,  and  emergency sites  for adverse weather conditions.
The site  size can  be  as much as  twice  the  net  application area  depending on the
specific circumstances.

F.8.a.(l)  Application  Area  - The  application  area is determined  as outlined in
later sections.  This  is the  land  that  receives  sludge.  This  area  is sized without
buffer  or replacement  area  considered  and  does  not  include  standby  disposal
areas.  These items  are  added as described  below.

F.S.a.(2)  Wet Weather  Plan  For  Stockpile  Storage or Alternative  Disposal  - The
site  area  requirements should  include  space for  stockpiling dewatered  sludge,
lagooning liquid sludge or  an alternative  disposal system unless  provided  at an
alternative location. The alternative system might consist  of  a  landfill,  trench
disposal, or  a  composting operation.  When  field  conditions  do  not  permit land
application then the  sludge  can be  stored  or  disposed  of  by  an alternate method.

F.S.a.(3)  Buffer  Area  -  Some space may  be  required  to separate  the application
area from neighboring areas.  This  space or  buffer helps  limit public access and
minimizes the chances for nuisance  conditions to develop.  The space required is a
function of  the  application  method,  prevailing wind  velocity, and topography of
the site. Application  by spraying in a  windy  area in  close proximity  to  resi-
dences  might require  a  large buffer area.  Sludge  injection  on level land  should
require very little buffer. The amounts  vary  between  these two extremes.

F.S.a.(4)   Expansion or  Replacement  Area -  If the treatment  plant  capacity  or
treatment level increases, more  sludge will  be  produced  and must  be managed.  If
this  increased  volume  is to  be  applied   to the  land then more  land  will  be
required. An alternative  to  acquiring more  land would be sizing  the application
area for future quantities expected in  the  next 20 years  and apply at lower load-
ing rates until the full  capacity  is  reached.  If application is  accomplished on
privately owned  land then landowner  committments  should  be made  with  increased
quantities accounted  for. When heavy  metals limitations are  reached on a particu-
lar site then an alternative application area must be  found.

                                        49

-------
F.S.b.  Compatibility With  Future  Expansion

Land  application  areas  must be  compatible with projected  future expansions. The
expansion may mean  an  increase in quantity due  to  increased population served by
the plant,  process  modifications or  changes  in constituent  levels.  Any of  these
changes could  cause a  change  in the  area requirements  or  type of  system to be
used.

Changes in  unit  processes  used  can  result in  larger quantities of  sludge, dif-
ferent  chemical  makeup  of  the  sludge,  or a  sludge with  a  different physical
nature or moisture  content.  Larger quantities  of sludge or sludges  of a different
physical or chemical nature can  result from a  variation  in  operation of existing
processes,  replacement  of  a unit process  with  another type  of  process, or  addi-
tion  of new unit  processes  to  meet  more  stringent discharge  standards.   Trans-
portation costs are sensitive  to  the  degree of  dewatering. Variations in dewater-
ing process operations  may  lower  the  volume to  be  hauled. This would also  require
adjustments  at  the  application area.  As  communities grow  there  can often  be
significant  changes in raw sewage constituent  levels.  This  may be  industrially
related or  related  to tourism  increases  or changes  in life styles.  Changes in raw
sewage constituent  levels  will result  in a change in sludge  constituent  levels
thus  requiring adjustments  in land application procedures  or  sludge application
rates.
F.9.  RUNOFF CONTROL

There are two sources of  runoff.  One  is  the  liquid in the sludge and the other is
precipitation falling  on a  sludge application  site.  Runoff control  consists of
containment and/or  treatment of  liquid  from the  site  to prevent  degradation of
nearby  surface  streams.  One of  the  best approaches  to  control  of  liquid  in the
sludge  is  rapid  incorporation  into  the  soil.  Runoff  from adjacent  properties
should  be  diverted around  the  application  site.  On-site  containment  of  liquid
from sludges  or precipitation is  normally provided by  small  impoundments  placed
at  needed  locations  on  the site.  The  contained liquids  can  be recycled  for
further treatment or can  be  reduced  through  evaporation and  percolation or can be
discharged after sufficient  detention time to meet regulatory standards.


F.10.   STORAGE

Storage is  critical for  time  periods when  application  operations are  not  pos-
sible.   These  time  periods may  be several  months  due  to severe  cold weather  con-
ditions or  they  may  be  several  days   due  to   excessive  precipitation.  Storage
requirements should include  provisions for agricultural operations.  If the types
of  crops grown  preclude application  for  certain time periods,  then storage  will
be  required.  Storage is  usually  provided by  lagoons.  Storage  systems must  be
adequately sized and designed  to  minimize the  possibility of nuisance  conditions.
The  storage  requirement will vary  somewhat  depending on application  method.  For
example, dewatered  sludge could be spread on  frozen ground  but  liquid injection
would not be feasible.
                                        50

-------
F.lO.a.  Capacity

Land  requirements  are  based on the type of  land  application system. Agricultural
utilization  systems  are  sized based on application  rate  determinations described
previously.  Dedicated  disposal systems are  sized by operation  constraints,  such
as weather  limitations to  operation,  seasonal limits,  and/or  application equip-
ment  limitations.
F.lO.b.  Odor Control

Odor control is best achieved  by  adequate  stabilization before storage. Odor con-
trol  of partially  stabilized  sludge  is  extremely  difficult.  High  dosages  of
chlorine  or lime  may  help temporarily  but  may not  be  allowed  by  regulatory
authorities. The best control  method  is  backup stabilization processes and proper
operation of stabilization  systems.

Mixing aids in odor  control by preventing layers from  developing in  deep storage
systems which are subject to seasonal  turnover which in turn causes odors. Mixing
can help  maintain  aerobic  conditions  throughout. Aeration  systems are an excel-
lent  means  of  providing odor control  and  additional  stabilization  of  sludge.
These  systems  must  be  very flexible  since  storage  lagoon levels may fluctuate
widely.


F.lO.c.  Drainage or Leachate  Control

Storage lagoons should  be lined  in areas  where groundwater supplies  are  threat-
ened.   More  positive control can  be provided  by drainage  ditches  placed  on  the
outside of  berms  around  the  lagoons.  If  lining is  inadequate, and  groundwater
levels  are  high,   the   leachate  may  be  captured  by  ditches  for   appropriate
treatment.
F.ll.  MONITORING PROGRAM

Monitoring  of  land application  systems is  usually required  by local,  state  or
federal  regulatory  agencies. The  monitoring program  should  meet  these  require-
ments and  provide  information feedback to assure  proper  system operation.   The
degree of  monitoring  will  vary  depending  on  regulatory  agency requirements, type
of crop  grown,  and  sludge  quality. Most land application  monitoring  programs are
primarily  concerned with three  areas  -  subsurface water,  soil,  and  sludge.  In
some  instances  monitoring  of crop tissues  may be  included.  These  programs  are
developed  to prevent  potential  health  hazards  and assure the  production  of high
quality  crops.

The  entire monitoring  program  should  be  summarized  in a  tabulated  form.  This
allows easy  estimating of  staff and  laboratory facility  requirements.  This also
provides a quick check  on all monitoring  results.
                                        51

-------
F.ll.a.  Monitoring Wells  and_Tests

Monitoring  well  requirements vary  depending on local  regulatory  agency require-
ments  and  the depth to  the  water table. As  a minimum  wells  should be  20 to 30
feet deep  or  to  the first impermeable  layer  (if  the layer is  closer  to the sur-
face).  The number of  wells  varies with  site size  and proximity  of  groundwater
aquifers.

The tests  normally  taken at the  wells  are nitrate  concentration,  total coliform
and fecal  coliform  counts and  TDS  concentrations.  Nitrate  concentrations  should
not exceed  10 mg/1. If  background levels  are found to increase significantly then
changes should be made  in  application rates  or cropping methods  before the maxi-
mum allowable levels are reached. If they do  reach  maximum allowable  levels then
adjustments should  be  made  to  the application rates.   If  total  coliforms, fecal
coliforms  or  other measures  are excessive operations should be stopped or  sharply
curtailed  in  the vicinity  of the  failing  test until appropriate actions are taken
to  lower  these  levels.  These  tests  should be  run in  accordance  with  procedures
outlined in Standard Methods (9).


F.11.b.  Soil Tests
The most  common soil  tests  are nitrogen  (all  forms), phosphorus,  potassium, pH
and  the heavy  metals (Zn,  Cn,  Cd,  Ni,  Pb) listed  previously.  Significance of
these  tests  has been  discussed.  The  primary purpose  of  these  tests  is  to check
levels  of  each  constituent in the  soil as  computed or predicted  prior to sludge
application. These  tests  should be run in accordance  with  Methods of Soil Analy-
sis (31) or other standardized  method.


F.ll.c.  Sludge Tests

The most common sludge tests  required are  the same as  the soil  tests plus percent
solids  and percent  volatile solids.  Their  significance  has   been  discussed in
earlier paragraphs. These  tests  should  be  run in accordance with Standard Methods
(9) and/or the Kansas  State  document  (32).


F.ll.d.  Crop Tissue  Analysis

Some  regulatory agencies  may  require a crop analysis of  crops grown  on sludge
amended soils.  These   tests  are  accomplished to  determine  plant  uptake  of heavy
metals. Test  procedures are  found in  the  Kansas manual  (32)  and  the "Official
Methods  of Analysis  of  the  Association  of Official  Analytical Chemists,   1975
(33)
Section G - LANDFILL

Landfill is the  planned  burial of processed sludge at  a  site  designated for this
purpose. The  sludge is  applied to  the  land and  buried  by  applying a  layer  of

                                        52

-------
cover soil  over it.  It  differs from  land-spreading in  that  to be  defined  as a
landfill, the soil  cover must  be  thicker  than the depth of the plow zone (34).

The following sections  deal with various  aspects of landfill  planning.  For  more
detailed  information,  the  reviewer   is   referred  to  Process  Design  Manual;
Municipal Sludge Landfills, EPA Technology Transfer, October 1978 (34).


G.I.  METHOD

There are three  basic methods   of landfill disposal of sludge.  Each  has specific
conditions for application which will  be  discussed.


G.I.a.  Sludge Only Trench Fill

The  sludge  only trench  method involves   excavating  subsurface trenches  so  that
sludge  may   be   buried  entirely  below  the  original  ground   surface.  The  soil
resulting from  the  trenching operation is used as  cover  and  not mixed  with  the
sludge as a bulking agent.  The  sludge  is  dumped directly into the trench from  the
haul  vehicle  and generally  covered the  day  it is  received.  Trench  disposal is
most  appropriate for  unstabilized or poorly  stabilized sludges; the  frequency of
cover reduces the odors generally associated  with these types of sludge.

G.l.a.(l)  Narrow Trench  - Narrow trenches are defined as having  widths  of  less
than  10  ft.  This   method  is  generally  used  for  sludges  with solids  contents
ranging  from 15 to 28 percent.  The application  rate  is  1,200 to  5,600 cu yd
sludge/ac. Excavated  material  is  usually used  immediately to  cover  an adjacent
sludge-filled trench. The  soil  cover thickness  is between 3 and 4 ft.

The main advantage  of the  narrow  trench method  is  that  it  is  suitable for sludge
with  a relatively low solids  content.  The primary  disadvantage of  this method is
that  it is land-intensive  because of the  low  application rates.

G.I.a.(2)  Wide Trench - Wide  trenches used for  sludge disposal have widths of
greater than  10  ft.  Material which  is  excavated from  the  trenches  is stockpiled
neatly and used  as  cover for that trench.  The method is suitable for sludges with
solids contents  of  20 percent   or greater  (34). The  application rates range  from
3,200  to  14,500 cu yd sludge/ac.   The  cover  thickness  depends on  the  type of
equipment used  at  the landfill. For land-based  equipment,  3  to 4 ft  of cover is
sufficient,  however for sludge-based equipment, 4 to 5 ft of cover is  required.

When  compared  to narrow trench operations,  the wide  trench  method  has  two  dis-
tinct advantages.  It  is less  land-intensive, and  liners  can be used  to  contain
sludge moisture, thus protecting  the groundwater from contamination,  thereby per-
mitting deeper  excavation.  The primary disadvantage  of  the  wide trench method is
the need for a sludge with  a solids content  greater  than  20  percent. However, if
it is too high  (greater than 32 percent)  the  sludge will not spread evenly.
                                        53

-------
G.l.b.  Sludge Only Area  Fill

With  sludge  only area fill,  sludge is usually  mixed  with soil  and  placed above
the  original ground  surface.  It requires  substantial amounts  of  imported soil,
but  is  suitable  in areas where  the groundwater is shallow  or  bedrock prevails.
This  method  is  best  suited  for  well stabilized sludge  since daily  cover is not
usually provided.  Liners can  be used  to  protect  the groundwater,  and  adequate
drainage  and run-off  control  are  necessary to prevent   contamination  of nearby
surface waters.

G.I.b.(1)    Mound  -  Area  fill  mound  applications  are   generally  suitable  for
stabilized sludges  with solids  content  greater than  20  percent.   Soil  is mixed
with  the  sludge  to provide  bulk  and stability before  it  is  hauled to the  filling
area. At  the  filling  area,  the mixture is  placed in 6 ft mounds and then  covered
with  3 to 5  ft of soil. A level  area is  required for disposal, however  the use  of
earthen containment structures can  permit disposal  in hilly areas.

G.l.b.(2)    Layer  -  Area  fill  layer applications are  suitable  for   stabilized
sludge with  solids as low as  15  percent.  Soil is mixed with the sludge, either  at
the  filling  area or  at a special mixing  area.   The sludge/soil  mixture is spread
in even layers 0.5 to 3.0 ft  thick. Interim cover  is  0.5 to  1 ft thick and final
cover 2 to 4  ft  thick.  Although  level ground is preferred for this operation,  it
is possible  to execute  it on mildly sloping terrain.

G.1.b.(3)  Diked Containment  -  To  be suitable  for  diked  containment, sludge must
have  a solids content oiT at least 20 percent. This method is suitable  for either
stabilized or unstabilized  sludge.   If  the  disposal site  is  level,  earthen dikes
are  used  on  all  four  sides  of  the containment area. As an alternative to  this,  if
the  site  is  at the toe  of a hill, only a partial dike will be required. Depending
on the  type  of  equipment  being  used,  the interim cover  will  vary from  1  to  3  ft
and  the  final cover  from 3 to  5 ft.  Although   diked  containment  is  an efficient
disposal  method  from  the  point  of view of  land  use,  it  does  necessitate  controls
to prevent localized  contamination  from leachates.


G.l.c.  Co-disposal With  Refuse

When  sludge   is  disposed  of at  a  refuse  landfill,  it  is  termed  co-disposal.
There are distinct  trade-offs in using  this method  rather than  the  sludge  only
methods.  These are presented  in  detail in reference 34.

The  two techniques for  disposing of sludge in this manner are to mix it  with the
refuse or to  mix it with  soil.

G.l.c.(l)    Sludge/Refuse  Mixture  -  Stabilized or   unstabilized  sludge  with  a
solids content  of  3  percent or  greater  can be   mixed  with refuse and landfilled.
The  sludge is applied to the working  face  of the  landfill on top  of the  refuse.
The  two are  thoroughly mixed before  being  spread,  compacted and covered.  Interim
cover is  0.5 to 1.0  ft  and final  cover,  2  ft. Application  rates  are  low,  gen-
erally  ranging  from  500  to  4,200   cu  yd  sludge/ac.  The  appropriate   regulatory
agencies  should  be  consulted for their requirements  on  the disposal of unstabil-
ized  sludge  by this method.

                                        54

-------
G. I.e.(2)   Sludge/Soil Mixture- With  this operation,  sludge is  mixed  with soil
and used as cover for  a  refuse  landfill.  The  procedure requires stabilized  sludge
with  at  least  20 percent  solids.  One of  the  clear advantages of  this  method is
that  it  promotes growth  of vegetation areas  without  the  use of  fertilizer.  It
does,  however,  have  the  potential  for  causing odors  since  the sludge  is not
completely buried.


G.2.  SITE SELECTION

Site  selection is a critical  process  in the planning  of  a  sludge landfill.  It is
directly related  to the  method  of  ultimate disposal. The site ultimately selected
must  be suitable  for the  type of  sludge to be disposed  of  and situated  in  a con-
venient, yet unobtrusive,  location.

The first step in selecting a  landfill site is  to  establish  the  study area. This
is  most  easily  defined  by  determining   a  maximum  economical  haul  distance.
Unsuitable  locations   such as  populated   or  clearly  inaccessible areas,  can  be
readily eliminated.

The site selection should  be made  by  an iterative process in which numerous  eval-
uation  steps  are made.  The methodology  for  performing  this analysis  will vary
from  project to project.  Numerical rating  systems can be helpful in assessing the
relative  merits  of  prospective  sites.  A  suggested   procedure   for  assessment,
screening and final site  selection is  presented  in  reference 34.


G.2.a.  Identify  Potential Sites

The number of potential  sites  will depend on the local  conditions,  the  method of
disposal,  and  the  characteristics  of  the  sludge  being   disposed   of.  Several
distinct options  should  be considered  in  the  evaluation.

Given a variety of potential  landfill  sites,  it  may be possible to eliminate cer-
tain  of them early in  the  planning process.  Considerations such as size, terrain,
location, subsurface conditions and economics may  be  used  in the initial screen-
ing process.


G.2.b.  Public Participation Program

In the  long run,  active  public participation will  insure the ultimate acceptance
of  the  landfill  program.  Public  participation in  the decision-making  process
should be initiated early in  the planning stages to avoid  unnecessary and  costly
delays.

The public participation program must be  tailored  to  suit  the particular project
and  the  community which  it is  to  serve.  Public meetings,  workshops, mass  media
publicity, etc. all serve to  increase the  public's understanding of  the proposed
project and provide the  opportunity  for people to contribute to the project.
                                        55

-------
Chapter  2  of reference  34  addresses  the  objectives, formation  and  execution of
public participation  programs  for  sludge landfill projects.


G.2.c.   Technical Considerations

Numerous  technical  considerations  must be  reviewed as  part  of the  final site
selection  process.   These  are  briefly  discussed  below.   Additional  information
regarding  them can  be  found in  reference 34.

G.2.c.(l)   Haul  Distance -  The minimum distance  over  level terrain  will  be the
most  favorable  haul  condition.  Transport through areas  with  low populations is
preferable   to   transport  through  high  density  urban   areas   with  congested
traffic.

G.2.c.(2)   Site  Life and Size  -  The  site life  and size are  directly related to
the quantity and characteristics  of the sludge and  the method  used  for landfill-
ing.  Since  the entire site  cannot  be  used as  fill area,  both  the gross  area and
the  usable  or   fill  area  must  be  considered   in  determining   the  site  size.
Initially,  the  life  of  the site  can be  roughly estimated.  As  the  landfill  is
used,  the  expected  life  should  be re-evaluated  to  insure  adequate  capacity for
future operations.

G.2.c.(3)   Topography - In  general,  sludge  landfilling is  limited  to sites with
at  least  1  percent  slope  and no  more  than  20  percent  slope. Perfectly flat
terrain  tends to result  in  ponding  while fill  on steep  slopes can erode.

G.2.c.(4)   Surface  and Groundwater  -  The location and extent of surface waters in
the vicinity of  the landfill  can  be  a  significant  factor  in  the selection pro-
cess. Existing surface  waters  and  drainage  near proposed  sites  should  be  mapped
and their  present  and proposed uses  outlined. Surface leachate  control  measures
(collection  and  treatment)  may  be  required as  part of the  landfill design.

Data  on  the  groundwaters  in the vicinity of  potential landfill sites is essential
in  the selection process. Characteristics such  as the depth  to  groundwater, the
hydraulic  gradient,  the quality and  use of  the  groundwater and  the  location  of
recharge zones are  essential in determining  the suitability of  a landfill site.
Such  information should be   collected  during  the  facility  planning stage  and  in
advance  of  the final  decision-making  process.

G.2.c.(5)   Soils and  Geology - Soil plays an  important role  in  sludge  landfill-
ing.  The properties of  the  soil such as texture,  structure,  permeability,  pH and
cation exchange  capacity,  as  well  as  the  characteristics  of  its  formation  may
influence  the  selection of   the  landfill site.  The  geology of possible  landfill
sites should  be  thoroughly  examined  to  identify any faults, major  fractures and
joint sets.  The  possibility of  aquifer contamination through irregular formations
must  be  studied.

G.2.c.(6)   Vegetation -  The type  and  quantity  of  vegetation  at and around  the
proposed landfill  sites  should  be considered in  the evaluation. Vegetation can
serve as a  natural  buffer,  reducing noise,  odor and  other  nuisances.  At  the same


                                        56

-------
time, clearing  a  site  of timber or  other heavy vegetation  can  add significantly
to the initial  project costs.

G.2.c.(7)   Environmentally Sensitive  Areas -  There  are presently  five environ-
mentally sensitive areas  included  in the  "Classification Criteria for Solid Waste
Disposal Facilities."  (34,  29) These  include  wetlands, flood plains,  permafrost
areas, critical habitats  of endangered species, and recharge zones of sole source
aquifers.  These should  be  avoided  if  at all  possible when  a  landfill  site  is
selected.

G.2.c.(8)  Archaeological and Historical  Significance  - The  archaeological  and/
or historical  significance  of proposed  sites   should  be determined early  in the
evaluation process. Any  finds of significance  at the  selected site must be accom-
modated prior to final approval and  construction.

G.2.c.(9)   Site Access - Haul  routes should  utilize major  highways,  preferably
those with a minimum of  traffic  during  normal transport hours.  Proposed routes
should be  studied to determine  impacts on local use  and  the  potential  effects  of
possible accidents.

G.2.c.(10)   Land  Use  - Zoning, restrictions  and future  development  of potential
sites should be considered  in the  selection  process.  Ideally, the sludge landfill
should be  located on land considered unsuitable for higher  uses.


G.3.   LEACHATE  CONTROLS

It is essential  that surface  and  groundwater supplies  be protected from landfill
leachate.  The primary  sources  of  leachate are  the  moisture  in the  sludge itself
and storm  water infiltration.  Careful  site  selection is the first step  in  con-
trolling leachate; there  are also  design features  which  can  reduce the potential
for contamination by leachates.


G.3.a.  Adequate Surface  Drainage

Providing  adequate  surface  drainage  is  the first  step in  controlling leachate.
Ideally,  the landfill  site  should   be   on  slightly  sloping land so  there  is
natural drainage. Storm water runoff  should  be  diverted around the landfill.


G.3.b.  Natural Attenuation

Contaminants  in landfill leachate can naturally attenuate  as they pass  through
the  soil.  The  mechanisms  by  which   this  occurs and the  potential for  natural
attenuation  should  be   examined  before   artificial  controls   are  planned  or
designed.
                                        57

-------
G.3.c.  Containment

Clay  soils  can  be  used to provide  an adequate barrier  against  leachate contami-
nation of groundwaters.  In some cases  enough  of  this material  will be available
at the landfill  site,  while  in  other  cases importation will be necessary. The use
of soils as  landfill  liners  or additives  is site-specific and  must be evaluated
on an individual basis.  Membrane  liners  may be  useful at  area fills  and wide
trench  application areas.  Although  soil  liners  are  preferable,  polymeric  and
asphaltic materials have  proven to be effective. The  final selection of landfill
liners will  depend  on on  the  specific characteristics  of  the  site.  If leachate
containment  is  necessary at  the  landfill  site,  collection and  treatment facili-
ties  must  be provided. An underdrain or  tile collection system  is  effective in
routing  the leachate  to  a  sump  or  storage area.   Several  methods  of  treatment
should be  evaluated.  Alternatives  include discharge to  a  local sewage treatment
plant,  recycle  through the  landfill, evaporation  of  the  leachate  in collection
ponds or on-site treatment.  The ultimate  method chosen will  depend on the indi-
vidual characteristics of  the landfill  method  and  site.
G.4  GAS CONTROL

Methane  and carbon  dioxide  gas  are  products  of  the  decomposition  of  organic
matter in sludge. The  gas  production depends on the  type  and quantity of sludge,
the type of  landfill  and the moisture present.  Although both  of  these gases are
odorless, methane can  be explosive in confined  areas. Gas controls  are  not con-
sidered necessary in isolated areas  or if  the  landfill is isolated from inhabited
areas. However,  gas  control  measures  will be  necessary  if  the landfill  is near
any populated area.

Possible gas  control  measures include  permeable  and  impermeable  methods  and gas
extraction.  Permeable  methods involve installing  a gravel-filled  trench  outside
the fill area. Migrating gas  is  intercepted and vented  to  the  atmosphere.  A bar-
rier of low  permeability material can be  used  around the perimeter  of the  land-
fill to minimize  lateral gas migration. A  compacted  clay layer about  2  ft  thick
is adequate  in most cases.  Synthetic  materials  may also  be considered as possible
barriers to  migrating  gas.  Gas extraction, with or without methane recovery, has
been initiated at some refuse landfills.  It is not suitable  for  sludge landfills
since they do not permit free movement of  gas  and  are not ordinarily large enough
to make such systems economically  justifiable.


G.5.  RUNOFF CONTROL

Factors of concern are  similar to  those  discussed  in  F.9.
G.6.  MONITORING

A preliminary  monitoring schedule  should  be determined  as  part of  the  facility
planning process. This  should  include, but not necessarily  be  limited to, staff-
ing requirements, leachate,  runoff, gas, and soil  analyses,  groundwater  observa-
tion wells and general  operational  record  keeping  and reporting procedures.

                                        58

-------
Once  the  landfill  is  operating,  the  monitoring  program should  be  revised  to
reflect  changes in  the  original  plan.


Section  H  - COMBUSTION

Combustion processes  are not  disposal  methods but are volume and weight reduction
methods.  A residue (ash)  will remain  which  must  be  disposed  of  by  one  of the
three  basic  disposal  techniques: land  application, landfill, or  off-site  use by
others.  The  weight and volume  reduction  can  be  of  great  value  where land  is
scarce.  In planning ultimate  disposal  methods for  ashes,  it  must  be  kept  in mind
that their physical and chemical characteristics  differ  substantially from  those
of uncombusted sludge.

The efficiency of the sludge  dewatering system (Table 10) is of  key importance in
determining  the  feasibility  of  the  incineration  process.  As  can  be  seen from
Figure 3,  the amount  of heat  (auxiliary fuel) required to sustain continuous com-
bustion  is  dependent  on  the   solids  content   of   the  sludge  entering  the
incinerator.

	TABLE 10.  TYPICAL SLUDGE DEWATERING PERFORMANCES  (7)	
                                                 Sludge Cake Solids (%)         ~
                                                                         Bowl
          Type of sludge     	Vacuum filter   Filter press  Centrifuge
Raw primary
Anaerobically digested primary
Primary & trickling filter humus
Pirmary & air activated
Primary & oxygen activated
Digested primary & air activated
25-38
25-32
20-30
16-25
20-28
14-22
45-50
45-50
45-50
45-50
45-50
45-50
23-35
28-35
20-30
15-30
-
15-30
H.1.  METHOD

The basic methods of combusting  sludge  are  described below.

H.I.a.  Incineration

Incineration  is  the  burning of the volatile  fraction  of the sludge  in  the pres-
ence of excess air.  Incineration is a two-step process  involving  drying and com-
bustion. Adequate fuel,  air,  time, temperature, and turbulence  are  necessary for
a complete  reaction.  The  drying  step  should  not  be  confused with  preliminary
dewatering, which  is  usually  by mechanical  means and precedes  the  incineration
process in most  systems.  When a sludge with  a  moisture  content of about  75 per-
cent is delivered to  the incinerators, the  heat  required to evaporate  the water
nearly balances  the available  heat  from combustion of  the dry solids.  Heat values
of sludges are summarized in Table  4.
                                        59

-------
g
O

g
O
(U
cc

5
O
u
cc

t-

Ul
                     20
                                  40
60
                                                             80
                      SLUDGE SOLIDS, % by weight
   Figure  3.   Heat required  to sustain  combustion of  sludge.

-------
Drying and  combustion may be done in  separate units or  successively in the same
unit.  Manufacturers  have  developed diversified  types  of  equipment  such  as  the
multiple hearth furnace  and  the  fluidized bed incinerator.

H.l.a.(l)   Multiple Hearth - A  typical multiple  hearth incinerator  is  shown in
Figure 4  and consists  of a circular  steel  shell  surrounding a  number  of  solid
refractory  hearths  and  a  central    rotating shaft  to  which  rabble  arms  are
attached. The operating capacity of these  furnaces is  related  to the total area
of the enclosed hearths.  They  are designed with  diameters  ranging from 54 inches
to 21 feet, 6 inches, with  four  to  eleven hearths.  The upper hearths  are the dry-
ing zone where moisture  is  evaporated  and driven off as steam, the middle hearths
are the combustion zone where  the volatile  portion of  the  sludge is burned,  and
the lower hearths  are the ash-cooling  zone.

Sludge enters the  incinerator  at the  top  and is  raked  by  the  rabble arms alter-
nately outward  and inward, as shown,  to the  entrance  of the  next  hearth below.
The rabble  arms serve  the multiple functions of  moving  the sludge  through  the
furnace,   forming   furrows  in  the sludge  layer  on  the hearth  to  maximize  the
exposed surface area, breaking up the  sludge, and  agitating the sludge to insure
complete combustion.

Combustion  air  enters  the  incinerator at  the bottom  gaining heat  from cooling
ash in the  cooling  zone  and  from burning sludge  in the  combustion zone, and giv-
ing up heat to evaporate  water from  sludge  in the drying zone.

H.I.a.(2)   Fluidized  Bed  - A typical fluidized bed incinerator is shown in Figure
5. The fluidized bed  incinerator is  a  vertical cylindrical  vessel with a grid in
the lower  section  to support a  sandbed.  Dewatered sludge  is  injected  above  the
grid and combustion air  flows upward at a pressure  of 3.5  to 5.0 psig and fluid-
izes  the  mixture  of  hot  sand  and  sludge.  Supplemental  fuel can be  supplied  by
burners above or below  the  grid.  In  essence,  the reactor is a single  chamber unit
where both  moisture  evaporation  and combustion  occur at 1,400  to 1,500°F in  the
sandbed.  All  the  combustion gases pass  through the  1,500°F  combustion zone with
residence  times of several seconds. Ash  is  carried  out the  top  with combustion
exhaust and is  removed  by air  pollution control  devices. The heat reservoir pro-
vided by  the  sandbed enables reduced  start-up times when  the unit  is  shut down
for relatively  short  periods (overnight). As an  example, a  unit  can be operated
four to eight hours a day  with little  reheating when restarting.

H.I.a.(3)   Cyclonic  Reactors  and   Electric  Incinerators  -  Horizontal  cyclonic
reactors  are  intended  primarily for  use  at  small wastewater  treatment  plants.
They are  usually available as  skid-mounted packaged  systems,  requiring a minimum
of field installation.  High  velocity air  is  preheated and introduced  tangentially
into a cylindrical combustion chamber,  providing combustion  air  and heating  the
reactor walls. Sludge is  sprayed radially toward the heated walls and is immedi-
ately caught up in  the  rapid cyclonic  flow.  Combustion  takes place before sludge
can adhere  to  the  reactor walls.  The ash   is removed  from  the  reactor  by  the
cyclonic flow of air  and  gases.

The  vertical  cyclonic  reactor  is   more  suited  to larger  plants.   The  vertical
cyclonic reactor has  a  rotating  hearth and a single  fixed  plow.  Preheated sludge
enters the  reactor at the  outer  edge and  is  plowed toward the center where ash is

                                        61

-------
                                     COOLING AIR DISCHARGE
  FLUE GASES OUT
  DRYING ZONE
  COMBUSTION  ZONE
  COOLING ZONE
  ASH DISCHARGE
                                                        SLUDGE INLET
                                                         ^
                                                        RABBLE ARM AT
                                                        EACH HEARTH
                                                      ^-COMBUSTION
                                                        AIR RETURN
                                                        RABBLE ARM
                                                          DRIVE
              COOLING AIR FAN
Figure  4.  Cross section of  a typical multiple hearth incinerator.(7)
                                 62

-------
                   Sight glass-
Exhaust
Access doors-
     \"ea-:v:-VarXv«i':v'c*X'"d*>yt*:
1   ifflMMfalffi
               ....
           lU£
                                               • Preheat burner
                                                •Thermocouple
                                              Sludge Inlet
                                               . Fluidlzlng
                                               air inlet
    Figure 5 .  Cross section of a fluid bed reactor.  (7)
                         63

-------
removed.  Combustion  air  is  introduced  tangentially  at   high  velocity,  which
results  in  a swirling motion  over the  top  of  the burning  sludge.  This provides
needed  turbulence and, together  with  sludge agitation  by  plowing,  promotes com-
plete combustion.  Hot  gases  leave the  cyclone through a top conical outlet  in  the
center. Neither  type of  reactor  is in  common use in the U.S.

The electric  incinerator uses infrared  heat to raise sludge  temperatures   to  the
ignition  point.  Sludge is moved  through the incinerator  on a  conveyor belt.   It
passes  through a  drying  zone in  which  hot gases from the combustion zone, flowing
countercurrent  to the  sludge, dry the sludge.   The  sludge   then  passes  through a
combustion  zone   where   a  battery  of  infrared   lamps   heat  it  to  ignition
temperatures.  Combustion  air  enters  in  the combustion  zone.   Ash  is   discharged
into a  hopper at  the end  of  the  conveyor.

H.l.b.  Pyrolysis

Pyrolysis is  a  process in which  organic  material  is decomposed at  high tempera-
ture  in an  oxygen-deficient  environment.   The  action,  causing  an  irreversible
chemical change,  produces  three  types  of products: gas,  tar (oil) and char  (solid
residue).  Water  vapor is  also   produced,   usually  in  relatively large  amounts
depending  on the initial  moisture content of  the  materials  being   pyrolyzed.
Residence time,  temperature  and  pressure in the reactor are controlled  to produce
various  combinations  and compositions   of  the products.   Two  general  types   of
pyrolysis process  may  be used. The  first,  true pyrolysis,  involves  applying  all
required  heat externally  to the  reaction  chamber.  The  other,  sometimes   called
partial combustion and gasification  or starved  air combustion,  involves the addi-
tion of small amount of  air  or oxygen  directly  into the reactor.  The oxygen sus-
tains combustion  of a  portion  of  the reactor contents which in turn  produces  the
heat required to  dry and  pyrolyze the  remainder of the contents.

Pyrolysis of municipal refuse  and of sewage sludge has been considered  as a means
for ultimate  disposal  of wastes   for several  years  (35,  36, 37,  38).  The results
of various studies and pilot programs  indicate   that  if  the  moisture  content of a
sludge  is below  70 to  75 percent, enough heat  can be generated  by  combustion   of
the oil and  gases produced  from  the  pyrolysis  of sludge  for   the process  to   be
thermally sustaining.  Pyrolysis   of municipal refuse, and combinations  of   refuse
and wastewater  sludges  will provide  energy in excess  of  that required  in   the
pyrolytic process  (36, 37).

Laboratory,  pilot and demonstration systems with wastewater  sludges   have been
tested  but no full-scale  systems  are in  operation.  Therefore,  data presented must
be considered preliminary.  Pyrolysis systems are  in  the  developmental   stages  and
additional information will  become available as  research and development work  and
the operation of  full-scale  plants progresses.

Pyrolysis appears  to have  several advantages over  incineration. For example, some
pyrolysis processes  can  convert   wastes  to  storable, transportable fuels  such   as
fuel gas  or  oil  while  incineration only  produces  heat that must  be  converted   to
steam.  Pyrolysis  can  give  a 50   percent  greater reduction  in  volume  of  residue
over  incineration and the  residue is   a  more readily usable by-product.   Air
                                        64

-------
pollution  is  not  as  severe a problem  in  pyrolysis systems because  the  volume of
stack gases and the quantity  of  particulates  in the stack gases are less.

On the  other  hand,  pyrolysis is  still in the  developmental  stage and,  with  few
exceptions, viable  commercial  systems are  not  readily available.  Most  of  the
pyrolytic  fuel  gases  have  relatively  low heat  values and the pyrolytic  oil  is
corrosive, requiring it to  be mixed with  other  fuel oil for best results.

The  construction  and  operating  costs  for most pyrolysis  systems are  much  more
uncertain  than  for  incineration.  Reliable cost  data  for  pyrolysis  systems  will
not  be  available until  significant operating  experience  is   developed  from  the
ongoing and planned demonstration  projects.

H.l.b.(l)  Multiple Hearth -  Research  and development  work has been conducted on
using multiple  hearth  furnaces, similar  in  design to  conventional  sludge incin-
erators,  for  pyrolysis of  wastewater  sludges  mixed  with municipal  solid wastes
(39). Shredded  and  classified solid wastes  and dewatered  sludge  are fed  to  the
furnace either  in a mixture or  separately, with  the  wetter sludge  fed  higher in
the  furnace.   Recirculated   hot   shaft   cooling   air   and  supplemental  outside
combustion air are fed to  the lower  hearths  to sustain  partial combustion of  the
wastes  circulating  down   through  the  furnace.  Fuel  gas  produced  through  the
pyrolysis  reaction  is  then  burned  in  a   high  temperature  afterburner.   The
resulting heat can be used  in a waste  heat boiler  to  produce  high pressure steam.
It may  also be  possible to  burn  the fuel gases  directly in a  boiler.  Char  from
the  process is  not  used,  but because it  has  some  fuel value  it may  be  usable as
an industrial fuel.

The  multiple  hearth process offers the following  advantages:   (1) usable in  much
smaller plants  than most  other  pyrolysis systems,  (2) employs modifications  of
well developed sludge incineration equipment,  (3)  produces  high temperature gases
without raising  temperatures  in the solid  phase   to  the  slagging point,  and  (4)
conversion from existing conventional  sludge  incineration systems  is a relatively
simple procedure. Disadvantages  include:  (1)  fuel value of the char  is  not used,
(2)  high  temperature  fuel gases  must  be used  on-site, and  (3)  incoming  solid
wastes must be well classified.

H. l.b.(2)  Other  Processes -  There are several proprietary processes for pyroly-
sis  of  solid  wastes,  including  sewage  sludge.  Several of  these  processes  are
listed below.

     •    Landgard - Monsanto Envirochem  Systems,  Inc.
     •    Occidental Process  - Occidental Research Corp.
     •    Purox - Union Carbide Corp.
     •    Torrax  - Carborundum Environmental  Systems,  Inc.
H. I.e.  Wet Air Oxidation

The wet air oxidation  (WAO) process  is  based on the fact that any substance capa-
ble of burning can  be  oxidized in aqueous form at  temperatures  between 250°F and
700°F  at   elevated  pressures.  Wet  air  oxidation  does  not  require  preliminary
                                        65

-------
dewatering  or  drying as required  by conventional combustion  processes.  However,
the oxidized ash must  be separated from the water by vacuum filtration, centrifu-
gation,  or  some other solids  separation  technique.  Air pollution  is minimized
because  the oxidation  takes  place  in  water at  low  temperatures and  no  flyash,
dust,  sulfur dioxide or nitrogen  oxides  are formed.  A  typical  wet  air oxidation
process  is  shown in  Figure  6.  Sludge is ground to a  controlled  particle  size and
pumped  to a pressure of 150-3,000 psig.  Compressed  air is  added to  the  sludge,
the mixture is brought  to a  temperature  of  about   675°F  by heat  exchange with
treated  sludge and direct  steam injection,  and then  is  processed (cooked) in the
reactor  at  the  desired temperature and  pressure.   The hot  oxidized sludge  is
cooled  by heat  exchange with the  incoming  sludge.  The  treated  sludge is  settled
from the supernatant  before  the dewatering step.  Gases released at the separation
step are passed  through a  catalytic afterburner  at  650 to 750°  or  deodorized by
other  means.  In some cases  these  gases have  been  returned  through  the  diffused
air system  in the aeration  basins  for  deodorization.


H.l.d.  Co-Disposal with Solid  Waste

Co-disposal of  sludge with municipal  solid waste has been proposed  or practiced
for most incineration and  pyrolysis  techniques.  Relative to  combustion  process,
co-disposal can take  one of  two forms:

     •    Combustion  of the  entire combined sludge  and solid waste streams.

     •    Use  of  classified  and  shredded  solid  waste  as  a  fuel to  the  extent
          required to make  difficult-to-burn sludges  autogenous.

H.2.  MASS  BALANCE

The calculation of the  expected flow of mass into and out of  the combustion pro-
cess  will   aid  in  establishing its  effectiveness  and  its  economics. The  mass
balance calculation must be  performed  in  conjunction  with the energy balance dis-
cussed  later in  this  section.  The mass of  inputs to the combustion  process must
equal  the mass of outputs.  (See Appendix  C  for  sample calculation).


H.2.a.  Inputs

     •    Dry  Solids in Sludge - The  mass of  dry   solids  in sludge  is  usually
          expressed  as  tons  per day and  may be estimated directly  or calculated
          from the wet  sludge production  and concentration.

     •    Moisture in Sludge -  The mass of  water  in  the  sludge,  usually expressed
          as tons per day, may  be  calculated from estimated  or actual sludge pro-
          duction and  concentration. The  moisture will  have  a significant  impact
          on the energy balance due to the energy  required to heat  and  vaporize
          the water.

     •    Air - The  quantity of air  (or oxygen  in some processes) introduced into
          the combustion process  is  usually expressed in tons per day or  scfm.  In
          combustion  processes  a  certain  theoretical  (stoichiometric)   oxygen

                                        66

-------
Sludge
         GRINDER
     AIR COMPRESSOR
       To disposal
                                   GROUND SLUDGE
                                   HOLDING TANK
   HEAT
 EXCHANGER
                           PUMP
                                       DISPLACEMENT
                                        SLUDGE PUMP
P
                                                     PCV
                          FILTER
                                           PUMP
                  REACTOR


               Exhaust gas
                                                                        VAPOR
                                                                      COMBUSTION
                                                                         UNIT
                                                                  Treated
                                                                  boiler
                                                                  water
                                                                           BOILER
                 Figure 6.  Wet air oxidation  system schematic. (7)

-------
          demand  (THOD)  must  be  met  for complete  combustion.  In  actual incin-
          erators,  however,  it is not  possible to  completely  combine  the avail-
          able  oxygen  with the combustible  materials.  A certain  quantity of air
          in  excess of the  theoretical  requirements must  be provided  to assure
          complete  combustion. It must  also be kept in  mind that  oxygen is not
          the  only  (or even the  principle)  constituent of  air.  The introduction
          of  excess air should be minimized as it has  the  effect  of reducing the
          burning temperature  and increasing  heat  losses from the  reactor.  This
          will  have a  great  effect on  the  energy  balances  as shown in  Figure 7.
          The  excess  air  requirements  of the  combustion process  are empirically
          derived values  which vary from  20  to  100 percent,  depending  on the
          installation. If a process  has an  approximate excess air  requirement of
          20  percent (typical  for a  fluidized  bed  reactor)  and a theoretical oxy-
          gen demand of 200 tons/day,  the actual  air requirement  would be:

          q =  (200  tons 02/day) (1.2  total air	)/(0.23 mass of oxygen)
                                      theoretical  air         mass of air

            =   1,040 tons  air/day
                    or
               19,300 scfm  air

Pyrolysis processes are operated  with  deficient,  rather than excess air. The cal-
culation  of  air  requirements  would  be  the  same  as  above  except  the  ratio  of
actual to theoretical  air  would be less than one.

     •    Auxiliary Fuel - The mass  of  auxiliary  fuel required will depend on the
          energy  calculation and  on  the auxiliary fuel  selected.

     •    Makeup  Sand - Makeup  sand  will  be  required to  replace  sand  lost  in
          fluidized bed reactors.

     •    Steam -  Steam is  often injected  into  wet  air  oxidation  reactors  to
          begin or  sustain the reaction.


H.2.b. Outputs

     •    Ash - Ash is the non-combustible, sterile residue  of  the incineration
          or  wet  air oxidation process.

     •    Combustible  Gas  -  The  principal  product  of  pyrolysis  is  a combustible
          gas containing several  gaseous hydrocarbons and other gases.

     •    Tar  - Tar,   or oil,  is   the  combustible liquid residue  of  a  pryolysis
          process.

     •    Char  -  Char  is the solid residue of  the  pyrolysis process.

     •    Water -   Water is  discharged from the process  as  water  vapors in stack
          gases,  in the liquid effluent  of  the wet  air  oxidation  process, and as
          a  contaminant  in  pyrolytic  tar  and  combustible  gas.  The sources  of

                                        68

-------
    10.0
     8.0
ig
"5
w
X
tJ
3
£
c
o
     6.0
HI
D
u.
4.0
     2.0
     0.0
                       20
                                      40
                                                     60
                                                                   80
                                                                                 100
                                     EXCESS AIR, percent
            Assumptions:
               Solids:  30%
               exhaust Temp:  1500°F
               Volatilcs:  70V,
                Figure 7.   Impact  of excess air on the amount of
                             auxiliary fuel for  sludge  incineration.
                                        69

-------
          water  in  the process  discharge are,  moisture in  the  incoming sludge,
          the combination  of  the  hydrogen fraction of sludge solids and auxiliary
          fuel with oxygen, and  steam supplied to the wet air oxidation process.

     •    Carbon Dioxide  - Carbon dioxide  is  the result of  the  complete combus-
          tion of the  carbon  fraction of  sludge solids and  auxiliary fuel.

     •    Carbon Monoxide  - Carbon monoxide is a toxic product of incomplete com-
          bustion. Its  presence  indicates insufficient excess air.

     •    Sulfur Dioxide - Sulfur dioxide is the combustion product of the sulfur
          fraction of  the  sludge  solids and  auxiliary fuel.

     •    Nitrogen -  Nitrogen consists of the  combustion product of the nitrogen
          fraction of  the  sludge  solids   and that portion of the theoretical com-
          bustion  air  which  is  not  involved  in  combustion  (approximately  79
          percent).

     •    Sand -  In  fluidized bed reactors  a  certain portion of  the  bed  sand is
          carried away  with the  fly  ash.

     •    Excess Air  - The excess air quantity discharged is  the  percent excess
          air supplied  to  the process.


H.3.  ENERGY BALANCE

The energy  balance,  together  with the mass  balance, provides the  basic  data for
determining  the  cost-  and energy-effectiveness  of  the  combustion  process.   The
total input and output  of  the combustion  process must be equal.


H.3.a.  Inputs

     •    Solids Heat  of Combustion  - The solids heat of combustion is the energy
          released by  the  oxidation  of the  combustible fraction of the sludge.

     •    Auxiliary Fuel  Heat of Combustion,  Including Afterburner -  The  auxil-
          iary fuel heat  of  combustion is  the  energy released by  the  burning  of
          auxiliary fuels  in  the  reactor, in an afterburner,  or in a wet air oxi-
          dation steara  generator.

H.3.b.  Outputs

     •    Latent  heat  of  moisture  - That  heat  required  to  just  vaporize  the
          moisture with no effect on its  temperature.

     •    The sensible  heat of  the stack gases  - That heat which  is  required  to
          raise those  gases to  respective temperatures at  the  point  of exit from
          the air pollution control  equipment.
                                        70

-------
     •    The sensible  heat  of the stack gases  - That heat  which  is required  to
          raise  those gases  to respective temperatures  at  the point of exit from
          the air pollution  control  equipment.

     •    Sensible heat of ash -  Heat  required  to raise the ash or wet air oxida-
          tion effluent,  from  the temperature at the sludge inlet to the tempera-
          ture at the ash, or  effluent,  outlet.

     •    Radiation  and conduction  losses  - The  energy lost  to  the surrounding
          air  and  objects   by high  temperature  components  of  the  combustion
          system.

     •    Shaft  cooling air  sensible heat;  energy gained by the shaft cooling air
          in  a  multiple  hearth unit  in  protecting  the  center shaft  and  rabble
          arras from  heat  damage.

     •    Recovered  energy;  that  energy deliberately  removed from  the combustion
          process for other  uses.


H.4.  USE OF  RECOVERED  ENERGY

The  practice of energy  recovery  in  the  combustion  process  can   significantly
affect the  overall  cost-  and energy-effectiveness  of  a sludge management system.
The selection of energy recovery systems must  be based on  the  cost- and energy-
effectiveness analyses,  as  in  some  instances the  value of  recovered  energy may
not justify  the  capital expenditure  required to recover that energy.

There are  several heat losses  from  the  combustion  process which can,  by  proper
design,  be  intercepted  so that a portion of the  lost heat  is  recovered  and put
to use.

     •    Sensible heat of gases  of  combustion,  excess air, and moisture
     •    Radiation  and conduction
     •    Sensible heat of shaft  cooling air
     •    Sensible heat of wet  air  oxidation effluent

In addition,  if  pyrolysis is practiced,  the products of pyrolysis can be expected
to have a fuel value apart from the  heat recoverable from the process itself.

The exit gas  sensible  heat  can be recovered  by running the  gases  through  a heat
exchanger to  produce steam,  or hot water;  or to heat a heat  exchange  fluid. The
energy so  recovered can  then  be  used in any  one of  a  number of ways.  Figure 8
indicates the amount of energy recoverable  from typical incinerator  stack gases.

Radiation and conduction  losses  can  be  recovered by  water  jacketing the reactor
and using the steam  produced as an  energy  source on-site or for sale to others.

The  sensible heat  of  multiple hearth furnace  shaft cooling  air  is  most   often
recovered by  recycling  it to the  combustion process itself as preheated air.
                                        71

-------
     4500
Q

c
Q
LU

o
o
LU
X
UJ
X
     37C-0
     2250
     15CO
     750
           r—
7
                                                                    PRIMARY* WAS
                               PRIMARY
                                      1000                           1500



                                   INITIAL FLUE GAS TEMPERATURE. *F
           Assumptions:

              Final Stack Temp = 500° F

              50% excess air



           ( To convert Btu to kwh:  1  kwh = 10.500 Btu)
      Figure   8.   Potential heat recovery from incineration of  sludge
                                        72

-------
The  sensible heat  of  multiple  hearth furnace  shaft cooling  air is  most  often
recovered by recycling  it  to  the  combustion process itself as preheated air.

The sensible heat of wet air  oxidation effluent is normally recovered in the pro-
cess itself  by  preheating  incoming sludge. Other  uses may be feasible and should
be considered.

H.4.a.  On-Site Use

Recovered energy  from  reduction  processes can have  a  significant  impact  on the
overall energy  consumption,  and  therefore the  cost-effectiveness of  the  entire
wastewater and  sludge treatment  facility  (40).

Combustion air  preheating  can  significantly  reduce  auxiliary  fuel  requirements
and can be  practiced by cooling  air return or  by heat  exchange  between exhaust
gases and combustion air.  Steam,  hot water, or heat  exchange  fluid could be used
as a building heat  source  either directly  or utilizing  heat  pumps. Additionally,
the heat  could  be  used as  the  heat  input to absorption type cooling  systems.
Recovered heat  can  be  used as  the heat  source  for sludge thermal conditioning,
improving the dewaterability of  the  sludge,  which  in  turn improves  its burning
characteristics.  Heat  recovered  from combustion  processes can  be used  to  heat
anaerobic  digesters,  reducing  the  need   for  auxiliary  fuel  or  eliminating  the
diversion to sludge heating  of  the  more easily  transported and  stored methane
gas.  Steam  generated  by  incinerator  water  jackets  or  by   heat exchange  with
exhaust gases can be used  to  drive steam  turbines. The  steam turbines could gen-
erate electricity or serve as prime  movers for process equipment.  Pyrolytic gas
may  be  burned  in  gas   turbines  for  use   in  generating  electricity  or  as  prime
movers for process equipment  or as  a  fuel source  for  the pyrolysis reactor.

H.4.b.  Off-Site Use

Under certain conditions,  energy  produced by the  combustion process may  have  a
market value which  would  justify its recovery. Facilities plans which anticipate
energy sales  should realistically  evaluate the market  potential  as well  as  the
value of the energy.

Combustible  pyrolytic gas  from  sludge alone can  be  expected  to have  a  heat con-
tent of 100-350 Btu/scf (35). By  comparison,  natural gas has  a  heat  content  of
approximately 1000 Btu/scf. Co-pyrolysis  with  solid waste  may produce higher heat
values.

Pyrolytic tar,  or oil,  from sludge alone  can  be  expected  to  have a  heat content
of  78,000-117,000  Btu/gal  (35).  No. 6  fuel  oil  has a heat  content  of 148,840
Btu/gal. This may be useful as  an  industrial  boiler  fuel. It has  a  lower  sulfur
content than most  oils but  has  a  great  deal of  entrained  moisture and  is  very
corrosive. Co-pyrolysis with  solid  waste  may  produce  higher heat values.

Pyrolytic char  from sludge alone has  a heat  content of 1,000-2,400  Btu/lb  (35).
Pennsylvania  anthracite coal has  an approximate  heat  content  of  13,900 Btu/lb.
Char could be  useful as a boiler fuel or  as  a raw material  for  adsorbent  manu-
facture. Co-pyrolysis with solid  waste  may produce higher  heat values.


                                        73

-------
Steam  may  be  the  most  easily  marketable  of  the  energy  forms  available  as
recovered energy. Many  industrial  processes use steam as an energy source.  It is
not as  readily  transportable as the  other forms, however.  Therefore,  a suitable
market must exist in  the  general  vicinity of the combustion system.  An additional
problem  is  assuring  adequate  reliability  of  supply to  the  purchaser,   as  an
unreliable supply of  steam  greatly  diminishes its value.

Electricity is  readily  transportable  and  has the broadest potential market  of the
forms of  recovered  energy.  Marketing  the electricity to an  electric  utility may
be feasible.  The  economics  of electric power generation on  the  small  scale pos-
sible at wastewater plants  are, however,  rarely favorable.


H.5.  ASH DISPOSAL

Since  the combustion  process  does  not  totally  dispose  of  sludge,   but   merely
reduces its volume  and weight, ultimate  disposal of  the ash or  residue  must  be
considered.

H.5.a.  Transport

Transport of  ash  is usually by truck or  pipeline, as  the  greatly-reduced volumes
usually preclude  consideration of  barges  and  rail.  Incinerator  ash  can be  pumped
in  a  slurry  from  the combustion  site  to  the disposal  site  but  may  require
dewatering.  Because of  its  finely  divided nature, truck  transport of  dry ash can
present problems  if adequate  dust  control measures are not  taken.


H.5.b.  Dewatering

Wet air oxidation subnatant is easily  dewatered for  ultimate  disposal on  vacuum
filters. When pumped  in slurry,  incinerator  ash  is  usually dewatered  in lagoons.
Because of the  relatively inert  nature of ash,  ash  lagoons  generally  do not pre-
sent the odor and fly  problems  that are typical of sludge  lagoons.


H.5.C.  Land  Application

Ash and wet air oxidation residue  have  very little value as nitrogen sources, but
their  physical  characteristics  may  make them  useful as  soil  conditioners.  In
addition, they  can  have high  phosphorus  contents.  All types  of  land  application
techniques  are  technically  feasible, and  several  of  the   operational problems,
such as disease vectors,  pathogens, odors,  and  nitrate  pollution of groundwater,
are eliminated  by the  inert  nature  of the material.


H.S.d.  Landfill

Landfilling of  ash,  including  permanent   lagooning,  is  the  most common  form  of
ultimate  disposal.  Many  of  the  problems   associated  with  sludge, such as   odors,
pathogens, disease  vectors,  gas  production, and nitrate  pollution of groundwater,
are not  present with ash.  Cover  is,  therefore,  less  critical but must  be  main-
tained in order to minimize  dust and  leachate problems.
                                        74

-------
H.S.e.  Off-Site Use  by  Others

Several off-site uses  of combustion  residues,  other than the energy recovery dis-
cussed above,  have been  proposed  or attempted.  Incinerator ash has  been tested
as a soil amendment to improve  the  freeze-thaw characteristics of road subgrades,
as  a fine  aggregate  for  building  materials,  as  a  soil  conditioner,  and  as  a
quasi-fertilizer  for  its  phosphorus content  (41). Dewatered  wet   air  oxidation
residue has been tested  with  success  as  a soil conditioner and mulch and is valu-
able for  its  moisture-holding properties  (42). Pyrolytic  char  has  been suggested
as a raw material  for activated  carbon manufacture (35).


H. 6.  AIR QUALITY  CONTROL

National  air  pollution standards for discharges  from municipal  sludge  incinera-
tors have been promulgated which limit emissions  of particulates (including visi-
ble emissions) from incinerators used to burn  wastewater sludge as  follows (43):

     1.   No more  than 0.65 g/kg dry  sludge input (1.30 Ib/ton dry  sludge
          input).
     2.   Less than 20 percent  opacity.

For  uncontrolled  incineration  of  average  municipal  wastewater  sludge,  particu-
lates  will  be about  33  pounds  of  particulates  per  ton  of sludge  burned  in  a
multiple  hearth  (44),  and about  45 pounds of  particulates  per  ton  of  sludge
burned in a fluid  bed  incinerator (45).  Particulate collection efficiencies of 96
to 97 percent are  required  to meet  the  standard,  based  on  the  above uncontrolled
emission  rates.  Impingement  scrubbers,  and Venturi  scrubbers  have  demonstrated
the  capability  to  meet  the particulate  discharge  requirement  (46).  Other poten-
tially effective types  include  baffle,  orifice and cyclone scrubbers.  Wet scrub-
bing is  normally  required in conjunction with mechanical  scrubbing.  Most metals
present in municipal  sludges  are converted to  oxides  which appear in the particu-
lates removed by the  scrubber or in  the  ash.

EPA  has  set  a standard  of  3,200 gms/day  of mercury  for discharge  from  a sewage
sludge incinerator reference  (47).  Metal  discharges should not present  a limita-
tion as properly designed  and operated  municipal  systems have  met  all  air pollu-
tion standards for metals.

Gaseous  pollutants  which could  be  released by  sludge incineration  are  hydrogen
chloride, sulfur dioxide,  oxides of nitrogen, and  carbon  monoxide.  Carbon monox-
ide  is no threat  if  the  incinerator  is  properly designed  and  operated.  Hydrogen
chloride, which would be generated by decomposition of certain plastics, is not  a
significant problem  at  concentrations  currently  observed. Consideration  °F  the
possibility  of  S02  and   NOX  pollution  is  aided  by  examination  of  the  sulfur
and  nitrogen  content  of  sludges.    Sulfur content   is  relatively  low  in  most
sludges. In addition, much of this sulfur is  in  the form of sulfate,  which origi-
nated in the wastewater.  Sulfur  dioxide  is not expected to be  a serious problem.
NOX  production  from  sludge  incineration  should be  less   than  100  ppm from  a
properly operated  incinerator.  Considering this  low concentration,  the production
of oxides of  nitrogen will probably  not  limit the use  of  incineration  for  dis-
posing of sludge in most cases.

                                       75

-------
Toxic substances  could  be discharged  from  the organic substances  such as pesti-
cides  and PCB's  - in  the  sludge.  However,  tests  (48)  have  shown  that  total
destruction of PCB's was  possible  when oxidized in combination with sewage sludge
and with  exhaust  gas  temperatures  of  1100°F. Ninety-five  percent  destruction of
PCB's was  achieved in  a multiple  hearth  furnace with no  afterburning  at exhaust
temperatures of 700°F.

In all cases involving  designated  nonattainment areas the local regulatory agency
offset policy should be considered.

The principal methods of  air  pollution control are:

     •    Venturi  scrubbers
     •    Afterburners
     •    Electrostatic precipitators


H.7.  FUEL

There are  a  number of  variables which  influence the amount of  fuel  required and
the resulting  cost for  sludge incineration.  Principal  variables  are  the solids
and volatile  solids content  of the sludge.  Their effect  on  the  amount  of  heat
required for incineration  is  shown by  Figure 3.

The principal sources of  auxiliary fuel are:

    •    Natural gas
    •    Oil
    •    Refuse derived fuel
    •    Powdered  coal  (49)


Section I - SLUDGE FOR  OFF-SITE USE  BY OTHERS
The use of  sludge  as  a fertilizer and  soil  conditioner under  the  direct  control
of the wastewater  treatment agency is  discussed  under the  land  application sec-
tion of this document.  This section  deals with sludge  that  is  processed in-plant
and  then  given or  sold to the  public  or private  entrepreneurs.  The  processing
produces  a  dry,  marketable  product  that  is  safe for  limited  applications  as  a
soil conditioner or  fertilizer.  This  disposal scheme  has  several advantages over
other methods:

     •    Sludge is utilized  rather than  discarded
     •    Land purchase or  lease  requirements  are reduced
     •    Part of  the  cost  of  processing  may  be  recoverable  through product sale
     •    Potential adverse environmental impacts are  spread over a wider area,
          minimizing  their  effect

The chief  disadvantage to  off-site use  by others is  the  loss  of  agency  control
over sludges which may  be potential health hazards  if  improperly  used.
                                        76

-------
Sludge  factors which  affect  health include:

     •    Degree of stabilization
     •    Heavy metals  content
     •    Toxic organic  compound  content
     •    Pathogen content

The  level  of agricultural or horticultural sophistication  of  the  intended users
should  be kept  in  mind. Sludges which  could  be safely  sold  to professional nur-
serymen for  use on ornamental plants only may  not  be  suitable  for  sale in bagged
form  to the  general  public.  Local  agency regulations should  be  consulted  to
determine if any restrictions on  marketing exist.

I.I.  MARKET ANALYSIS

A  key  step  in evaluating  potential  off-site   use  alternatives is  analyzing  the
market  for the product.  This  includes identifying  the potential market, analyzing
the  capacity of  the  market  to  absorb  the  product,  determining   the  realistic
market  value of  the  product,  identifying  the most  desirable  packaging  for  the
product, and establishing a  brand name  for the product. Data for the market anal-
ysis can be  obtained  by telephone  or mail surveys of  individuals,  possibly sent
with  their   utility  bills,   and  telephone  or   personal  interviews   with  possible
large users, wholesalers,  and processors. The  EPA  publication  User Acceptance of
Wastewater Sludge  Compost (50)  contains considerable  information   on  the market
for processed sewage  sludge.


I.I.a.  Intended Market

The  first  step in the  market analysis  is identifying  the potential  market  and
market  restrictions  for  the product.  The potential  users  can  be  divided  into
three broad  categories:

     •    Government  agencies
     •    Wholesalers and processors
     •    Private users

I.l.a.(l)   Government Agencies  - Government  agencies  offer what  is potentially
the  most  advantageous  of possible markets. Where  sludge  is   used  by  government
agencies it  is usually  possible for  the  wastewater treatment  agency to  retain a
high  degree  of control  over the  final  use of  the  product. There  will  usually,
however, be  no direct cash return for the product,  but an economic   benefit may be
derived by  the reduction  in the  cost  of  fertilizer  use.  The market   analysis
should  consider agencies at  the  local,  state and federal level.

Highway  departments   often  use  fertilizers  and  soil  amendments   for  plantings
alongside roadways. These plantings  are  not  food  chain crops  and   may  present  a
potential use for sludge not  safe for use on food chain crops  due  to heavy metal
content. Care must be taken  in  sludge application, however,  to avoid runoff.  The
same  advantages  would  apply  to  municipal recreation facilities   such  as  golf
courses, reforestation  and tree  or turf  farming.


                                        77

-------
I.I.a.(2)   Wholesalers and Processors -  Sewage  sludge may  be  sold to fertilizer
wholesalers  for  distribution through  the normal fertilizer  and  soil  conditioner
market  place.  Sludge may  also  be  sold or  given to fertilizer  manufacturers for
use as a raw material  in  the  manufacture  of commercial fertilizers. These options
present  a  problem  in  that  the  end use  of the  sludge  is  nearly  impossible  to
control, limiting the  market  to  those  sludges  which are safe for human food chain
crops.

I.I.a.(3)   Private  Users  -  The sale  or  distribution  of sludge  to private users
may be  feasible, especially  when  the sludge  is safe  for  food  chain  crops.  The
chief obstacle to be overcome is assuring the quality  of the sludge and the lack
of control  over  the use of the sludge. While  some  control  can  be  exercised over
large private  users,  it is virtually  impossible  to control  the  use  of  sludge or
sludge products  by  individuals.  This  is  a major  factor being addressed by various
agencies in updated guidance  and regulations.

Nurseries of all types  have  the potential of using sewage  sludge.  In particular,
sludge would be  useful in cultivating non-food chain  ornamental  plants  for sale,
silviculture,  and  sod production.  Agricultural  uses  of   sludge  are  numerous
including all  types of above ground  crops. The  use of sludge on  root  crops and
leafy vegetableslis  generally not  recommended (21). The  sewage  sludge is used in
many communities by home  gardeners.  This market is the most difficult to control
and requires  the utmost  care  in  assuring  sludge  quality  and  safe  use.  Sewage
sludges are most applicable  to  lawn and  ornamental  plant  cultivation.


I.l.b.  Capacity of Market to Absorb Product

The capacity of  the intended market or  markets  to  utilize  the  entire production
of the sludge management  systems must  be evaluated. In highly urbanized areas it
may not  be  possible to market the  entire sludge production  within an economical
transportation distance.


I.I.e.  Market Value of Product

The potential  market value of  the  product must  be determined.  The  market value
is  best  approximated  by  the  sale price  of similar fertilizers  and  soil  condi-
tioners  similarly  marketed.   There  are several  complex factors  which also enter
into the determination  of  the actual market value,  such as  public acceptance, but
their effects  are  difficult  to  quantify. Their  effects  can  be  explored through
surveys of  public acceptance.


I.l.d.  Packaging Requirements

Packaging and  product  delivery  system requirements will vary with  the  intended
market. Large  users will  generally prefer  delivery in bulk  while  smaller  users,
such as individuals, may  prefer  a  bagged  product. In  addition, a determination as
to whether  the product  must  be  delivered  to the  user  or if  the user is willing to
pick up the sludge.


                                       78

-------
It has  been  found  (50) that affixing a  brand  name to  the  sludge product greatly
enhances its marketability.  Some  typical brand names  in use are:
          Nu-Earth  (Chicago,  IL)
          Hou-Actinite  (Houston,  TX)
          Zitrohumus  (Los  Angeles,  CA)
          Philorganic  (Philadelphia,  PA)
Biogrow (Salem, OR)
Metrogrow (Madison, WI)
Milorganite (Milwaukee, WI)
1.2.  PROCESSING METHOD
Sludge  suitable for  use  off-site  by others  is  usually  processed  by  drying or
composting.


I.2.a.  Drying

Well stabilized sludges may  be  suitable  for use off-site after drying.

I.2.a.(1)   Drying Beds - The most  widely used  dewatering method  in  the United
States  is  drying  of  the sludge on  open  or covered sandbeds.  They are especially
popular at  small  plants.  Sandbeds possess  the  advantage of needing  little opera-
tor skill.  Air  drying  is  normally restricted to well  digested sludge, because  raw
sludge  is  sometimes odorous,  attracts insects,  and  does  not  dry satisfactorily
when applied at reasonable depths.  The design and use of drying beds are affected
by many parameters. They  include  weather  conditions,  sludge characteristics,  land
values and  proximity of residences,  and  use of sludge conditioning aids.

Drying  times  typically  range from  4 to  12  weeks,  depending  upon  the  weather.
Especially  adverse weather can  result in  drying times as long as 6 months (51).

I.2.a.(2)   Drying Lagoons -  Lagoon  drying is  a low cost, simple system for sludge
dewatering  that has  been commonly  used  in the United  States. Sludge  is removed
periodically and  the  lagoon  refilled. Sludge is  stabilized  to  reduce odor prob-
lems prior  to dewatering  in  a  drying lagoon.

Most design factors  include  climate,  subsoil  permeability,  lagoon depth, loading
rates, and  sludge characteristics.

Sludge will generally  not dewater in  any  reasonable  period of time  to  the point
that  it  can be lifted by a  fork except  in  an extremely  hot,  arid  climate. If
sludge  is   placed  in  depths  of  15  inches  or less,  it  may be  removed  with a
front-end loader  in 3  to  5 months.  When  sludge is  to be used for  soil condition-
ing, it may be desirable  to  stockpile it  for  added drying before use.

1.2.a.(3)   Heat  Drying  -  Heat  drying   raises  the  temperature  of  the  incoming
sludge  to   212°F  (100°C)  to  remove  moisture  which  reduces  total  volume,   yet
retains the nutrient properties  of  the sludge. The end  product is  odor free,  con-
tains no pathogenic  organisms,  and contains  soil  nutrients.  Sludge  has  been  heat
dried in flash drying  equipment and rotary kilns.
                                        79

-------
I.2.a.(3)  (a)   Flash  Drying -  Flash  drying  is  the  instantaneous  removal of
moisture  from solids by  introducing them  into  a hot  gas stream.  There  are two
basic flash drying systems:  cage  mill  dryers and jet mill dryers.

A flow diagram of the cage mill  process  is  shown in Figure 9. The system is  based
on  three  distinct cycles which   can  be  combined  in different  arrangements. The
first cycle is the flash  drying  cycle, where wet filter cake is blended with  some
previously dried  sludge in  a mixer  to  improve  pneumatic  conveyance. The blended
sludge and the hot gases  from the furnace at  1,300°F are  mixed  ahead of the  cage
mill and  flashing of  the  water vapor begins.  The  cage  mill mechanically agitates
the mixture  of  sludge  and gas  and the drying is  virtually  complete  by the  time
the sludge leaves the cage mill.  The sludge, at  this stage,  is at a moisture  con-
tent of 8 to  10  percent and  dry  sludge  is  separated from  the  spent drying  gases
in a cyclone. The dried sludge can be  sent  either to fertilizer storage or  to the
furnace for incineration.

I.2.a.(3)  (b)  Rotary Kiln  Dryer - The rotary kiln is  a  cylindrical steel  shell
mounted with  its  axis  at a  slight slope from the  horizontal as  shown  in  Figure
10. Dewatered sludge is  fed continuously  into  the upper  end.  A portion  of the
dried sludge  is  mixed  with  the  feed sludge  to  reduce  moisture  and  disperse the
cake.  Vanes  pick up the  material,  then  steadily  spill it  off  in  the  form of a
thin sheet of falling particles  as the dryer  rotates.  This  action is intended to
provide  contact   between  sludge  and  gases  to  promote  rapid  drying.  The   dried
sludge  from   such  a unit  will  consist  of  varied  sizes  of  particles  that may
require grinding  before use.  Deodorization  of the  exhaust  gases by after burning
at approximately  1,200° to  1,400°F (650° to 760°C)  is  necessary  if  odors are to
be avoided. Also, scrubbers  must be used to  remove  particulates from the exhaust
gases.


I.2.b.  Composting

Composting is a method of  biological oxidation of organic  matter  in  sludge by
thermophilic  organisms. Composting,  properly carried out, will destroy  objection-
able  odor producing  elements  of  sludge,   destroy  or  reduce  disease  organisms
because  of elevated  temperature,  and  produce  an  aesthetic and  useful  organic
product.

Composting systems  generally fall  into  three categories:  (a)  pile, (b) windrow,
and  (c)  mechanized  or  enclosed  systems.   The  pile  (static  aerated  pile) and
windrow  systems  have  been  used  almost  exclusively  in composting  sewage  sludge
because  of their low  cost  and  demonstrated performance. Mechanized or enclosed
systems have  not  been used  to any  extent  recently in the U.S.  on sewage sludge.
The general  composting method is very similar  for  all processes.  The dewatered
sludge  (typically 20 percent solids)  is  delivered  to the  site and  is  usually
mixed with a  bulking agent.  The  purpose  of  the  bulking agent  is  to increase the
porosity  of  the  sludge to  assure  aerobic   conditions  during composting.  If the
composting material  is  too  dense or wet it may become anaerobic thus producing
odors or  if it is too porous the temperature of  the material will remain low. Low
temperatures  will delay  the  completion  of composting  and reduce  the  kill of
disease organisms.


                                        80

-------
        ,RSUEf VE\T
                               HOT GAS OUCT
           REFRACTORY




           HOT GAS TO DRYING SYSTEM




           DRYING SYSTEM
[      I  SLUDGE




Y////A  COMBUSTION AIR



1/////1  DEODORIZED GAS
Figure  9.   Cage  mill  flash dryer system.   (52)
                            81

-------
                                                     BUCKET	
                                                     ELEVATOR
PUMP
                                                    NATURAL GAS
5t*H*V -^*Ji^-j^^^y^^
50UCT SCREW \_
                                                 PRODUCT
                                                                       STORAGE
                                                                       PRODUCT
                  Figure 10.   Rotary  kiln dryer.
                                82

-------
Various  bulking materials can  be  used  and  suitable low  cost  materials  include,
previously  composted  sludge,  wood chips, bark  chips,  rice hulls, and cubed  solid
waste. Unscreened  finished  compost has also been used. Generally, one part  sludge
(20 percent  solids) is  mixed  with three parts bulking agent although this mixture
can be varied  depending on  moisture content of sludge, type of bulking agent,  and
local  conditions.  The  sludge-bulking  agent  mixture  is  then  formed  into  the
windrow  or  static  pile  as applicable.

Following composting,  the  product is removed from  the  windrow or static  pile  and
cured  in storage piles  for 30  days or  longer.  This curing  provides  for further
stabilization  and  pathogen  destruction. Prior to or following curing, the compost
may be screened to  remove a portion of  the bulking  agent  for reuse  or for  appli-
cations  requiring  a finer product.  The  compost can also  be  used without screen-
ing. Removal of the bulking agent  also reduces  the dilution of the nutrient  value
of the compost.

I.2.b.(l)   Windrow - The  sludge-bulking agent  mixture,  (2-3  parts  of bulking
agent  by volume to one  part  of sludge)  is  spread in windrows with  a triangular
cross  section.  The  windrows are normally 10 to  16 feet wide and 3 to 5 feet  high.
An  alternative method  of mixing  the  bulking  agent and  sludge  and  forming  the
windrow  consists  of laying  the bulking  agent out  as a base  for  the  windrow.  The
sludge is  dumped  on  top of  the  bulking agent  and  spread. A  composting machine
(similar to  a  large rototiller) then mixes  the  sludge and bulking agent  and  forms
the mixture  into a windrow.  Several turnings about  (8  to  10  times)  are  necessary
to adequately  blend the  two materials.

The windrow is normally turned  daily  using the cotnpostor; however,  during  rainy
periods  turning is  suspended  until the  windrow  surface  layers  dry out.   Tempera-
tures  in the windrow  interior under proper  composting conditions range from  55  to
65°C.  Turning  moves the surface material to  the center of the  windrow  for  expo-
sure to  higher temperatures.  The  higher temperatures are  needed for pasteuriza-
tion  and kill off  most pathogenic  agents.   Turning  also  aids  in  drying  and
increases the  porosity  for greater air movement and distribution.

The windrows are turned  for a two week  period  or  longer  depending on the weather
and efficiency of  composting.  The  compost  windrow is  then flattened  for further
drying.  The  compost is  moved  to curing when the moisture content has decreased  to
approximately  30 to 45  percent. Proper  windrow composting should produce a  rela-
tively stable  product with a  moisture  content of 30 to 45 percent  which has been
exposed  to  temperatures of at  least 50°C for  a  portion  of time  during  the com-
posting  process.

The composting process  required longer detention times  in cold or  hot  weather,
therefore,  climate is  a significant  factor  with  the  windrow  process   in open
spaces.  Covering the  composting  area  would  significantly reduce the  effects   of
cold weather and  nearly eliminate the  problems  of  wet weather.  In any  case,  the
curing  area  should  be  covered  if  operations  are  to   be  carried  out  during
precipitation.

I.2.b.(2)   Static  Pile  - The  static   pile  composting method  as applied  to  raw
sludge requires a  forced ventilation system for control  of the  process.  The pile


                                        83

-------
then  remains  fixed, as opposed  to the constant  turning of the  windrow,  and  the
forced ventilation  system  maintains  aerobic conditions.

A base  is  prepared for the  pile  consisting  of a  1  foot thick  layer  of bulking
agent or  previously composted unscreened  product. A  4-inch  diameter performated
pipe  is installed in  the base  as  an  aeration header.  The base is constructed with
a typical plan dimension of  approximately  40 by 20 feet. The sludge-bulking agent
mixture is piled on this base  to  a height  of approximately 8  feet  to form a tri-
angular cross section.  The pile  is capped  with a 1 foot layer of screened compost
product. This top layer extends  down the sides to help absorb odors and to act as
a shield or  roof  against   penetration  of  precipitation. A  typical  static pile is
illustrated  in  Figure  11. An alternative configuration  is  the  extended static
pile  method where  subsequent piles are  "added" to the  initial  static  pile. This
configuration saves space  compared to  a  number of separate static piles.

The perforated underdrain  pipe  is attached to  a  blower  by  pipe  and fittings.  The
other side of the blower is  piped to  a smaller, adjacent pile of screened compost
product. Air  and  gases are drawn  by the blower from  the static  compost pile  and
discharged through  the small pile of  product  compost.  The  small pile effectively
absorbs odors. The  operating cycle of the blower is  adjusted to maintain oxygen
levels in the exhausted gases  and compost  pile within a range of 5 to 15 percent.
Temperatures  within the compost  pile will vary somewhat with  monitoring location
in  the  pile,  but  should   reach  60-65°C.   Normally the  blower  is operated  on  an
on-off cycle  to maintain proper  oxygen levels and temperatures within the pile.

After an average  composting  period of 3 weeks, the compost is  moved  to a curing
area.

Outdoor temperatures  as  low  as -7°C and rain  totaling 7 inches  per  week has  not
interferred  with  the  successful  outdoor  operation of  exposed   static  pile com-
posting. Temperatures  produced during static pile  composting  are generally above
55°C and often exceed  70 to  80°C.

I.2.b.(3)   Mechanical Systems  -  There are  several mechanical  systems  available
for  composting.  Most  are  designed  for solid waste  composting  where   the  much
larger quantities of  material  to  be  composted make the reduction in land require-
ments due  to mechanical compostors  cost  effective.  The volume  of sludge  to  be
composted at  most  operations  is  very  small when  compared  to solid  waste system
and mechanical compostors  have not been  found to  be advantageous.

In general mechanical  compostors consist  of  large  vats  or  digesters  with mechan-
ical  equipment for aeration, mixing,  and moving the compost through the digester.
Additional information on  mechanical composting and European  experience is  given
in reference  (53).


1.2.c.  Co-disposal with Solid Waste

Co-disposal  of  sludge  and solid  waste  by  composting usually  takes  one of   two
forms:
                                        84

-------
                                              FAN   SCREENED
                                                    COMPOST
 LONGITUDINAL SECTION
WOOD CHIPS AND SLUDGE

SCREENED COMPOST

UNSCREENED COMPOST

PERFORATED PIPE
EXTENDED PILES
                             CROSS SECTION
       Figure 11.  Static pile composting.

-------
     •    Use of  shredded  and  classified solid waste as a bulking agent in sludge
          composting
     •    Use of  sludge  as  a nutrient  source in solid composting

Sewage sludge  has too high a  moisture content  for successful  windrow or static
pile construction without  the aid  of  a bulking  agent.  The  cellulose  (paper and
some garbage) fraction of  solid  waste  may  offer a suitable and economical bulking
agent.  Solid waste  on  the other  hand  generally requires  supplemental  nitrogen
and moisture for  successful composting.  Sewage  sludge  has  been  suggested  as an
economical source of  additional  nitrogen (54).


I.Z.d.  Nutrient  Enrichment

It may prove cost-effective to increase the market value of the sludge product by
nutrient  enrichment.  While nitrogen and  phosphorus phosphoric  acid  contents can
be increased with a  subsequent  increase in  value,  the greatest  nutrient short-
coming of most sewage sludge products  is the potassium (potash) content. Nutrient
enrichment processes  may be part of the sludge management system or  they may be
practiced  by  fertilizer processors  who  purchase  unenriched  product from the
wastewater agency.


1.3.   PACKAGING AND DELIVERY

The  facility plan  must  give  adequate consideration  to  the  methods  of  product
packaging and delivery,  as  they  may determine  the  success  or  failure  of the  com-
posting system.

By far the most common system  of delivery  sludge for off-site use by others  is to
allow  or  encourage  individuals  to  pick up  lagoon or  bed  dried  sludge  at the
treatment plant.  Usually the sludge  is given away, or a nominal price charged, if
it is  loaded by  the user.  If  the sludge is loaded by the utility a  higher  price
is often charged  to off-set labor costs.

The  same  concept  is sometimes  applied  to  larger  deliveries,  with   user   owned
trucks  loaded  with  sludge  during regularly  scheduled   drying  bed  or  lagoon
cleanings.

Sludge product  is often delivered  in  bulk  to  the users.  Trucks, railroads, and
barges have  been  used.  The section  on sludge  transport  has  more  information on
the selection of  transportation  modes.

Bagging of  the sludge  product is  a costly  process,  but  the bagged  product can
usually be sold at  a  correspondingly higher  price.  Many urban and suburban  indi-
vidual users will desire small quantities  of sludge product and will not have the
means for transporting the  unbagged  product.  This segment  of the potential market
is accustomed  to  obtaining fertilizers  and soil conditioners  in  bagged  form and
is generally willing  to  pay a  premium  for  the convenience. The bagged product can
be sold at the  treatment  plant site, although  the  visibility  afforded by market-
ing through  the  usual outlets such  as garden  centers  and nurseries  can  greatly


                                        86

-------
improve  sales.  Regulatory  agencies  should  be  consulted  to determine  required
labeling.
Section J - COST EFFECTIVENESS  ANALYSIS

In order to select  the  best  sludge  management alternative, a cost-effective anal-
ysis  must  be  performed. The  cost-effectiveness analysis  may be on  an amortized
annual basis or on  a  present worth basis, but  all  alternatives  must  be evaluated
in  the  same manner.  Whether on an  annual or  present  worth hisis,  the  analysis
should include  the  costs of construction, operation, maintenance and supervision
for  all  components of  the sludge management system,  including  sludge treatment
processes and any impacts  on  the wastewater  treatment processes.

Cost-effectiveness  analyses  should  be  made in accordance with the Federal regula-
tions "Cost-Effectiveness  Analysis  Guidelines"  (55).

In evaluating systems which  involve  co-disposal with  solid waste, great care must
be exercised  to insure  that  the costs  used  reflect the  actual situation.  Some
examples follow:

     •    When  solid  waste and  sludge are to be  managed in  an all new facility,
          the total cost  of  managing both waste streams  together should  be used.
          In  evaluating  alternative  sludge  management  systems  not  involving
          co-disposal,  the cost  of  separate  solid  waste  management  should  be
          included.

     •    Where sludge  is  to  be added to an  existing solid  waste management sys-
          tem,  the   incremental  cost   of   the   sludge  management   should   be
          evaluated.

     •    Where solid waste  is  added to  a sludge  management system  as  raw mate-
          rial  (refuse-derived  fuel  or  bulking  agent),   the  cost  of  separating
          usable material  from  the overall solid  waste  stream and inserting it in
          the sludge  management stream  should  be  treated  as  a variable  annual
          cost  to the sludge management  system for fuel or  material.  Credit  for
          an  incremental  reduction  in  the  solid waste  stream may  be  taken,
          although  the  volumes  involved  may not justify this.

     •    Cost  must be   allocated  between  the  sludge  management system and  the
          solid waste  management  system  according  to  EPA  policy   to  determine
          separate agency  shares.

This  section  discusses  only  quantifiable costs. Such  non-quantifiable costs  as
social and  environmental costs  are  discussed under the section  on environmental
assessment; and  the performance of  a  separate energy-effectiveness  analysis  is
discussed in the section on energy analysis.

Comparative cost information  which  may be useful may be obtained from  the  tech-
nical report,  A Guide  to the  Selection of  Cost-Effective  Wastewater  Treatment
Systems,  (56)  in conjunction  with  its  supplement,  An Analysis of  Construction
Cost Experience for Wastewater  Treatment  Plants,  (57).

                                        87

-------
J.I.  GENERAL  CONSIDERATIONS


J.I.a.  Planning Period

The planning period  for  cost-effectiveness analyses is 20 years,


J.l.b.  Discount Rate

The discount,  or  interest rate to  be  used in cost-effectiveness  analyses is the
rate  established  by  the Water Resources Council  for water  resources projects.
Discount rates are normally revised on October 1 of each year.


J.l.c.  Construction or  Other  Cost  Indices

Cost vary with time  and  with  geographical location. All  usable  cost data will be
referenced  to  a specific place  and point  in  time.  Cost  indices  must  then be
applied  to  the  data  to  adjust   them  to the  conditions  under  consideration.
Adjustment  is  performed  by multiplying the cost  data by the ration of  the current
cost index  to  the  cost index for the  place and  time for which  the  data was  com-
piled.  The  most  useful  indices   (which  are  all   published  in  Engineering
News-Record) are:

     •    The  Engineering News-Record  Construction  Cost Index
     •    The  EPA Sewage  Treatment  Plant Index
     •    The  EPA Sewer  Construction Cost Index


J.l.d.  Service Lives  of  Facility and  Equipment

The cost-effectiveness guidelines  give  service  lives  for various  components of
the wastewater treatment  system.  These service  lives  are  generally applicable to
sludge management systems. Many components of  sludge management  systems, however,
do not fit  into  the  categories in  the cost-effectiveness  guidelines,  and consid-
eration should be  given  to establishing more accurate service  lives.  Where the
sludge management system has  a useful life less  than  the planning  period,  as is
often the case with  landfills,  the  cost  of sludge management for the remainder of
the planning period  must  be included in  the analysis.  In evaluating service  lines
consideration  must also  be  given  to the  salvage values of  facilities  and equip-
ment at the end of the project life.


J.l.e.  Capital Costs  and Credits

Capital costs  and credits include such items as:

     •    Land or right-of-way purchase
     •    Facility construction  including engineering,  administration, construc-
          tion cost,  fixed  equipment  costs,  start-up  costs, and  interest during
          construction.

                                        88

-------
     •    Mobile equipment  costs  including trucks, tractors, etc.
     •    The  incremental  cost of  increasing  wastewater treatment unit  sizes to
          accommodate sidestreams.
     •    Credit for salvage  values of  land and equipment if applicable.

In evaluating  the  cost  of  land acquisition, consideration  should  be  given to any
losses in property tax  revenues due to  public  ownership of  the property.


J\l.f.  Fixed Annual Costs

Fixed annual  costs are  those  costs which are  incurred regardless of  the actual
flow to the sludge management system. These costs  include  operating  labor, main-
tenance, supplies, monitoring,  equipment leasing, and  land  leasing.  Inflation of
material and wages should not  be  considered unless a change in the relative costs
of portions of the fixed annual costs can be anticipated.


J.l.g.  Variable Annual Costs  and Credits

Variable annual  costs  and credits  are  those which  change  with  the  sludge flow.
These costs and credits include:

          Fuel
          Electricity
          Chemicals including  supplemental  fertilizer
          Incremental operation and maintenance costs of sidestream treatment
          Credits  for energy  recovery
          Contract haul costs
          Cost of  product disposal  or credit for product sale
          Bulking  agent costs
          Product  packaging costs


J.2.   SLUDGE TREATMENT

The cost of  sludge treatment  (thickening,  stabilization,  conditioning,  dewater-
ing)  is  a  major portion  of any  sludge management  system.  Detailed analysis of
sludge treatment costs  must be made for each alternative under consideration.  In
addition,  possible  alternative   sludge  treatment   systems  for  each  management
alternative  should be  analyzed   for their  effect  on  the   overall cost.  Sludge
treatment costs  should  not  neglect  the  incremental  addition  to wastewater treat-
ment costs due to  the return  of sidestreams  to  the wastewater processes.


J.3.   SLUDGE TRANSPORT

Each  sludge  transport  system  under consideration  should  be  analyzed  for  its
cost-effectiveness. It  should be  recognized that each  sludge  management alterna-
tive will  have a  different  set   of  sludge  transport  costs  to evaluate.  Data on
sludge  transportation  costs  can  be  found  in  the  EPA  publication Transport of
Sewage Sludge  (16).

                                        89

-------
J.4.  LAND APPLICATION

Cost-effectiveness  analyses for  land  application  systems should  include credit
for the  increase  in value of reclaimed land  and  credit for the  sale  of  any crop
produced on land  owned  or leased by the wastewater  agency.  Land application sys-
tems should be  given 115 percent cost  preference over other  disposal systems in
accordance with EPA regulations  on  innovative/alternative systems. The credit for
the value of the  reclaimed  land  should be based  on  the estimated market  value of
the reclaimed land  at the time  the  analysis  is made.  Conversely, if the intended
crop is  unsalable,  the  cost of  crop  disposal  should be  included; and  if  land
application of  sludge makes  previously usable  farm land  permanently unsuitable
for food chain crops, consideration should be given to a  possible loss in market
value.  Area funding  agencies  should be  contacted  for their acceptance considering
these concepts.
J.5.  LANDFILL

If  the  life of the  landfill  is less  than  the planning  period,  as  is  often the
case, the cost  of  sludge  management through the  remainder  of  the planning period
should be considered.
J.6.  COMBUSTION

Analyses  of  combustion  processes  should  consider  the  value  of  any  energy
recovered in the form of waste heat  or  as  pyrolysis products, the cost of residue
disposal, and  the  cost  of  sidestream treatment.  It is possible  that  the combus-
tion  process  residue may  have a  market value,  either as  is,  or  after further
processing.


J.7.  SLUDGE FOR OFF-SITE USE  BY  OTHERS

Analysis of off-site use alternative should  include a realistic assessment of the
market  value  of the product.  Considered in  the  evaluation of the  product  value
should be the cost  of transporting it to the  user.


Section K - RELIABILITY

The reliability  of  the  sludge  management alternative  under consideration must be
evaluated. While the minute-to-minute reliability of the  sludge management system
is not as critical  as  that  of  the wastewater  treatment process,  sufficient  reli-
ability should  be  designed  into  the  sludge management  system to  prevent  undesir-
able  effects  resulting  from  system interruptions.  The   EPA technical  bulletin
Design  Criteria for Mechanical,  Electric,  and Fluid  System and  Component  Reli-
ability (58)  should be consulted  in evaluating  the reliability  of  the  proposed
facility.
                                        90

-------
K.I.  MECHANICAL DOWNTIME

The  sludge  management system  chosen should  include  features which  minimize the
effects  of  mechanical downtime.  Mechanical  downtime  usually occurs  as  a result
of:
     •    Scheduled maintenance
     •    Power failures
     •    Equipment failures

K.I.a.  Standby Power Supply

In  general,  the nature  of  sludge management  systems  is such  that  power failures
of  typical  duration  have no serious effects  on  the  system operation.  A notable
exception, however, is the multiple  hearth incinerator. Loss of power to the rab-
ble arm drive  and  cooling  air  supply can  result  in serious damage  to the rabble
arms and  center shaft.  Standby power should  always be provided for  at  least the
rabble arm  drive  and cooling  air fan.  Whenever  possible,  standby  power  should
also be provided for the induced  draft  fan, as it  is  quite  costly,  and sometimes
damaging, to permit a multiple hearth furnace to  cool  and  to  subsequently reheat
it.
K.l.b.  Standby Fuel Supply

It is sometimes desirable  to  have a standby source of  fuel.  This is particularly
true  in  the case  of  multiple hearth  incinerators on  interruptible  natural  gas
supplies. It is very costly to permit  an  operating multiple hearth incinerator to
cool  down as  a considerable  amount  of fuel  is  required  to  bring it  back  up to
operating temperature.  In  addition,  uncontrolled cooling can result in refractory
damage.


K. I.e.  Storage

Sludge storage is  often the most economical way  to provide adequate reliability.
Storage has  the  added  benefit of providing operating  flexibility at  the  sludge
disposal site, possibly allowing  8-hour,  5-day work schedules and shutdown during
inclement weather.  Storage should be sized to accommodate  the  entire sludge pro-
duction  from  the  wastewater  treatment facility  during  the longest  anticipated
outage due to mechanical downtime.  Where  operating flexibility  is  also a goal of
sludge storage, the sizing of the storage facility will often  be governed  by the
flexibility requirement.


K. l.d.  Duplicate  Equipment

The  provision  of   multiple process  units   can  provide protection  from mechanical
downtime for  scheduled  maintenance  or equipment  failure.  This  approach  is  most
often applicable  to  larger facilities which  handle a quantity  of  sludge several
times  the  capacity of  a typical sludge  processing unit.  An example would  be  a
sludge incinerator installation  with four incinerators, three  of which can,  when
operating at peak capacity,  handle  the full  sludge production  of  the wastewater

                                       91

-------
treatment facility.  Care  should  be taken to insure that duplicate items of equip-
ment are not  subject  to  "common  mode"  failures, such as loss of a single gas  line
which serves  all  incinerators.  Storage can often  be  considered as an alternative
to duplicate  equipment.


K. I.e.  Backup Equipment

In  the  case  of  landfill  and  land  application facilities,  and  some composting
operations,  protection  against   mechanical failure  can  be  provided by  backup
equipment.  Backup  equipment can  often be  multi-purpose,  such as  a  tractor  with
dozer blade  which  can serve as a  backup  at a  landfill  site  for  more specialized
excavating,  compacting,  backfilling, and road  grading  equipment.  Often it is  not
necessary for the  backup equipment  to  be  dedicated to  the  sludge landfill site.
Backup equipment  for a landfill  might  be  obtainable by agreement  from the local
solid waste  landfill  operation,  the local  public  works  department,  or from other
utilities in  the area. In many  communities it  may  be  possible  to  rent the neces-
sary backup equipment  as  needed  from a local heavy equipment rental agency.


K. l.f.  Alternative Management Techniques

The planning  of an alternative sludge  management technique can protect a facility
from mechanical downtime.  An example would be  an  incineration  facility with  pro-
visions for hauling  sludge  to  a  solid waste landfill  in the  event of incinerator
failure.  Care  should be taken,  however,  that  the alternative management system
is not subject to "common mode"  failures  with  the  principal management system.


K.2.  AVAILABILITY OF  NEEDED RESOURCES

A key  factor in determining the  reliability  of  the  sludge  management  system is
the availability  of  the  resources  necessary  to operate the  system.  An otherwise
well planned  and  designed  system will not function  reliably  if  these resources
are in short  or unreliable  supply.


K.2.a.  Electric Power

The supply  of power  from the local  electrical utility must  be considered  in  the
early stages  of facility  planning.  Frequently  the  electric utility will be forced
to construct  new lines,  the cost  of which may  be charged to the sludge management
operation. These costs should be  included in  the cost-effectiveness analysis  in a
manner appropriate to  the  billing schedule.


K.2.b.  Fuel

The supply of necessary  fuels must  be  assured. If  gas is required, the ability of
the local gas utility to provide service  should be verified as service  is often
on an interruptible  basis.  This  will further affect fuel supply reliability.


                                        92

-------
If  liquid  fuels are  required,  the local  fuel  marketing  system's  capability for
meeting  the  requirements  of  the  sludge  management  system  must   be  addressed.
Marketing  capabilities  must  be  matched  to  the  system design   (frequency  of
delivery,  size  of  delivery,  etc.)-  Adequate  on-site  fuel  storage  should  be
considered to allow  for delivery  delays.

K.2.c.  Chemicals

The local availability  of  necessary chemicals must  be  considered.  The  ability of
the local chemical marketing  system to  reliably meet the facility's needs must be
assessed. The system design must  be matchable to the marketing capabilities  (fre-
quency of delivery,  size of delivery,  etc.).  Sufficient on-site storage should be
considered to allow  for delays in deliveries.


K.2.d.  Manpower

The ability  of  the  local  labor  market  to  supply  the needed  qualified personnel
at  the  salary  levels established  for  the  sludge  management  operation  must  be
examined. Qualified  maintenance  personnel  should  be  available  in  the  local  labor
market.  In  the  case  of  agricultural operations,  people with  farming  experience
must  be  available.  If  qualified  heavy  equipment  operators  are required,   their
availability must be  considered.


K. 2.e.  Replacement  Parts

The availability of  replacement  parts for  the sludge management  system equipment
is  critical  to  system  reliability.  In many  small  communities,  spare parts for
even  relatively  common types  of  equipment  may  require long  delivery  times.
Machine  shops may  be locally available  which could,  in an  emergency,  fabricate
difficult-to-obtain  parts.


K.3.  FACTORS OF SAFETY

The design  of  the  sludge  management  system  should  include  factors of  safety  to
allow  for  abnormal  sludge quantities  and  characteristics,   unusual   periods  of
inclement weather, droughts, and  other reasonably  foreseeable occurrences.


Section L - ENERGY ANALYSIS

The energy-effectiveness  of sludge  management  alternatives  must  be analyzed  in
order to determine  the  effect of  the facility  on energy  production and  consump-
tion in the planning  area. The EPA's  "Grants  Regulations and  Procedures,  Revision
of 40CFR30, 420-6" (59) requires  all  portions of  the wastewater treatment system,
including  sludge  management  systems,  to  be  energy-efficient.  The economics  of
energy utilization are considered  in  the  cost-effectiveness analysis.

Energy analyses  must consider both  the  primary energy  consumption (used  in the
operation  of  the management  system) and  secondary  energy  consumption  (used  in

                                       93

-------
the  manufacture  of consumables  used by  the  management system).  Energy analyses
should  present  all alternatives  on a common  basis. In  the  case  of  co-disposal
alternatives,  the  energy consumption  of both  solid waste and  sludge management
should  be considered for  both  the  co-disposal  alternative itself and alternatives
not  involving co-disposal.  Credits for  energy  recovery should  be  based on real-
istic estimates of  the  actual  utilization of that  energy.  Credit  for  recovery of
steam from  waste  heat,  for  instance,  should only  be  considered if a  viable  use
for  the steam exists. Energy analyses  should also  include  the  energy  consumed in
treating sidestreams.

Energy-effectiveness must be  evaluated  within  the framework  of  cost-effective-
ness. Theoretically, the  two should be similar, but for a variety of reasons this
may  not be  the case. For  instance, the regional fuel  price structure  is variable
and  will reflect  the  relative availability  of  a particular type  of  energy, such
as fuel oil, natural gas,  coal,  or nuclear. Thus,  a particular sludge management
system  might  be  energy- as  well  as  cost-effective  in one  region,  while only
energy-effective in another.  Similarly,  while  the  energy-effectiveness  of  a par-
ticular system might be high,  the cost-effectiveness might not reflect  this fact
if  the  system  is   labor  intensive  and  labor  costs are  high  for a  particular
project.

The  EPA publication Energy  Conservation in Municipal  Wastewater  Treatment (40)
contains more  detailed  guidance on  making  energy-effectiveness analyses  as well
as a great  deal of primary and secondary  energy consumption data.


Section M - ENVIRONMENTAL ASSESSMENT

An assessment of  the  impact  of the  sludge  management system on the  environment,
including public health,  social,  and economic  impacts,  is required for all fed-
erally  funded projects.  Similar  assessments are required by many  state  and local
governments. The impact of each sludge management  alternative  under consideration
must be evaluated.
M.1  ENVIRONMENTAL  IMPACT

Sludge  management  systems  may  affect  the  following  components  of  the  environ-
ment: (1) soil and  vegetation,  (2)  groundwater,  (3) surface water,  (4) animal and
insect life, (5) air quality and  (6)  climate.


M.I.a.  Soil and Vegetation

The effects of the  deposition of  sludge on  the  land may be adverse  or beneficial,
or  some combination  of  the  two,  depending  on the  character  of   the  material
deposited,  the  manner  in which  it  is deposited, and  the  character  of  the  land.
(See Section F and  I).
                                        94

-------
M.l.b.  Groundwater

Groundwater  quality,  level,  and  flow  will  normally be  affected,  to  a  minor
extent, by sludge management  techniques  which place sludge on or in the land.

Effects on  groundwater quality  may  be more  significant.  Leachate  moving from a
sludge  land  application or landfill  site  to groundwater  by  percolation can con-
tain  significant  concentrations of  substances  which are  considered  to  be pollu-
tants.  The   sludge  constituent  typically   of  most  concern  is  nitrate-nitrogen.
Other  constituents  which may  leach  from  sludge  into  the  groundwater  include
phosphates,  heavy metals,  organics,  dissolved solids,  and others identified under
article B.2.
M. I.e.  Surface Water

Surface  water flow  and  quality  can  be  affected  by an  improperly  designed  or
operated  sludge  management  system.  Flow  can be  increased  or  decreased  by the
alteration  of  runoff patterns due  to  grading at  a landfill or  land application
site. Surface water  quality  can be  adversely affected by allowing runoff from the
site  to  enter  surface  waters. Any of  the  constituents of  the sludge could enter
surface water with the  runoff.

When  sludge  is transported  by barge, the additional  possibility  of surface water
pollution due to sludge  spills must  be  evaluated.


M.l.d.  Animal and Insect Life

The  impact  of sludge  management  systems on animal and  insect  life  is  normally
minimal. Where sludge  is being deposited in or  on previously unfarmed  land, the
natural habitat of certain  species  may be disrupted.  Conversely,  the production
of  crops  on  land  with  applied  sludge may  provide  additional  food  sources  for
wildlife. These and  other effects must  be  evaluated for  each species of concern.


M. I.e.  Air  Quality

Sludge  incineration  and  heat drying  processes may  have  a  significant  impact  on
air  quality.  Among the  air  pollution  components which  may be produced  by these
processes are:

          Particulates
          Sulfur dioxide
          Oxides of  nitrogen
          Heavy metals
          Toxic organic  compounds
          Hydrocarbons  and carboxyls

The evaluation of  the  impact on air quality should consider each  of these pollu-
tants as well as any other  substances  which may be formed  in the  atmosphere from
these pollutants,  such  as photochemicals.

                                        95

-------
Sludge transport by  truck,  barge,  or rail will have  an  impact  on air quality due
to  vehicle  emissions. The  nature  and  quantity of  the  pollutants  from internal
combustion  engines  is well documented  (60) and  will  not  be  discussed  further
here. Land  application  systems which utilize  spraying of sludge  may  lead  to the
production  of aerosols (finely divided  airborne moisture). The chief concern with
aerosol  production  is  the  possibility  of pathogens  entering  human  or  animal
respiratory systems.

All  sludge  management systems have  the potential  for   odor  production  to  some
degree  or  another.  While  odors  are  indicative  of  the  presence  of  polluting
substances,  primarily hydrocarbons  and  hydrogen  sulfide, their  primary  adverse
effect is  aesthetic. Odors will  be  discussed  further under article  M. 3.  Social
Impacts.


M. l.f.  Climate

The  effects  of  sludge management  systems  on climate are  minimal, generally lim-
ited  to  a small increase  in  humidity  in the  immediate  vicinity  of  the project.
This  increase may  be due  to evapotranspiration at  land  application sites  or heat
evaporation at incineration or heat  drying  projects.


M. 2   PUBLIC HEALTH IMPACTS

Public health impacts  must receive  careful  attention in  the  facility  plan.  Most
public health effects  of  sludge management  systems are  the result  of  impacts on
animal and  insect  life,  soils and vegetation,  groundwater quality, surface water
quality,  or air quality.


M.2.a.  Disease Vectors

Several  of  the  animals and insects  which are  known  to  thrive  in certain  sludge
management  systems are also known to be  vectors  for several diseases  of  man and
animals. Of particular concern in  this  regard  are  rodents, notably rats and mice,
flies and mosquitoes.

Rodents  are particularly  troublesome  on  sites which employ  the  co-disposal  of
sludge with  solid  waste  by landfill  or  composting.  The  solid  waste provides food
and  harborage  for  the rodents,  while  the sludge  may provide  a  source  of  patho-
genic organisms.  The existence of large numbers  of  the  rodents  in  a  small  area
such  as  a  landfill can enhance the  spread  of  the  diseases from  animal  to  animal
and  thence  to the  human  population.  Proper  operation of  a landfill or composting
operation can minimize the  rodent  problem.

Flies  are  a  potential  problem with  virtually  all  sludge  management  systems.
They  find  sludge  storage  and  disposal sites  to  be  very  hospitable,  feeding
directly on most sludges  and  laying  their eggs within the sludge. Aside from the
aesthetic  problems  associated  with  flies,   they are  mechanical  disease vectors,
carrying  small  particles  of   potentially  pathogenic sludge  on  their  bodies  and
legs. Upon  contacting  human beings or  human food,  the pathogenic  organisms may be

                                        96

-------
transmitted  to  people. Fly  control  is primarily  a  matter of  keeping  the sludge
covered  to  prevent  the  emergence  of  larvae.  Well-compacted,  daily  cover at
landfill  sites  and  subsurface  injection  at  land  application  sites  will   help
control flies. Mosquitoes are  known  to transmit several pathogenic organisms.

Mosquitoes breed  in standing water.  The most effective method of mosquito control
is proper grading  of  the site  to  prevent ponding of water.


M.2.b.  Soil and Vegetation

Soil and  vegetation impacts  are of concern  to  public health when  crops grown on
land application  or landfill sites or with  the aid of  sludge  by-products may be
introduced into  the human  food chain.  In this event,  toxic  substances deposited
in the soil with  the  sludge  may be transferred to the  crops,  and thence to human
beings.


M. 2.c.  Groundwater Quality

The effects of sludge management  or  groundwater quality are  a  public health  con-
cern whenever an aquifer is, or may  be,  used as a potable water supply.  Leachate
capture and  treatment may be  required in order  to  protect the  aquifer. Nitrate
pollution is the  most common problem, but toxic organics, dissolved salts, trace
elements, and pathogens must be considered.  Adequate leachate monitoring and  con-
trol practices must be included in the facility plan.


M.2.d.  Surface Water Quality

Surface water quality is  a  public health  concern  when  runoff  from  a sludge  man-
agement site enters a receiving water  which  is  used as a potable water supply for
recreational activities  involving bodily  contact  with  the water,  or for commer-
cial  or  recreational  fishing.  A  properly planned  landfill  or  land application
site will include  grading to divert  runoff around the  site and/or  to capture and
treat the runoff before it enters  the  receiving water.


M.2.e.  Air Quality

Air quality is a  public  health concern  from  two  standpoints: an increase  in the
incidence of respiratory diseases  from the increase in  the general  air pollution
level due to sludge combustion, heat  drying  or  transport activities; and the  pos-
sibility of aerosol-borne pathogens  from spray-type  land application sites.

Well-operated sludge  incineration  facilities  with  modern pollution  control equip-
ment have  a  relatively low  potential  for air  pollution when  compared  with,  for
example, automobiles  (61). The  facility  plan must  define the  operating parameters
for minimizing air pollution.  The facility  plan  must  take into  account  the  cur-
rent federal, state,  and local  air quality regulations and policies. Other public
health effects of  sludge combustion  process  pollutants and the  resultant products
(photochemicals) must  be evaluated in  the facility plan.

                                        97

-------
Aerosols  are  most  successfully controlled  by limiting their  travel.  This can be
done by use of  buffer  zones,  vegetation,  proper sprayer design, and scheduling of
spraying.


M.3.  SOCIAL  IMPACTS

The  impact of  sludge  management  on  the  sociological aspects  of  the  community
must be evaluated.
M.3.a  Relocation of Residents

Sludge  management  by  land  application  or  landfill  often  requires  substantial
quantities  of  land.  This  may  lead  to  relocation  of  residents.  For  projects
involving federal funds,  land  acquisition  procedures must comply with the Uniform
Relocation Assistance and Land Acquisition Policies Act  of  1970 (62).   Inconven-
ience to  residents  must be weighed against  the advantages  of  the  sludge manage-
ment system.


M.3.b.  Greenbelts  and  Open  Spaces

Proposed  sludge  management  systems  should  be evaluated  with  regard   to  their
effect on  greenbelts  and  open  spaces.  While  sludge management systems  may dis-
rupt existing  open  space, existing damaged  land,  such as  abandoned  strip  mines,
may  be  reclaimed  for   use  as  open  space  by  land  application  and  landfill
operations.


M.3.c.  Recreational Activities

Sludge  management  systems  may affect recreational activities  by disruption  of
existing  parks  or open space,  by  eventual creation of  new parks or  open  space,
by  improvement of  existing parks  where  sludge is  used off-site  by  the  local
parks department, or  by  the deleterious effects of site  run-off  on  recreational
waters.
M.3.d.  Community Growth

Unless the sludge management  system  is  the  capacity-limiting element of the over-
all  wastewater  treatment system,  the sludge management  technique  selected  will
have only a minor effect  on  the rate of community growth.  The  overall wastewater
treatment  system,  of which  the sludge management  system is only one  part,  may
however, have a major effect  on the  rate of  community growth.

The  patterns  of  community growth  may be  greatly affected  by the  sludge  manage-
ment  system.  Certain sludge  management systems  may  deter   residential  growth  in
the  vicinity of the  facility, while  encouraging  industrial  growth. The availabil-
ity  of recovered energy,  for  instance,  will  rarely  be so  significant as to affect
the  decision  of a  new industry  to move to  a community, but  it  could conceivably

                                        98

-------
be  a  factor in  determining  the exact  site for  the  industrial  development.  The
effects  of  sludge management  on the patterns  of growth  will affect  the  growth
patterns  of other  community  services,  which  must  be  evaluated  in  the  impact
assessment.
M.3.e.  Noise and Odor

Noise and odor  are  primarily aesthetic concerns which  affect  the other sociolog-
ical aspects of  the sludge management  system.  Nearly all  sludge management sys-
tems  are  prone  to  odor problems.  Noise  problems are  normally  associated  with
sludge  transport by  truck  and  with  landfill,  land  application  and  composting
operations. The  facility plan  should  address  these problems and formulate methods
of dealing with  them. Appropriate  scheduling of operations  can  be of great value
in  minimizing   noise  problems.  Adequate  stabilization  and  prompt  disposal  of
sludge can be of value  in  reducing  odor  problems  by eliminating septic conditions
in uncovered sludge.


M.4.  ECONOMIC IMPACT

The facility plan should consider  the effects of  the  sludge management system on
the economy.  The effect of  the system  on the value  of the  site itself  and  of
adjacent property must  be  evaluated.  The sludge management  system may affect the
overall economy in  terms  of  jobs created  and  land  removed from  agricultural
production. Public  ownership of  the sludge management  system  property may affect
the community tax base. The  overall effect  of  the  sludge management system on the
supply of resources and energy must be  considered.


Section N - IMPLEMENTATION PROGRAM
Selection  of  the  sludge management  system  is  based  on technical  feasibility,
cost-effectiveness,  flexibility,  reliability,  energy-effectiveness,  and  overall
impacts. At all  stages  of  the planning processes  the public must  be  involved in
order to aid  the  planner in selecting the most  cost-effective  system, especially
in considering non-monetary costs,  and in  assessing the impacts of the system.


N.I.  PUBLIC  PARTICIPATION  PROGRAM

An appropriate,  actively pursued  public  participation  program  can often make the
difference between a sludge management system which has the  support of the major-
ity of  the community and one  which is unable to  generate the  support  necessary
for successful  completion.  Public  resistance  to sludge management  systems  is an
almost  universal  phenomenon.   This  resistance is  often rooted  in misconceptions
and lack of understanding of  the  problems  and the  alternative solutions, and in a
feeling by the  community that  they have  been excluded from  the  decision-making
process. The  resistance may  also be due  to  valid  concerns  of the community  of
which the  planner is not fully aware. A vigorous public participation  program can
educate the community  concerning  the problems and  solutions  of sludge managment,
involve the public in a  constructive  manner  in the planning  process, and serve as

                                       99

-------
a valuable  information-gathering  tool  for the planner, assisting him in assessing
the impacts of  the  system  on  the  community.  The public participation plan must be
tailored  to the  scope  of the  project and to  the potential for community concern.

Public involvement  in  the  planning process  can,  of course,  slow  the  process and
may result  in additional cost.  On the  other  hand,  a lawsuit brought by uninformed
members of  the  community to  halt  a sludge management  program in the final stages
of planning,  or even  during  costruction, can be  far  more costly,  and  can delay
the  project for  a  much   longer  period  of   time.  While  a  public  participation
program will not  eliminate resistance  to a  proposed  sludge management  system, it
may be able to  reduce  that resistance  to a  manageable  level. The  EPA publication
Process Design  Manual for Municipal  Sludge  Landfills  (34)  has  a  great  deal of
information on  the design of  public  participation programs  which,  while written
primarily for landfill systems, is generally applicable  to all  sludge  management
systems.


N. 2.  POTENTIAL  ROADBLOCKS

The  facility  plan  should  identify potential  roadblocks  to  iraplmentation  of the
plan. Typical items  which  may  be  considered  are:

     •    Public  resistance  to  the  plan
     •    Inability  to obtain  necessary  financing
     •    Difficulty in acquiring land
     •    Where  the  plan involves a contract with  a  private  concern,  such as use
          of  sludge as a  raw  material by a fertilizer manufacturer,  failure to
          execute  the  anticipated contract.


N.3.  LAND  ACQUISITION PROGRAM

The facility plan  should include  a  proposal  for land  acquisition.  If the required
land is not already owned  by the  authority  operating  the  sludge  management  sys-
tem, it may be  acquired by:

     •    Negotiated purchase  of  land  or right-of-way
     •    Leasing  of land
     •    Purchase  by  condemnation  of  land or right-of-way
     •    Dedication of  land already  owned  by  the sludge-managing authority  or
          another  related  authority to  the sludge  management system


N.4.  IMPLEMENTATION SCHEDULE

The  facility  plan  should  include a  schedule  for  project  implementation.  The
schedule  should  include anticipated start and stop dates  for each  major activity.
The schedule should  take into  account  possible  delays in  implementation.

The schedule should  be broken  down to  the level of detail  justified by the scope
of the project.  As a minimum,  the  following  major  tasks should  be  included:


                                        100

-------
     1.   Facility  plan  approval
     2.   Land acquisition
     3.   Design
     4.   Design approval
     5.   Construction
     6.   Operation

Graphical   presentation   of  the   schedule   is  often   useful  as  an   aid  to
understanding.


N.5.  STAFFING PLAN

A preliminary  project staffing plan  should  be  included  to permit  the operating
authority  to begin  the  process  of  hiring  and  training personnel  at  the  most
appropriate  time. The staffing plan  should  consider needs in  the  following gen-
eral categories:

          Operations
          Maintenance
          Supervisory
          Laboratory
          Administrative

The staffing plan should be  developed to a level of  detail  justified  by the pro-
ject scope.


N.6.  COMPATIBILITY WITH REGULATIONS

The facility plan  must  include an  evaluation  of  the proposed  sludge  management
system  compatibility  with   the  applicable  federal,  state  and  local laws  and
regulations.


N.6.a.  Zoning and Land  Use

The plan  must  take  into consideration local  and  regional zoning  ordinances and
land use plans. The proposed  sludge management system must be  compatible with the
planned growth patterns  of  the community.


N.6.b.  Solid Waste Disposal

The management  of  sludge is  governed by  the  Resource Conservation and  Recovery
Act (2), the Toxic Substances  Control Act  (63) and  federal regulations pertaining
to  the  disposal  of  solid waste as  well  as those pertaining to  wastewater treat-
ment.  In addition,  many  states regulate  sludge disposal  under  their  solid waste
regulations  whenever  the material  is removed  from  the  treatment  plant  site,  as
for land application  or  landfill.
                                        101

-------
N.6.c.  Air Pollution Control

Sludge  incinerators  must comply  with the  "New  Source Performance  Standards  for
Sludge  Incinerators"  (43,   47,  64),  the   applicable provisions   of  the  Toxic
Substances Control Act  (63)  and any  applicable  federal regulations. In addition,
sludge  incinerators  and dryers must  comply with  the  mercury limitations  of  the
"Amendments to  the National  Emission Standards". Many state,  regional, and local
governments have air pollution  control  requirements  which are more stringent than
the federal requirements, all of  which must  be met.


N.6.d.  Water Pollution  Control

The sludge management  system must comply with the  Clean  Water Act  (65),  Federal
Water Polution  Control  Act  (4),  the  Resource  Conservation and Recovery  Act (2),
and the Toxic Substances Control Act  (53),  and all  applicable  federal  regula-
tions.  Any applicable  state or regional  laws  and regulations  must also  be met.
Until groundwater protection criteria are developed under  the  Resource Conserva-
tion and Recovery Act,  the groundwater  protection  criteria in the EPA publication
Alternative Waste Management Techniques for  Best Practicable  Waste Treatment (66)
shall be used.
N.6.e.  Public Health

Applicable  state and  local  regulations  regarding  pathogen  destruction must  be
complied  with.  These  regulations  often deal specifically  with hospital  wastes,
and sludge to which  public access  is  permitted  or encouraged.
                                        102

-------
   DESIGN AMD
SPECIFICATIONS

-------
                             DESIGN  AND SPECIFICATIONS

                                   INTRODUCTION
The design and specifications  package  should be a logical extension of the facil-
ity plan. The design  and  specifications  are for the purpose of implementation and
construction of  the sludge  management  system detailed in the facility plan. As an
aid to the evaluator,  basic  design  criteria should be included with the package.

The format of this checklist  has  been  selected to  enable  the  reviewer to enter a
checkmark or comment  to the  right of each item.  There are 6 major categories:

     A.  Agreement with Facilities  Plan
     B.  Sludge  Transport
     C.  Land Application
     D.  Landfill
     E.  Combustion
     F.  Off-Site Use of  Sludge by  Others

Within each  category  are numerous  sub-elements.  All the  major  categories should
usually  be included.  It  is  not necessary that all the  sub-elements  be included.
References are given  for  more detailed  information and design  criteria.  In par-
ticular,  the  EPA Process Design Manual for  Sludge Treatment  and  Disposal  (1)
should be consulted for specific  design  information. It  is  not  the intent of the
supporting commentary to  limit alternatives to just those discussed.  A particular
technique or process  may  be  described  as "best" or as "typical" but this does not
mean that other  procedures  are unacceptable.
                                        103

-------
                            DESIGN AND  SPECIFICATIONS

                                    CHECKLIST
A.   AGREEMENT WITH FACILITIES PLAN
     1.  MODIFICATIONS
     2.  CHANGES IN REGULATIONS AND  POLICIES  CONSIDERED
         (In Federal, State, and Local regulations;  in local  or
         regional land use  plans.)

B.   SLUDGE TRANSPORT
     1.  SLUDGE CHARACTERISTICS
         a.  Quantity: Maximum, Average, Minimum
         b.  Solids Content
         c.  Odor Potential
     2.  PIPELINE
         a.  Alternate Routes Considered
         b.  Distance
         c.  Elevation Changes
             (Air relief, vacuum relief)
         d.  Operating Program
         e.  Pipe Selection
             (Velocity, maximum and  minimum,  size, material,
             friction losses, corrosion control)
         f.  Pumping Facilities
             (Number and location of pumping  stations, number and
             type of pumps,  pumping  energy,  station  structure,  station
             utilities, controls.)
         g.  Pipeline Cleaning Provisions
         h.  Emergency Operation
             (Storage, standby power.)
         i.  Excavation Conditions Verified
             (Soil conditions, other underground  utilities, highways,
             rail crossings.)
         j.  Methods of Right-Of-Way Acquisition
             (Existing utility easements,  negotiation with  landowners,
             condemnation.)
     3.  TRUCKS
         a.  Alternate Routes Considered
         b.  Haul Distance,  Speed and Travel  Time
         c.  Compatability  of Proposed Route  with Existing
             Road and Traffic
             (Weight and height limits, turns required,  speed
             limits, traffic congestion, road width, elevation  changes,
             traffic control (stops, etc.).)
         d.  Operating Schedule
             (Loading time,  haul time, unloading  time, return time
             fueling and daily maintenance.)
         e.  Fuel Consumption
         f.  Manpower Requirements
                                        105

-------
    g.  Truck Selection and Acquisition
        (Size, type, quantity, useful  life,  purchase  lease.)
    h.  Contract Haul Considered
    i.  Facilities Required
        (Loading, unloading, vehicle maintenance,  fueling,
        parking,  washdown, sludge storage)
4.   BARGE
    a.  Haul Distance
    b.  Barge Speed and Travel Time
        (Traffic, drawbridges, locks,  tides, currents,  and  height
        limitations.)
    c.  Operating Schedule
        (Loading time,  haul time, unloading  time,  return  time.)
    d.  Barge Selection, Acquisition,  and/or Tow Boat Acquisition
        (Towed or self-propelled, type, size, quantity, useful
        life, purchase, lease)
    e.  Contract Haul Considered
        (Towing or complete operation.)
    f.  Manpower Requirements
    g.  Fuel Consumption
    h.  Facilities Required
        (Loading, unloading, barge and tow-boat maintaenance,
        fueling,  docking, and wash-down, sludge storage
5.   RAILROAD
    a.  Distance
    b.  Speed, Load-Limiting Factors,  and Travel Time
        (Clearance limitations, track  conditions,  traffic
        schedule)
    c.  Operating Schedule
        (Loading, haul, unloading and  return times)
    d.  Car Selection and Acquisition
        (Type, size, quantity, useful  life,  purchase, lease,
        or railroad owned)
    e.  Fuel Consumption
    f.  Manpower Requirements
    g.  Facilities Required
        (Loading, unloading, tank car maintenance, storage,
        and cleaning, sludge storage,  siding extensions.)
6.   ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACT
    (Air,  land, surface water, groundwater,  social, health,
    economic, historical,  archaelogical impacts, and environmen-
    tally sensitive areas.)
7.   REGULATIONS AND STANDARDS
    a.  Surface Water Protection
    b.  Sludge Loading  and Unloading
    c.  Construction Within Navigable Waterways
    d.  Building Codes
    e.  Reporting Spills
    f.  Permits
                                  106

-------
C.   LAND APPLICATION
     1.  SLUDGE CHARACTERISTICS
         a.  Type of Processing at Treatment Plant                       _
         b.  Quantity:  Maximum, Average, Minimum
         c.  Analysis                                                    _
             (Concentration, particle characteristics, volatile, content
             nitrogen, phosphorus, potassium, heavy metals, pathogen
             content, pH
     2.  TYPE
         a.  Crop Utilization                                            _
             (Crop(s) chosen, tillage requirements, application/
             crop growth timing, application method.)
         b.  Dedicated Disposal
             (Application method, tillage requirement.)
         c.  Land Reclamation
             (Present condition of site, soil-sludge reactions,
             application methods, tillage, requirements)
     3.  SITE CHARACTERISTICS
         a.  Topography
             (Limitations on application methods, erosion potential,
             crop compatibility.)
         b.  Runoff Control
             (From adjacent areas, on-site, storm flow added  to liquid
             sludge quantity, cut-off trenches, embankments for runoff
             diversion.)
         c.  Soil                                                        _
             (Soil Conservation Service soil maps; soil profiles:
             Location, physical properties, pH, CEC, heavy metals.)
         d.  Geohydrology
             (Map of geologic formations and discontinuities;
             groundwater: location,  extent, use.)
     4.  DESIGN CRITERIA
         a.  Climatic Factors                                            _
             (Rainfall:  quantity, duration, seasonal variation; wind
             velocity and direction, temperature variation)
         b.  Loading  Rates
             (1) Metals                                                  _
                 (Background level in soil, cation exchange capacity
                 limits, projected from industrial changes or pre-
                 treatment programs.)
             (2) Nitrogen                                                _
                 (Forms of nitrogen present, mineralization rate.)
         c.  Crops
             (1) Nutrient uptake                                         _
                 (Nitrogen, phosphorus,  potassium, micronutrients.)
             (2) Compatibility With Applications
                 (Tillage requirements,  timing of planting and harvesting,
                 can application be made on growing crop, forage, have
                 leaves been washed by rain or irrigation.)
             (3) Harvesting requirement
                 (Single harvest each year, multiple harvest each
                 year, continual or intermittent harvest (grazing).)

                                       107

-------
     5.  SYSTEM COMPONENTS
         a.  Dewatering
             (Percent solids achieved, chemicals  used)
         b.  Field Equipment
             (Compatibility with crops,  compatibility with  sludge,
             moisture content, compatibility with climatic  factors.)
         c.  Storage
             (Open, or covered; capacity to match non-operating
             periods, nuisance condition prevention  methods.)
         d.  Buffer Zones
             (Size, vegetation provided,  fencing.)
     6.  MONITORING
         a.  Land
             (pH,  pathogens, available nutrients, heavy metals.)
         b.  Crops
             (Yield, tissue analysis, disease  control.)
         c.  Water Quality
             (BOD, suspended solids, nutrients, coliforms,  etc.)
     7.  RELIABILITY AND FLEXIBILITY
         (Expandability, storage, alternate sludge management
         techniques.)

D.   LANDFILL
     1.  SLUDGE CHARACTERISTICS
         a.  Type of Processing at Treatment Plant
         b.  Quantity:  Maximum, Average, Minimum
         c.  Analysis
             (Concentration, particle characteristics, volatile
             content, nitrogen, inorganic ions, pathogen  content,  toxic
             organic compounds, pH.)
     2.  REGULATIONS AND STANDARDS
         (Sludge stabilization, sludge loading  rates, frequency
         and depth of cover, distances to road, residences  and
         surface water, monitoring, roads, building  codes,  permits.)
     3.  SITE CHARACTERISTICS
         a.  Site Plan
         b.  Soils
             (Depth, texture, structure,  bulk  density, porosity,
             permeability, moisture, ease of excavation,  stability,
             pH, cation exchange capacity.)
         c.  Geohydrology
             (Groundwater:  Location, extent,  use, geologic  formations,
             discontinuities, surface outcrops.)
         d.  Climate
             (Precipitation, evaportranspiration,  temperatures,
             number of freezing days, wind direction.)
         e.  Land Use
             (Present, final, adjacent property.)
     4.  LANDFILL TYPE
         a.  Sludge Only Trench Fill
             (1) Narrow trench
             (2) Wide trench

                                       108

-------
     b.   Sludge Only Area Fill
         (1) Mound
         (2) Layer
         (3) Diked contaminent
     c.   Co-Disposal With Refuse
         (1) Sludge-refuse mixture
         (2) Sludge-soil mixture
 5.   LANDFILL DESIGNS
     a.   Trench or Area Dimensions
         (1) Length
         (2) Width
         (3) Depth
     b.   Berm Dimensions
     c.   Trench or Area Spacing
     d.   Sludge Depth
     e.   Intermediate Cover Depth
     f.   Final Cover Depth
     g.   Bulking Agent
     h.   Bulking Ratio
     i.   Soil Importation
 6.   FACILITIES
     a.   Leachate Controls
         (Adequate surface drainage, natural attenuation,
         soil liners, membrane liners, collection and treatment.)
     b.   Gas Control
         (Permeable methods, impermeable methods, gas extraction.)
     c.   Roads
     d.   Soil Stockpiles
     e.   Inclement Weather Areas
     f.   Minor Facilities
         (Structures, utilities, fencing, lighting, washbacks,
         monitoring wells, landscaping, equipment fueling,
         storage and maintenance)
 7.   LANDFILL EQUIPMENT
     (Excavation, sludge handling, backfilling, grading,  road
     construction.)
 8.   MANPOWER REQUIREMENTS
 9.   FLEXIBILITY AND RELIABILITY
     (Expansion potential, modification for change in sludge
     volume or type, equipment failure locally, storage.)
10.   ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACTS
     (Air,  land, surface water, groundwater, social, health,
     economic, historical, archeological impacts, and
     environmentally sensitive areas.)

 COMBUSTION
 1.   SLUDGE CHARACTERISTICS
     a.   Type of Processing at Treatment Plant
     b.   Quantity: Maximum, Average, Minimum
     c.   Analysis
         (Moisture, heat value, nitrogen, sulfur, heavy
         metals, toxic organic compound.)

                                   109

-------
REGULATIONS AND STANDARDS
a.  Air Quality Requirements
    (Particulates, opacity, oxides of nitrogen, sulfur
    dioxide, carbon monoxide, heavy metals,  toxic organic
    compounds, hydrocarbons and carbonyls, odors.)
b.  Permits
MULTIPLE HEARTH INCINERATION OR PYROLYSIS
a.  Operating Schedule
b.  Reactor Design
    (1) Hearth loading rate
    (2) Hearth area
    (3) Number of hearths
    (4) Reactor dimensions
    (5) Rabble speed
    (6) Rabble drive cooling air requirements
    (7) Sludge feed system
c.  Auxiliary Fuel System
    (1) Start-up
    (2) Continuous operation
    (3) Standby
d.  Combustion and Excess Air Requirements
    (1) Incineration
    (2) Pyrolysis
e.  Incineration Ash Systems
    (1) Handling
        (a) Truck
        (b) Slurry pipeline
    (2) Disposal
        (a) Landfill
        (b) Lagoon
        (c) Land application
        (d) Off-site use by others
f.  Pyrolysis Residue Systems
    (1) Gas
    (2) Tar
    (3) Char
g.  Air Quality Control
    (1) Afterburners
    (2) Scrubbers
    (3) Electrostatic Precipitators
FLUIDIZED BED INCINERATION
a.  Operating Schedule
b.  Reactor Design
    (1) Bed loading rate
    (2) Bed area and diameter
    (3) Reactor volume and height
    (4) Sand bed volume
    (5) Fluidizing air requirement
    (6) Sludge feed system
c.  Auxiliary Fuel Systems
    (1) Start-up
    (2) Continuous operation

                              110

-------
         (3) Standby
     d.   Combustion and Excess Air Requirements
     e.   Incineration Ash Systems
         (1) Handling
         (2) Disposal
             (Landfill, lagoon, land application,  reuse  off-site
             by others)
     f.   Air Quality Control
         (1) Afterburners
         (2) Scrubbers
         (3) Electrostatic precipitators
 5.   WET AIR OXIDATION
 6.   OTHER PROCESSES
     a.   Cyclonic Reactors
     b.   Electric Incinerators
     c.   Proprietary Process
 7.   CO-DISPOSAL
     a.   Refuse Disposal
     b.   Refuse Derived Fuel
 8.   AUXILIARY FUEL SELECTION
     (Gas, oil, powdered coal, refuse derived fuel,  electricity.)
 9.   RELIABILITY AND FLEXIBILITY
     (Expandable facilities, multiple units, alternative
     reduction and/or disposal methods, storage, standby  power,
     standby fuel.)
10.   MASS BALANCE
     a.   Inputs
         (Dry solids in sludge, moisture in sludge,  air,  auxiliary
         fuel, make-up sand, and steam.)
     b.   Outputs
         (Ash, combustible gas, tar, char, water,  carbon  dioxide,
         carbon monoxide, sulfur dioxide, nitrogen,  sand,
         excess air.)
11.   ENERGY BALANCE
     a.   Inputs
         (Solids heat of combustion, and auxiliary fuel  heat
         of combustion, including after-burner.)
     b.   Outputs
         (Latent heat of free raoisture and moisture  of combustion,
         sensible heat of gases of combustion, excess air,  and
         moisture, sensible heat of ash, radiation,  sensible  heat
         of shaft cooling air, recovered energy  for  other  plant
         other plant processes.)
12.   ENERGY RECOVERY SYSTEMS
     a.   Shaft Cooling Air Recycle
     b.   Stack Gas Heat Exchange
     c.   Reactor Water Jacket
     d.   Wet Air Oxidation Effluent Heat Exchange
     e.   Pyrolysis Product Recovery
13.   ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACTS
     (Air, land, surface water, groundwater, social, health,
     economic impacts.)

                                    Ill

-------
F.  SLUDGE FOR OFF-SITE USE BY OTHERS
     1.  SLUDGE CHARACTERISTICS
         a.  Type of Processing At Treatment Plant
         b.  Quantity:  Maximum, Average, Minimum
         c.  Analysis
             (Moisture, nitrogen, phosphorous, potassium,
             heavy metals, toxic organic compound content,
             pathogens, heat content.
     2.  COMPOSTING
         a.  Bulking Agents
             (1) Finished compost
             (2) Refuse
             (3) Wood products wastes
             (4) Other wastes
         b.  Sludge Receiving and Mixing
         c.  Windrow composting
             (1) Windrow construction
             (2) Windrow mixing and turning
         d.  Static Pile Composting
             (1) Pile construction
             (2) Aeration system
             (3) Recycle of air for pile heating
         e.  Mechanical Composting Systems
         f.  Curing
         g.  Screening
         h.  Facilities
             (Bulking agent storage area, curing area,  screening,
             packaging, equipment storage, maintenance, and
             fueling areas, structures, utilities,  fencing.)
         i.  Equipment
             (1) Front end loader
             (2) Windrow turner
             (3) Aeration blowers and  piping
             (4) Mechanical composter
             (5) Screens
             (6) Dump trucks
     3.  DRYING
         a.  Drying Beds
             (1) Surface area
             (2) Sludge loading depth
             (3) Base design
             (4) Underdrain design
             (5) Wall design
             (6) Sludge removal
         b.  Drying Lagoons
             (1) Surface area
             (2) Lagoon depth
             (3) Surface water control
             (4) Berm design
             (5) Decanting system
             (6) Sludge removal
                                        112

-------
    c.   Heat Drying
        (1) Flash dryers
            (Flash drying cycle, incineration cycle,  effluent
            gas cycle, product handling cycle.)
        (2) Rotary kiln dryers
            (Rotary kiln, sludge feed system, effluent  gas
            system, product handling system.)
        (3) Air pollution control
            (Scrubber, filters, electrostatic precipitators.)
        (4) Auxiliary fuel
            (Gas, oil, coal, dried sludge, electricity.)
4.   COMPOSTING WITH REFUSE
    (Refuse as a bulking agent or sludge as a nutrient  source.)
5.   NUTRIENT ENRICHMENT
6.   PACKAGING
    a.   Pick Up By User
        (User loads, utility loads.)
    b.   Bulk Delivery To User
        (Truck, rail, barge.)
    c.   Bagged
        (Sold at site, or sold through usual fertilizer
        outlets.)
    d.   Instructions and Guidelines For Use
    e.   Brand Name
7.   ENVIRONMENTAL  IMPACTS
    (Air, land, surface water, groundwater, social,  health,
    and economic impacts.)
                                   113

-------
                           DESIGN AND  SPECIFICATIONS

                              SUPPORTING  COMMENTARY
Section A - AGREEMENT WITH  FACILITIES  PLAN

When  reviewing  the design  plans  and  specifications, the  evaluator must  have a
clear  understanding of  the facility  plan and  its  relationship  to  the  design.
The  design  should  conform  as closely  as possible  to  the  facility plan.  It is
often  necessary  or desirable, however, to deviate  from the  facility  plan as  the
project  progresses.  Deviation from  the facility  plan may be  due  to  new infor-
mation  or  to changes  in regulatory requirements.  The  design  and  specifications
package  submitted  for  review should include a  statement regarding agreement with
the  facility  plan with  emphasis  given to those  areas where the  design deviates
from  the facility  plan.  When deviations from the facility plan are  substantial, a
re-evaluation of  the plan,  in whole  or  part, may be required.


A.I.  MODIFICATIONS

Modifications  to facility  plans  are often  necessary, and may  be  the  result of
new  information  from  pilot   studies, detailed  site investigations,  or  any one of
a  number  of  other  sources.  Changes  in  regulations,  policies,  and  project goals
between  the time  of facility plan preparation and  the completion  of design plans
and  specifications  may  also necessitate  revision of   the facility  plan.  When  the
facility plan  is modified during the  design process, the  design  engineer should
prepare a full explanation  and justification of the changes.  This  explanation  and
justification  may take  the  form  of  a  supplement  to  the facility  plan  or  may be
submitted as supporting  material  with  the  design plans and  specifications.

Any  modification to the  facility plan must  be  evaluated to  assess  its  effect on
other  criteria of the  facility plan and  on  other treatment  processes  within  the
overall wastewater treatment-sludge  management system.  Particular  care  should be
taken  to  insure   that  any effects on  the wastewater  treatment  system  are taken
into account.
A.2.  CHANGES  IN REGULATIONS  AND  POLICIES  CONSIDERED

In  preparing  the  design  plans  and  specifications,  the  design  engineer  should
review  the regulations  and  official policies  relating to  the  sludge management
project  to determine if any  changes since the  preparation of  the  facility plan
affect  the  design  to  the  extent   that  modification  of  the  facility  plan  is
required.  This  review should cover, as  a  minimum,  federal, state  and local laws
and regulations and  local  or  regional  land use plans.

Section  B  -  SLUDGE TRANSPORT

Transport  facilities must  be designed  to  be  compatible  with  the  type  and quan-
tity  of  sludge produced at  the  treatment  plant. The  degree  of  processing prior
to  disposal will  also affect  the  design  of  transport  facilities.  The mode  of

                                        115

-------
transport  must  be appropriate  for  the type  of  sludge and  the  ultimate disposal
method.  Local conditions  and  environmental  features  may play  an  important role
in the design of  sludge  transport  facilities and the selection of equipment.


B.I.  SLUDGE  CHARACTERISTICS
B.I.a.  Quantity:  Maximum,  Average,  Minimum

The quantity  of  sludge produced will determine  the  size  of transport facilities.
If  equalization is  included,   the  average  quantity  produced  by the  final  unit
process (dewatering,  incineration,  etc.) will be the determining factor in trans-
port  sizing;  if  not  the  peak quantity should be used.   Staged items may be appro-
priate depending on  the  method  of  transport since some equipment is permanent and
other equipment has  a  short  service  life.

B.l.b.  Solids Content

The solids  content  is important in the  design  of auxiliary equipment  as  well as
the details of the transfer  equipment.   It may  be necessary  to  dilute  very thick
sludge for pipeline  transport.
B.l.c.  Odor Potential

Odorous  or  highly putrescible  sludge can  be a  nuisance,  particularly  in cases
where  the  transport  distances or  the transit times are  long.   Delays  in trans-
port  of  partially  stabilized   or conditioned   sludge  can  create  significant,
highly objectional odor problems.


B.2.  PIPELINE

Design of pipelines  for transport  of  0-4  percent sludge  solids is essentially the
same as for water  or  sewerage facilities(16).  The key factors in pipeline design
and  providing  adequate  appurtenant  facilities   are  described  in the  following
sections.
B.2.a.  Alternate Routes  Considered

Preliminary  design  is used  to reduce  the number  of  potential  pipeline  routes.
Generally, one  route  will be clearly  favorable  over the others,  however,  due to
unknown  or  hidden conditions,  a certain  amount of  flexibility should  be  main-
tained until final design is begun.   Crossings  can  add  significantly  to the cost
of the pipeline and to the complexity  of  construction
                                        116

-------
B.2.b.  Distance

The length of the sludge  pipeline  can have a significant  bearing  on  costs  of the
pipeline itself, on the pump  station  costs,  and on the annual O&M costs.   Sludge
pipelines can be  feasible for relatively short  distances  (approximately 5  miles)
up to fairly long distances (100 miles).


B.2.c.  Elevation Changes

In order  to  protect the  pipeline  from air binding due  to entrapped air or  from
collapse  due  to vacuums  which develop  when pumps  are stopped,  air and  vacuum
relief valves should be provided at critical  high  points  in the  line.


B.2.d.  Operating Program

A comparison use  of  constant  versus  variable  speed  pumps  is  important  in  deter-
mining the design flow  through the pipeline. Variable speed  pumps allow for  con-
tinuous  operation  and  lower  storage  requirements.  Constant  speed pumping  will
require  more  storage,  for  peak flow  dampening by equalization,  but is  usually
more efficient. The maximum and minimum  velocities are an important consideration
in pipeline  design. For  sludge transport  3 fps  is   a  satisfactory value  (16);
slower rates  can promote  solids  settling and  decomposition, while  higher  rates
cause scouring  and  increase  head  loss.  Since  pipelines   represent  a  significant
investment and have long  service  lives,  they should be sized to permit  efficient
operation  under existing conditions  yet  provide  adequate  capacity  for  future
growth.


B.2.e.  Pipe Selection

Sludge  pipelines are  generally  cement-lined  cast-iron  or   ductile  iron  pipe.
Friction  losses  should be  minimized  since  they can   contribute  significantly to
the pumping requirements.  Abrupt  changes in  slope and direction  should be  mini-
mized as they  introduce   headloss  for  in  excess  of  the  loss  through straight
pipe. Depending on the  nature of  the  sludge and the characteristics  of  the  soil,
corrosion-control features  should  be  incorporated  in  the  pipeline  design.
B.2.f.  Pumping Facilities

More  than  one pump  station  may be  needed if  the  piping  distance  is  long.  The
number  of  pump stations  should be  balanced  with  the  size  and  number  of  pumps
required for  the most cost effective  combination.  Pumps  should be appropriate for
the type of sludge to be  pumped and  standby units  must  be provided.


B.2.g.  Pipeline Cleaning Provisions

Pigging facilities,  or an appropriate alternative,  should be provided  to  allow
for cleaning  the sludge pipelines  on  a  regular  basis.

                                        117

-------
B.2.h.  Emergency Operation

Storage for several days  should  be  provided in case of equipment failure.  Diges-
ters can be used for  this purpose if available.  Standby  power should be provided
if  there  are  not two  independent  sources  of electricity  to the  pump  stations.
Additional storage may  be  substituted  for standby power under certain conditions,
although continuous operation  is  preferable.

B.2.I.  Excavation Conditions  Verified

Field  tests  should be  used to  establish  or verify  the  subsurface  soil  condi-
tions. Borings should be  taken after the pipeline  route  has  been established but
prior  to final design.  The report  should  be  used to  isolate  areas where special
design considerations  are needed.  If  highly  unusual  localized  conditions  exist,
they should be avoided, if possible, or  additional field  tests made.

Existing or other planned underground  utilities  should be  located  and field ver-
ified  if possible.  If  exact locations cannot be established,  the  contractor may
be held responsible for locating  them  during  design.


B.2.j.  Methods of Right-of-Way  Acquisition

Rights-of-way must  be  acquired  for all  pipelines.  This  process should  be  init-
iated  in  the  early stages of  the  project.  The preferable  method is  to  obtain
access rights on easements owned  or controlled by other utilities or to negotiate
with landowners. Condemnation  is  a  length,  complex procedure  which should be used
only after all other methods fail.


B.3.  TRUCKS


B.3.a.  Alternate Routes  Considered
It is often the case  that  several  possible  truck routes exist.  The advantages and
disadvantages of these must  be  examined  before  the final route  is established. An
alternative route should be  planned  to insure  uninterrupted transport of sludge.


B.3.b.  Haul Distance, Speed and Travel  Time

The  haul  distance  should  be minimized  to  reduce travel  time  and  the  potential
for  accidents  enroute to  the  disposal  site.  Topographic  features  may  influence
routing such that the shortest  haul  distance  is  not  the most favorable.  The prac-
tical limit  is  about  10  to 20 miles one-way,  although  in some  special  cases,
hauls of up to 80 miles may  be  cost-effective.

Effective speed and  travel time can  be  estimated from  the  haul  instance,  allow-
able  speed  of  various segments of the  route and the anticipated  traffic  condi-
tions.  In  scheduling sludge hauling, activities  during the day may affect  the


                                       118

-------
travel  time; periods  of  heavy  traffic  should  be  avoided both  from  a safety
standpoint and  for  efficiency  of  operation.


B.3.c>  Compatibility of  Proposed Route with Existing Road and Traffic


The existing  conditions  must be considered  in  the  evaluation  of truck transport.
Physical constraints  such as weight,  height and speed limits  may  preclude truck
transport and will  definitely influence vehicle and  route selection.  Local traf-
fic congestion  and  traffic  controls  will not  only influence  routing  but should
also  be  considered  in   determining   the  transport  operation  schedule.  Public
opinion on the  use  of  local roadway,   particularly  residential  streets  may have a
significant  effect  on truck transport  operation.


B.3.d.  Operating Schedule

An operating  program  must be outlined  to insure efficient operation and adequacy
of  facilities.  Realistic estimates  of loading,  unloading  and round-trip  haul
times should  be made.  Daily maintenance of  the trucks and  other  facilities  must
also  be included  in the  working  schedule.  The trade-offs  between  longer working
hours  and  more hauling  equipment should  be  considered  when  scheduling sludge
hauling.


B.3.e.  Fuel Consumption

Fuel  availability  and costs can  have  a profound impact  on the future  of sludge
hauling activities.   Larger trucks  tend  to  be  more  fuel  efficient  than smaller
ones. Also,  short haul  distances  over flat  terrain will  have  lower fuel require-
ments than long distances and  hills.


B.3.f.  Manpower Requirements

Manpower  requirements  can   be  determined  from the  operating  schedule.   Truck
drivers  and  mechanics  as   well   as   loading  and  unloading  personnel  will  be
required for an efficient sludge  hauling  operation  (16).


B.3.g.  Truck Selection and  Acquisition

Truck selection is  based  on sludge type and quantity.  The  size, type  and number
of trucks must  be  specified. The  useful  life and  long-term maintenance require-
ments of the vehicles  should be  considered  in the selection  of sludge transport
trucks  (16).

The trade-offs  between  purchase and lease  should  be evaluated  before  the method
of acquisition  is determined.
                                                              Protection Agency
                                        119       Ubrary               R«>m
                                                  401 M Street, SW, WSM  PM-213
                                                  Washington, D.C.   204««

-------
B.3.h.  Contract  Haul  Considered

For  small  plants in  particular,  the  possibility  of  contracting  for  periodic
sludge  hauling  may be  feasible. If such  a program is undertaken,  a contract and
guarantee of reliable  service  will  be  required.


B.3.1.  Facilities Required

Plant-site  loading facilities  should be  accessible and  in a convenient location.
Depending  on the type  of  sludge  being  hauled,  hoppers  or  pipelines  will  be
needed  to load  the  trucks.  Unloading is  generally by  gravity,  either at  a trans-
fer station  or  directly  on  the land application  site.  Vehicle storage and a main-
tenance/repair  shop  should  be  located  at the plant site.  Washdown equipment and
parking should  be nearby.

Sludge  storage  facilities will be needed  at  the  plant  site. The capacity of these
facilities will be influenced  by  the sludge  unit processes and the reliability of
the transfer system.


B.4.  BARGE

The characteristics  of a barge  transport system  are  described in the following
sections.  These  have  been generalized  and may not  pertain  to  all  barging
operations.


B.4.a Haul Distance

The haul  distance is an important  parameter  since it affects  several  aspects  of
operation.


B.4.b.  Barge Speed  and  Travel Time

In planning  a barge  transport  system,   speed  factors  can play  an  important  role.
The traffic  on  the  waterway;  physical  features,  such as  drawbridges, locks  and
height  limitations;  and natural characteristics such  as currents  and  tides  will
all affect  the  speed  of barge operation.  Certain delays  may  be   hard to  judge,
therefore travel  time  estimates should  include a conservative safety factor.


B.4.c.  Operating Schedule

An  operating schedule  should  be  developed  taking  the  loading,  unloading  and
round-trip travel times  into consideration.  This is  critical when  contracting for
towing  service.
                                        120

-------
B.4.d.  Barge Selection, Acquisition and/or Tow Boat Acquisition

A major  consideration in  barge selection  is  the choice  between towed  or  self-
propelled.  Other  factors  such  as  the  size and number  are  related to  the  plant
size  and  specific sludge  processing system  (16).  The  useful  life of  equipment
will  have a  significant  influence  of  the overall  economics  of  the  transport
operation.  The trade-offs between purchasing  and leasing barges must  be weighed.
The  final selection  will  depend  on  the   size  of   the  barges,  use  demands  and
service life.  Depending on  the frequency  of  barge  towing,  economics  may  favor
purchase  over lease  of a  tow  boat.  This  is  likely  not warranted  except  for
sizeable  facilities with large  quantities  of  sludge  to  be transported.


B.4.e.  Contract Haul Considered

For  moderate-sized operation,  contract towing  will most  likely be  the favored
method  of  barge  transport.  For  small operations  with  intermittent  transport
requirements,  contracting  for   complete  transport  service  may prove   the  most
practical, efficient and economical.  Contractual agreements  should  clearly define
all services  to be provided  and include a  barging schedule.


B.4.f.  Manpower Requirements

The manpower  requirements  should be  determined so that  there  is an  adequate  staff
of properly  trained  individuals to  carry   out  the  sludge transfer and  transport
services.
B.4.g.  Fuel Consumption

Unless  self-propelled  barges are used,  the fuel  use  will be  the  responsibility
of  the  towing company.  In  general, larger  barges are  more  fuel efficient  than
smaller ones.
B.4.h.  Facilities Required

Sludge  loading and  unloading  will  require  pumping  facilities  and  relatively
short  pipeline.  Maintenance, fueling  and cleaning  facilities  should  be  located
near  the  loading  dock.  Storage  requirements  at the docking  site will  depend  on
the  amount  of  storage  at  the   processing  site and on  the   reliability  of  the
process and transport systems.
B.5.  RAILROAD

Railroad  transport  is  not common,  therefore  examples  of  existing systems  are
scarce. The  following general guidelines  should be  modified  to fit the  partic-
ulars of the proposed railroad transport  system.
                                        121

-------
B.5.a.  Distance

The  feasible  haul distance  for rail  transport  is dependent  on the  quantity of
sludge  transported,  the  cost  of transportation  and  the  value  of sludge  at the
receiving end. Haul distance usually  range from 50 to 150 miles.


B.5.b.  Speed and Load-Limiting Factors  and Travel Time

The  speed of  railroad  transport will  depend  on  the  track conditions  and traffic
schedule. The  limits on  loads will  determine  the size  and  type  of  cars  to be
used. If the  shipper  is supplying cars,  they will be required  to  meet  the  rail-
road's clearance  limitations.  The  effective speed  and  travel  time will  depend on
the  railroad's  operating  schedule.  Realistic  estimates  of  travel time  will be
necessary to assess the suitability of the system for meeting transport  needs.
B.5.c.  Operating Schedule

An operating  schedule based  on  loading time  requirements and  on  the railroad's
required  travel  time  should be  outlined  during design  to  insure  adequate trans-
fer,  transport and  storage  facilities.


B.5.d.  Car Selection and Acquisition

The type,  size and  number of cars selected  will  depend on the  type and quantity
of sludge  being  transported  and  on  the  transport  distance. The useful life of the
cars and  the  frequency  of maintenance will have an impact on the economics of the
operation.

Tank  cars are ordinarily supplied  by  the  shipper.  If  liquid sludge  is  to  be
transported  by  rail,  cars  can  either  be  purchased or  leased from  the manufac-
turer.  Dump  cars which would be needed for dewatered sludge are  often  owned  by
the railroad  and available  on a  rental  or  fee  basis.
B.5.e.  Fuel Consumption

Fuel supply will  be  the responsibility of the railroad.  Costs will be included in
the transport charges.


B.S.f.  Manpower  Requirements

Staff  will  be required  for loading  and unloading  the  railroad  cars and  for a
varying amount of maintenance,  depending on type and ownership of the cars.
                                        122

-------
B.5.g.  Facilities Required

Railroad  sidings  will be necessary  at  both the  treatment  facility  and  the dis-
posal site. At  the  treatment plant,  the  siding could be designed  in conjunction
with  the  chemical  delivery  facilities.  Loading  and  unloading facilities  will
depend on the type  of sludge being transported and  the  ultimate disposal method.
Car maintenance storage  and  cleaning  will depend  on the type and ownership of the
cars.
B.6.  ENVIRONMENTAL  IMPACTS

The  environmental  impacts of  the transport  system should be  clearly identified
and mitigating measures designed  to  lessen any negative impacts.  A certain amount
of air pollution is  associated with vehicular  transport  of  sludge.  Emission con-
trols will  minimize  this potential.  The  impact  of transport  facilities  on land
use  is minimal.  Disruption  from pipeline  construction  is short-term.  Most routes
can  be  restored  to near  their original condition  in  a relatively  short  time.  A
small amount of  land  will be dedicated  to  permanent  use  for  transfer facilities.
The  impact  of  this is usually minor due  to  the  remote  location  of  most  facili-
ties. Of  the methods  available for  sludge transport,  barging has  the  greatest
potential for having  adverse effects on surface  water.   Accidental  sludge spills
which would cause  surface water  pollution  should be  guarded  against. There  is
little danger  that a  groundwater supply  would  be  adversely  impacted  by sludge
transport.

Public  acceptability  of  the  transport  method  and  route  can  have  a  profound
effects on  system  operation. Safety features  are important,  particularly  in con-
gested areas where accidents are  more  likely to occur.  The handling, transfer and
transport of sludge  can represent  a  certain health hazard; however,  with adequate
precautionary  measures  taken,  this  can   be  minimized.  Sludge   spills   and  the
resultant human  contact can  be a  health problem if not quickly  attended to.

The  financial  impacts  of sludge  transport  should be  fully  analyzed.  Possible
measures  for reducing  costs  should be explored and  implemented as practical.   In
the  long  run,   a  comprehensive   maintenance  program will  reduce  the  general
operating costs  of the  transport system  and  minimize unnecessary  and  expensive
emergencies. Local historical  and  archaeological  sites of significance identified
in  the  facility  plan should  be  protected.  Care  should  be  taken  to  minimize
disruption  of environmentally  sensitive areas identified in the facility plan and
to protect  any endangered species in  the  vicinity. Such  impacts  are  not  usually
significant  in  predisturbed  areas  such  as  treatment   plant  sites  or  pipeline
rights-of-way.


B.7.  REGULATIONS  AND  STANDARDS

The  engineer must be  cognizant  of  the  regulations governing design and  other
local,  state and  federal standards  which must  be met.  These must  be  followed
throughout  design  and  construction,  and any  conflicts  resulting  from overlapping
jurisdictions must be  resolved.


                                        123

-------
B.7.a.  Surface Water  Protection

Surface  water quality  must  be maintained during  construction and  operation of
all facilities. Federal  standards  have been set in P.L.92-500 and its amendments;
local  water  quality  standards  may,   however,  be more  rigorous  and  must  be
followed.
B.7.b.  Sludge Loading and Unloading

Certain  local  regulations   may govern  the  methods  used  for  sludge  transfer.
Clean-up  will be  essential  and  there  may be  restrictions  on  the  disposal  of
spilled sludge.


B.7.c.  Construction Within  Navigable  Waterways

There  are  strict regulations  regarding  construction  in  navigable  waters.  These
should be  thoroughly  examined during  the preliminary  stages  of  design.  Often the
waters  are  multi-jurisdictional,  therefore,   more  than  one   agency  will  be
approving  plans and specifications  and monitoring construction.


B.7.d.  Building Codes

All  local  building  codes and  applicable employee health  and  safety requirements
must  be  met  by new construction  projects.  In  addition,  it  may be  required  that
existing facilities being modified  comply fully to current codes.


B.7.e.  Reporting Spills

Depending  on  local  and  state regulations,  the  reporting  of sludge  spills  may  be
required.  This  is  particularly important if  such spills   result in  the  violation
of surface discharge  regulations.  The  operating  agency should be  informed  of the
procedures for filing such a  report.


B.7.f.  Permits

All  necessary permits  for  field  studies,  construction  and  operation  should  be
identified early in the  design  stages. Procurement procedures  should be initiated
in sufficient time  so that  progress is not  delayed  because of the  lack of  proper
permits and approvals.
                                        124

-------
Section C - LAND APPLICATION
C.I  SLUDGE CHARACTERISTICS
C.I.a. Type of Processing at  Treatment  Plant

Stabilization  and  dewatering  processes  impact the  type  of land  application and
equipment used as different equipment is  used  for liquid  and dewatered sludges.


C.l.b. Quantity:  Maximum, Average, Minimum

The average sludge  quantity  is necessary  to  determine the  land  application area
requirements  and  in estimating the  useful life  of  the site.  Maximum quantities
are  required   to  determine   equipment  and  storage  facility   capacities  and  to
estimate daily operating schedules.


J3. I.e. Analysis

The  solids  concentration  affects the  application  equipment  type  and  capacity.
Particle  or  physical characteristics  impact   the  soil  conditioning value  of the
sludge. Volatile content is important for  estimating the  potential for developing
odors while being stored or  surface applied.   The  importance of heavy  metals, pH,
and  nutrient   content  monitoring  has  been discussed  in  the facility  planning
section.
C.2.  TYPE

The types of  systems  included below are crop  utilization,  dedicated disposal and
land reclamation.  Some  areas may include a  combination  of  two or  three  of these
types of systems.  A  typical  design for crop utilization  is  presented in Appendix
A.
C.2.a.  Crop Utilization

Crop utilization  systems  are designed to take advantage  of  the  nutrient contents
as well as the soil  conditioning  properties  of  the sludge.  In the facilities plan
a  crop or  crops  were  selected   for  utilization  of  sludge.   These  crops  were
selected  for either  their cash value, nitrogen  or  phosphoruous  utilization rate,
or  their  tolerance  of heavy  metals.  This  selection should be  reviewed  at  the
beginning  of  the  design phase and  adjusted if necessary.   Along  with  the  crop
selection, individual  tillage requirments should be  determined.  Grain  crops such
as corn require annual tillage.  Other crops such as  forages  require tillage only
when  a new stand is  desired (several  years).  The  significance  of  determining
tillage requirements is  for  costs  and  coordination with application operations so
sludge  incorporation can be completed  simultaneously.  In the  case of  a  forage
crop,  incorporation is  not  possible  except by an  injector system.  Therefore,

                                        125

-------
applications  on  forage  crops  will  usually  be  by  surface   systems  unless  an
injection system  can  be  used.  The design should specify  the  application cycle in
detail.  Some  crops such  as  forages  can receive  applications during  the  growth
phase  with  a  rest period  just  prior  to harvest or  grazing by animals.  The rest
period time depends on  the frequency  of  rainfall or  irrigation.

Liquid sludge is  applied  by  spraying from a modified  irrigation  system,  spraying
from a truck,  injection  by  tractor-towed  system, injection  by  a  truck mounted
system  or  by  a  surface  irrigation  type  system  such as  ridge  and  furrow  or
flooding. Dewatered  sludge  is  usually  applied  by  trucks with  moving  beds  and
spreading mechanisms or conventional  agricultural  manure  spreaders.


C.2.b.   Dedicated Disposal

Land application  for  disposal  or dedicated  disposal systems  are  similar to crop
utilization systems  except application  rates  exceed agronomic rates.  Crops will
not  always  grow well in  these  conditions and are generally  not  of  major  impor-
tance  to  system  design.  Application methods and tillage  requirements are similar
to those described above.
C.2.c.  Land Reclamation

Land reclamation  systems  may  be designed for future  agricultural  use,  park land,
residential development  or  commercial use.  The design  of  the  reclamation project
will  depend  on the  future  use  and conditions  of  land  being reclaimed.  If  the
site's future planned use is  agricultural or  residential,  then heavy metal limits
should be  observed  (Part I,  Section F.6).  Nitrate contamination,  of  groundwater
should be avoided. Surface  application  of dewatered-stabilized sludge  can be left
without  incorporation allowing more of the  ammonia  to  volatilize rather  than
nitrify,  thus  allowing  somewhat  higher   application   rates.   The   cumulative
phosphorus levels  should  be monitored if the site  is to be  used  for agriculture,
residential  development, or  parks.  Procedures  for  dedicated  disposal  systems
apply to other uses.

The  site  should  be analyzed  to determine  whether  the  soil  is in  poor  condition
due  to  natural causes  or  as  a result  of  strip mining   or  some   other  man-made
activity. Naturally  occurring  poor  soils  usually  require more organic  material
and  nutrients. Disturbed  soils  resulting from mining activities usually  have  low
pH  values and  higher  than  normal  concentrations  of   trace  elements  or  heavy
metals. Each site  analysis  should include  these  items. The analyses should  also
consider  potential reactions  of  constituents in the  ludge with  constituents  in
the  soil. The  same application  methods  can be used  for   reclamation projects  as
used  for  crop utilization  projects. Tillage requirements  are  the  same  as  the
other systems  except possibly  where  loading  rates  are significantly higher  than
agronomic rates.   In  some instances  deep  plowing  may  be  necessary instread  of
disking.
                                        126

-------
C 3.  SITE CHARACTERISTICS
C.3.a.  Topography

Extremely  hilly  areas may limit  application equipment operation.   Proper design
should  include  slope determination  to check  if the  application method  will be
operable.  Site ground slopes  should  be determined and reviewed to develop erosion
control  practices.  Even  row  crops such  as  corn may  not  be feasible  on certain
soils  with  high slopes.  This  problem  can  be minimized   somewhat  by  contour
planting or  terracing.


C.3.b.  Runoff Control

The design  should include runoff control facilities  containing  or rerouting run-
off from adjacent areas.  These  facilities may consist of  small  basins  where run-
off can be  contained  and  allowed to percolate or evaporate.  Another option would
be to place  a ditch along  the affected area  in order to  route runoff elsewhere. A
third option provides for  use  of existing drainways.  The  design  should  allow for
buffer  areas between application  areas  and  drainways in  order  to  minimize  the
possible contamination  of  drainage water. Provisions  made for control  of run off
from  liquid sludge  applications  should  be  designed  for an  emergency  situation.
Generally,  if  the system  is  being properly  operated there  should  be  no  runoff
created by  liquid in  the  sludge.  Runoff resulting  from  rainfall on the applica-
tion  site  must  be contained or  controlled so that  this  runoff   does not contam-
inate nearby surface water.


C.3.c.  Soil

The soil  characteristics  at the  proposed land  application  site  should  be  typed
and mapped.  The  pH and  cation exchange  capacity should  be  determined  for  each
soil type.  As discussed earlier  these  parameters impact  the  movement and possible
plant uptake of  heavy metals.  Other parameters  that  are important  to  design are
water intake rate, permeability, heavy metal  concentrations,  and  texture.


C.3.d.  Geohydrology

The groundwater  aquifers  underlying the  land  application site need  to  be delin-
eated. The  depth of  the aquifer  under varying conditions  should  be  determined at
several locations. Other  characteristics  such as the  direction and  rate of  flow,
the hydraulic gradient, the quality,  and present and  planned uses  should also be
established. The location  of the primary  recharge zones  is critical  in  protecting
quality.

The geologic formations  underlying  the  land  application  site  are  important  in
establishing the design parameters.  The  type of  bedrock; its depth,  fractures,
and surface  outcroppings;  and any  faults  are  critical design factors.
                                        127

-------
C.4.  DESIGN CRITERIA
C.4.a.  Climate Factors

In  order  to  determine  application  equipment  sizing  the  designer  should  have
included an estimate  of  the number of  days  when  operations are  not possible due
to  rainfall.  Twenty-year  records  are  preferred  for analysis  of  rainfall  data
concerning agricultural  operations. Wind  velocity  and direction  is  important  in
minimizing movement of  aerosols and development  of buffer areas  to minimize the
possibility of  aerosols  reaching  neighboring  property.  This  is a  concern  with
spray  type  systems.   Temperature  variation  is  critical  mainly  with  surface
application during  freezing weather  when the  ground is  frozen or  covered  with
snow.  Unless  special  procedures  are  taken  to avoid  water pollution  problems,
surface  application  should be  halted  during these  periods.  Local  farm advisors
are the preferred source  for freezing data.


C.4.b.  Loading Rates


C.4.b.(l)   Metals -  Design of  crop utilization  or  reclamation systems  should
include  a  determination  to  prevent possible  heavy  metal buildup.  The  design
should include  the  following items:  background  level of  heavy metals  (Pb,  Zn,
Cu, Ni, Cd); soil cation exchange  capacity limits  (see Table 9).

C.4.b.(2)  Nitrogen - Crop  utilization  systems should include  a determination  of
nitrogen forms  present  and  an estimate  of the  mineralization  rate.  Additionally,
the designer should have  specified a  procedure  for  confirming  the actual mineral-
ization rate (see Table 8 and Appendix  A).


C.4.c.  Crops


C.4.c.(l)  Nutrient Uptake - The crop or  crops  chosen should  be listed along  with
nitrogen,  phosphorus,  potassium,  and  micronutrient  requirements  for  each.  The
table  used  for  planning purposes  should  have been reviewed  with the  local  farm
advisor  to see  if  local  conditions will cause  variations in the  recommended
quantities. (See Table 8  for typical values).

C.4.c.(2)   Compatibility with  Applications  -  Different   crops  are  harvested  in
different ways  at different  times  of the  year.  Land  application  systems  must  be
designed  with  this   in  mind.  Tillage  requirements  for  incorporating  surface
applied  sludge  would  interfer with  growing  a forage crop. Application  schedules
must  be  timed  so  as  not  to interfer  with  planting and  harvesting.  Each  crop
should be reviewed to determine  if application  can  be made  on  the growing crop.

C.4.c.(3)   Harvesting Requirement - Critical to  both the  application procedures
and  harvest  operations  is  the  timing  and  frequency  of  harvest.  Some  crops  are
harvested  once  a year  with the  plant   removed completely  or   destroyed.  Forage
crops  such as alfalfa are harvested several  times a year with  the  plant base and
root system left intact,
                                        128

-------
C.5.  SYSTEM COMPONENTS

Within  the  treatment plant there  are  system components  which impact application
procedures or methods.  These  are discussed in  the  following sections. The design
reviewer  should  be  sure  that  the  designer  has   developed  compatible  systems
throughout (e.g. dewatered sludge  can't  be injected).


C.5.a.  Dewatering

Dewatering  designs   or  systems  should  be  reviewed to  determine  percent  solids
achieved  or  expected and the  chemicals  used.  Solids  content will  impact  trans-
port and application  methods and costs.


C.5.b.  Field Equipment

Field  equipment should  be designed  to  be compatible  with  crops.  Any  type  of
application equipment can  be  used  for annual  crops if  the  application  is accom-
plished  between harvest and  planting.  Spray  injection  systems  are  limited  with
forage  crops.  Also  capacities must be  designed for  the expected  number  of  days
each year  when  application can  actually  take  place.  The field  equipment  design
should be compatible  with  the  moisture  content of  the sludge.  Variation in mois-
ture  content  can limit  the type  of  equipment  and impact  costs  of alternative
types of equipment.  Equipment  should  also be designed to  acclimate to field  con-
ditions  caused  by  climatic conditions.  High  flotation  tires  or  tracked vehicles
are often necessary  to insure mobility.


C.S.c.  Storage

Lagoon  or  pond  storage  systems  are very  economical  to construct  and  maintain.
The reviewer should  analyze designs of  these  systems for adequate embankment  pro-
tection. Covered storage is less common  than  open  storage due to the higher cost.
Covered storage or  tank  storage  is preferred  when  storage areas  are near residen-
tial  areas.  There  are  several  potential  nuisance conditions.  They are  odors,
insect breeding, excessive weed  growths  on embankments,  or vector breeding.  Pre-
ventive methods should be included in the  design.  These  include  chemical addition
facilities or aeration for odor control and  proper  design of  embankment  slopes
and liquid depths to  minimize the  others.


C.5.d.  Buffer Zones

Buffer zone size should  be  justified  in the design. Applicable  regulatory agency
requirements should be reviewed.  Spray  systems require the largest  buffer  area
(especially in windy  areas) and  injection systems  the least.  The designer should
provide rationale for  selection  of the type of  vegetation in the buffer  zone.  The
type depends on the  needs of the buffer  area.  Examples are shrubs for aesthetics,
grass for erosion control, and trees for wind  breaks.  Fencing requirements depend
on the surrounding  land  use. If  the  site is rural  with  privately owned  land  then
a simple animal detainment fence may be  sufficient. In an area near public acces-
sible lands a chain  link fence may be necessary.
                                        129

-------
C.6.  MONITORING
C.6.a.  Land

Soils  monitoring should  include pH,  CEC,  nitrogen,  phosphorus,  potassium,  and
heavy  metals  (Cd,  Cu,  Zn, Pb, Ni).  The  nutrient analyses are  necessary for good
crop  growth and for  preventing excessive  amounts of  nitrogen or  phosphorus  in
suceeding  applications or  for  determining additional  nutrient  needs.  Potassium
is  not normally a  problem but  monitoring  is  necessary to  determine  additional
needs  for  good  crop growth. The pH,  CEC and  metals  determinations  are necessary
for preventing  metals  accumulations  in soils  or crops.  Pathogen monitoring should
be as  specified  by  the  regulatory  agency.


C.6.b.  Crops

Crop  monitoring should include  yield, crop  disease,  and crop  pest evaluations.
Tissue analysis  may be  required  periodically  for food-chain crops. Crops destined
for human  consumption  should  be  monitored for pathogens.


C.6.C.  Water Quality

Surface  waters   and  intermittent streams  (when flowing)  should be  monitored  as
required by the  appropriate  regulatory agencies. Monitoring points should include
at least one sampling  station upstream of  the application area and one downstream
from  the  application  area.  Frequencies  depend  on circumstances  of  each  site.
Minimum  parameters  include 3005,  suspended  solids,  nutrients,  and  coliforms.
Nearby domestic  wells should be tested  prior  to  project  startup and  then  moni-
tored  periodically.  On-site  monitoring wells   should  be placed  and  sampled  as
required by the  appropriate  regulatory agency.  At  a minimum,  tests should include
nitrates,  total  dissolved  solids and coliforms.


C.7.   RELIABILITY AND  FLEXIBILITY

Reliability  is  normally  provided  by extra storage facilities. Some  systems  may
have  standby equipment  and/or a good spare parts  inventory.  Designs should  iden-
tify  potential   application  areas  for  future  expansion,  and  operational  flexi-
bility. Flexibility may be attained by converting  a  crop growing area  to a dis-
posal  area or  switching  to  a  different type   of  crop. This  may  allow  greater
loading  rates.  The  design  should  consider  this option.  The  decision  for  deter-
mining the  proper amount  of standby equipment  should be  justified  in the  design.
Standby  tractor or trucks  can  be  very  costly  and  may  not  be necessary if  the
right  spare parts inventory  is maintained.


Section D  - LANDFILL

The design  of a  sludge landfill depends on many interrelated  factors.  These will
be addressed  in the following  sections.  For more  detail regarding  these  areas,

                                        130

-------
the evaluator is  referred  to  Process  Design Manual for Municipal Sludge Landfills
(34). An example  landfill  design  calculation is given in Appendix B.


D.I.  SLUDGE CHARACTERISTICS

The  first  step   in  landfill  design  is   to   clearly  define  certain  sludge
characteristics.
D.I.a.  Type of Processing at  Treatment  Plant

Stabilization  and  dewatering processes  effect  the type oflandfill  and the daily
quantity of sludge that  can  be  accepted.


D.l.b.  Quantity; Maximum, Average, Minimum

The sludge  quantity  is necessary  in  establishing the  landfill  area requirements
and in  estimating  the useful  life of the  site.  The  average quantity  will prove
most  useful  for  this purpose.  Maximum sludge quantities  will  be needed  to size
equipment and  storage facilities and  for  determining  daily operating schedules.


D. I.e.  Analysis

The solids content or concentration  of sludge is  related  to  the  nature of waste-
water  treatment  and  to  the  sludge processing  steps. The  type  and  operation  of
dewatering equipment has, perhaps,  the most significant effect  on the sludge con-
centration. A  certain degree of flexibility  should be  incorporated  in  the design
of  landfills  to  compensate  for the  variability  in  dewatered  sludge.    Volatile
solids content of the sludge determines  the gas  produced and the long term volume
reduction of solids.  Typically the volatile  portion  of sludge ranges  from 30  to
80  percent.  Gas  is generated  at  16 to  18  ft^/lb volatile  solids  destroyed(34).
Almost all  the volatile  solids will  eventually  be destroyed. The  nitrogen found
in  sludge  represents a  potential  source  of  groundwater  pollution.    The total
quantity of nitrogen  as  well as the  species  present  are of  importance.   Nitrate
is  the principal species of  concern  and  is relatively mobile in  soil.  It  is con-
servative  to  assume  that all  of  the  nitrogen forms  present  will  eventually  be
oxidized to nitrate.   Inorganic  ions  such  as heavy metals are found  in most munic-
ipal  sludge. These can be leached  if  soil and sludge are  acidic.  If near  neutral
conditions can be maintained,  the  metals will not be as readily  leached from the
sludge. Most  sludge  treatment  processes  reduce   the  number  of  pathogens  and  the
possibility of pathogenic contamination  associated with sludge  landfilling (34),
but do  not  provide  a  sterile product.  Toxic  organic compounds  can   present  a
potential  contamination  problem.   These  should  be  identified  and  dealt  with
according to their nature and  the  disposal  methods employed.
                                        131

-------
D.2.  REGULATIONS AND  STANDARDS

Consideration must  be  given to requirements  governing the degree  of  sludge sta-
bilization,  the  loading  rates, the  frequency and depth of cover,  monitoring and
reporting.  The  design should  conform to  all building  codes and  should  include
adequate  buffer  zones  to  protect  public  roads,  private  structures  and  surface
waters.

Obtaining  permits  for construction  and  operation  of sludge  landfills can  be  a
long and costly  process. The following is  a partial list of the permits which may
be required:

     •   NPDES permit-if landfill  is in  wetlands
     •   Army Corps  of Engineers  permit-for  construction  of  levee, dike  or con-
         tainment structure to be  placed in the  water in a wetlands area
     •   Office  of  Endangered  Species permit-if landfill  is  located  in critical
         habitual of an endangered species
     •   Solid Waste Management permit
     •   Special Use permit
     •   Sedimentation Control permit
     •   NPDES permit-if landfill  is in  wetlands
     •   Army Corps  of Engineers  permit-for  construction  of  levee, dike  or con-
         tainment structure to be  placed in the  water in a wetlands area
     •   Office  of  Endangered  Species permit-if landfill  is  located  in critical
         habitual of an endangered species
     •   Solid Waste Management permit
     •   Special Use permit
     •   Sedimentation Control permit
     •   Highway Department permit
     •   Construction  permit
     •   Building permit


D.3.  SITE  CHARACTERISTICS

The definition  of  site characteristics  is essential  to the  design of  the  land-
fill. These  should be  clearly  described  and analyzed to  insure the suitability of
the site and the method of  landfilling.


D.3.a  Site  Plan

The site plan should contain the  following information as  a minimum:

     •   Boundaries of fill area  and buffer zones

     •   Topographic features  and  slopes of fill area and  buffer zones

     •   Location of surface water,  roads,  and utilities

     •   Existing and  proposed structures  and access roads


                                       132

-------
     •    Existing   vegetation  to   remain   and  to  be   removed;   areas  to   be
          re-vegetated.


D.3.b.  Soils

The  soil  characteristics  at the  landfill  site  should be  thoroughly catalogued
and mapped. The  information  of  most  importance to the design and operation of the
landfill  includes  depth,  texture,  structure,  bulk  density,   porosity,  permea-
bility, moisture,  stability, and ease  of  excavation. The pH  and  cation capacity
have a  direct  bearing on  heavy metal transport  through  the soil;  these  must  be
considered to insure  protection of surface  and groundwater supplies.


D.3.C.  Geohydrology

The  groundwater aquifers  underlying  the  landfill  site   need  to  be  delineated.
The depth of  the aquifer  under varying conditions  should be  determined  at  sev-
eral locations.  Other characteristics  such  as the direction  and rate of flow, the
hydraulic  gradient,   the  quality,  and  present and  planned  uses  should  also   be
established. The location  of the  primary recharge zones is critical in protecting
quality.

The geologic formations  underlying the  landfill are important in establishing the
design  parameters.  The  type  of bedrock;   its  depth,   fractures,  and  surface
outcroppings; and any faults are  critical  design  features.


D.3.d.  Climate

The climate influences many  factors  in the  design of landfills.   It plays a part
in the  rate  of   organic  decomposition,   the  composition  and  quantity  of  leachate
and  runoff and  the  day-to-day  fill  operations.  Information  such as  seasonal
temperature, precipitation,  evapotranspiration, number of  freezing days,  and wind
direction and speed can  be obtained  from a  local  weather  station.


D.3.e.  Land Use

The present and  proposed use of  the landfill  site  and adjacent  properties  will
have a decisive  influence  on the mitigating measures  taken  to  reduce  any adverse
impacts of the project.  If the  site  is  already dedicated  to  refuse or sludge dis-
posal it  is unlikely  that  expanding it  will  result in adverse  impacts.  However,
if it is  located in or near  a populated  area,  extensive measures may be needed  to
justify the proposed  use and maintain  the value of  adjacent  properties.


D.4.   LANDFILL TYPE

There are three  basic types  of  landfill for sludge. These are  sludge  only trench
fill, sludge only-area fill  and co-disposal  with  refuse.  The conditions for which
each are best suited  are given  in Table  11.

                                        133

-------
     Method
                                       TABLE  11.   SLUDGE AND SITE CONDITIONS (34)
Sludge solids
   content
     Sludge
characteristics
Hydrogeology
        Ground slope
Narrow trench
   15-28%
Unstabilized or
  stabilized
Deep groundwater
  and bedrock
             <20%
Wide trench
Area fill mound
Area fill layer
Diked containment
Sludge/refuse mixture
Sludge/soil mixture
    >20%
    >20%
    >20%
    >20%
Unstabilized or
  stabilized

Stabilized
Unstabilized or
  stabilized

Stabilized
                  Unstabilized or
                    stabilized
Stabilized
Deep groundwater
  and bedrock

Shallow groundwater
  or bedrock
Shallow groundwater
  or bedrock

Shallow groundwater
  or bedrock
Deep or shallow
  groundwater or
  bedrock

Deep or shallow
  groundwater or
  bedrock
Suitable for steep terrain as
  long as level area is pre-
  pared for mounding

Suitable for medium slopes but
  level ground preferred

Suitable for steep terrain as
  long as a level area is
  prepared inside dikes

             <30%

-------
D.5.  LANDFILL DESIGN

Typical design criteria for the three  methods  of landfill  disposal  are given in
Table 12.
D.6.  FACILITIES

Various  ancillary  facilities  will  be  needed  at  the  landfill  site.  These  are
described in the  following  sections.  It  should be noted that all of these may not
be needed at every  site.


D.6.a.  Leachate  Controls

Leachate  from  the  landfill must  be contained  and  disposed  of  if  it  poses  a
threat  to public  health or represents  a  potential source  of water pollution.
Numerous  methods  are  available   for  controlling  leachate  including  drainage,
natural  attenuation,  soil  or  membrane  liners,  or  collection  and  treatment.  The
method chosen and  the design features are  specific  for  each project.


D.6.b.  Gas Control

Gas  produced  by  the decomposition  of  organic  matter  can  present  a  potential
danger,  particularly  if the landfill  is located near  a populated  area.  Methane
gas, in particular, is  highly  explosive  if  confined in  an enclosed area.

Some  method  for  venting the  gases  produced  at the landfill  must  be  provided.
The  two  types  widely   accepted  are  the  permeable and   impermeable.  Permeable
methods usually consist of  a gravel  filled trench  around  the  fill area  to inter-
cept migrating gas  and  vent it to the atmosphere.  Impermeable  methods consist of
placing a barrier of low  permeability  material, such  as  compacted  clay, around
the fill  area  to  minimize lateral movement  of gas. In general, methane recovery
is not economically cost-effective at sludge  only or small co-disposal sites.

Additional information  dealing with  the  design  of  gas  controls  is  presented in
reference 34.
D.6.C.  Roads

Access  and  on-site roads  are  necessary  at  the landfill  site.  Access  roads  and
permanent on-site  roads should  be  paved; temporary  roads may be  constructed of
well  compacted  natural soil.  For loaded  vehicles uphill  grades  should  be  less
than 7 percent and downhill  grades  less  than 10 percent.  Radii should be suitable
for the trucks which are to  use  the  roads.
                                        135

-------
                                                 TABLE  12.   LANDFILL DESIGN CRITERIA  (34)
to

Method
Sludge
solids
content. Trench Bulking Bulking Cover Thickness, ft
percent width, ft required agent Bulking ratio1 Interim Final
Sludge only-trench fill
Narrow trench



Wide trench

Sludge only-area
Area fill mound


Area fill layer


Diked containment


Co-cisr,osal with
Sludge/refuse
mixture
Sludge/soil
mixture

?
15-20 2—3 No ' 	 	 	 2—3 ft
TA "} Q ^ 1 A M/-I ___ — — 1 — A f t-
20-2o J-1U NO 	 • 	 J 4 it

2 c
-28 10 No3 	 4-5 ft

fill
-20 	 Yes3 Soil 0.5-1 soil 3 ft 3-5 ft
1 sludge

-15 	 Yes3 Soil 0.25-1 soil: 0.5-1 ft 2-4 ft
sludge

20-28 	 No2,'' Soil 0.25-0.5 soil: 3-4 ft
^28 	 No3," Soil 1 sludge

refuse
>3 	 Yes3 Refuse 4-7 tons refuse: 0.5-1 ft 2 ft
1 wet ton sludge
-20 	 Yes Soil 1 soil: 1 sludge 0.5-1 ft 2 ft


Kludge application
Imported soil rate, cu yd/ac
required (in actual fill areas) Equipment

No 1,200-5,600 Backhoe with loo
excavator, trcnc
machine

No 3 , 200—14 , 500 Track loader ,
dragline, scrape
track dozer

Yes 3,000-14,000 Track loader,
backhoo wich
loader, track dc
Yes 2,000-9,000 Track dozer.
grader, track
loader
Yes 4,800-15,000 Dragline,
track dozer.
scraper

No 500-4,200 Dragline,
track loader
No 1,600 Tractor with
disc, grader,
track loader
       Volume  basis unless otherwise noted
     2 Land-based equipment
     3 Sludge-based equipment
     "* But sometimes used
1 ft  = 0.305 m
1 yd  = 0.765 mJ
1 aero = 0.405 ha

-------
D.6.d.  Soil Stockpiles

If  insufficient  or inappropriate  soil  at the landfill  site warrants importation
of  soil, a storage  place  should  be located on-site. The quantity and type of soil
to  be  stockpiled  will depend on the  individual  demands of  the  landfill.   Stock-
piles  may also  be desirable for winter  operations in cold  climates where frozen
ground may limit  excavation  of cover  or  bulking  materials.


D.6.e.  Inclement Weather Areas

Special work areas  should be provided so  that landfilling operations may be con-
tinued even during  inclement weather. It  is most  convenient to  locate these near
the entrance to the site  and to  provide  paved  or all-weather roads around them.


D.6.f.  Minor Facilities

An  office and other employee facilities should  be  provided  at  the landfill site.
For larger operations a  permanent  structure should be  provided,  while at smaller
sites  a  trailer might suffice.  An equipment  barn and  shop may  be  desirable  in
areas where weather is inclement.

Larger landfills  should  have electrical,  water, communication and  sanitary ser-
vices; for remote  facilities,  this may mean extending  existing  utilities.  Chem-
ical toilets, bottled water  and  on-site  electrical generation may reduce the cost
of  obtaining services from the utility  companies.

To  protect the  landfill  site and  the general  public,  the site  should  be fenced.
Access should be  limited  to one  or two  entrances  secured with  gates.  The height
and  type  of  fence  provided should  be  chosen  to  suit  local conditions.  A 6-ft
chain  link fence  topped with barbed wire  will restrict  trespassers; a wood fence
or  hedge  is  effective in screening  the  operation from  view;  and  a  4-ft barbed
wire fence will  keep  livestock from  the  site.  Portable lighting  is effective  if
landfill operations are carried  out at  night.  Permanent lights  should be provided
for  all  structures and  heavily used access  roads.  A  cleaning  program  will  be
necessary for  equipment  in  frequent  contact with sludge.  A curbed  wash  pad and
collection basin  should   be  provided  to  contain the  contaminated wash  water  so
that it can be treated. Groundwater monitoring is  crucial and should not be over-
looked. The number,  type  and location of  monitoring  wells  must be  suited to the
specific conditions associated with the  landfill.  Depending on  the size and loca-
tion of  the  landfill, landscaping may be an  important  design  factor.  The  aes-
thetic acceptability  of the  landfill  is  critical if it is in or near an urban  or
densely populated  area.  In general,  plants should be  low  maintenance types which
will quickly become an effective visual  barrier.

Depending on the  size and location of the landfill,  on-site equipment  facilities
may be warranted.
                                        137

-------
D.7.  LANDFILL EQUIPMENT

A wide variety of equipment  is  required  for  a sludge landfill.  The type of equip-
ment depends on the landfill  method  employed and on the quantity  of  sludge to be
disposed  of.  Equipment  will be  needed  for sludge  handling,  excavation,  back-
filling,  grading  and  road  construction.  Table  13 presents  typical  equipment
performance characteristics  for various  methods  of  sludge  landfilling.


D.8.  MANPOWER REQUIREMENTS

For  effective  operation,  landfill  operations must be  staffed by  well-trained,
qualified  personnel.  Typical positions  include  equipment  operators,  a  superin-
tendent/foreman/supervisor,  mechanics and laborers.  The size  of  the  staff  will
depend on the type of landfill  and the operating schedule.


D.9.  FLEXIBILITY AND RELIABILITY

Due  to  the possibility  of  changes  in  sludge characteristics  and quantities,  a
landfill site should be  designed  with a maximum  degree  of  flexibility.  Since the
life of  a landfill is  difficult  to  predict accurately expansion may be  needed
sooner than originally  planned  or it be  delayed for various reasons.  Any change
in wastewater treatment  or  sludge  handling may affect the  nature  and quantity of
sludge  produced.  If this  is drastic,  operational  modifications  may  be  needed.
The  landfill  should  be  designed so  that such changes can  be made without  major
disruption to operations.

Reliability is also an  important  factor in  designing a  landfill  operation.   Con-
tinunity of operation should not  be  stopped because of inclement  weather unless
absolutely necessary.  In such  cases, special work areas  and  storage  facilities
should  be  available.  Adequate  back-up  equipment should be available  on-site or
nearby for emergency operations or unexpected equipment  failures.


D.10.  ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACTS

The  specific  areas  of  environmental impact  will vary  among landfill  locations.
However, crucial  impact  areas normally  include  land use;  air, surface water and
groundwater quality; social,  health  and economics; historical  and archaeological
sites and habitats of endangered  species. Adverse  impacts  should  be  mitigated by
the  measures  suggested  in the  facilities  plan.   These mitigating  measures should
be definitive and included as features  of  the design.


Section E - COMBUSTION

Combustion systems  are  usually designed with the  close cooperation and  assist-
ance of  one  or more manufacturer  of combustion  equipment. Most  design  criteria
and  procedures available  relate specifically  to  one manufacturer of the  type of
equipment  in  question.  The  similarities  between  manufacturers  are  such  that


                                        138

-------
                        TABLE 13.  LANDFILL EQUIPMENT PERFORMANCE CHARACTERISTICS  (34)
vO

Trench





















Equipment name
Trenching machine

Narrow
trench
c
0
•rH
U
O
3
(-1
4-1
w
c
o
O 00
c
4= -H
O r-l
C 01

M O
H CJ
G G

Wide
trench
c
0
•rH
U
o
3
M
4-)
CO
ti
0
O OO

U2 -H
O r-l
c a)
ai >
r-l O
H U
_ —
Backhoe with loader G G - -
Excavator
Track loader
Wheel loader
a
Track dozer
Scraper
Dragline
Grader
Tractor with disc
G F
- G
- G
- G
- -
G G
- -
— —
-
G F
F -
G G
G -
G G
- -
— —










w
c
•H
iH
3
CO
f.

rH
•H
o
CO
	
F
-
F
G
-
G
-
-
—


Mound





00
C
) -H
rH
3
CO














J= 00 00
C
00 (U -H
C 00 T)

X 3 3
•H rH O
2 co 2
— — —
F F G
_ _ _
G F G
F G F
G - F
- F -
- - -
_ _ _
_ — — .
C
•H
V-(
0)

o
u
	
F
-
G
F
G
-
G
-
— .
Area fill










00
c
•H
rH
3
CO
«

iH
•H
O

	
F
-
F
G
-
G
-
-
—


Layer





00
C
•tH
rH
3
CO
x: oo
£
OO CU -H
C 00 r-l
•H "O 0)
X 3 >>
•H tH CO

_ 	 _
F F -
_ _ _
G F F
G G -
G - G
- F G
- - -
- - G
— — —














00
C
•H
)-l
cu
^
o
u
__
-
-
F
_
G
G
-
G
—
Diked
contain-
ment


c
o
•H
U
U
00 3
C ^
•H -U
rH U)
3 C 00
CO 0 C
,C CJ -H
r-l
rH CU 
0 -H 0
CO Q 0
	
F - -
_ _ _
F F -
G F -
- G G
G G -
- - G
_ _ _
— — —
Codisposal

Sludge/
refuse










00
C 00
•H C
•O -rH
CO >•<
Q) 0)
r-< ^
cx o
CO O
_ _
-
- -
F F
— —
G G
- F
- -
- -
_ —

Sludge/
soil



00
c
•H
•o
CO
CU
)-i
a
0) 00
00 C

rH -H CO O
CO S ffi U
— — . — —
_
_ _ _ _
F - G F
- - F F
G F - G
- - F F
- - - -
F - - -
- G - -

LEGEND
G - Good. Fully

capable of


performing

function

listed





Equipment could be selected solely

on basis of
                function listed.
     F = Fair.  Marginally capable of performing function listed.  Equipment should be selected on basis of
                full capabilities in other function.
     - = Not applicable.  Cannot be used for function listed.
     a   Caterpillar D-6 generally is the largest track dozer appropriate for a sludge landfill.

-------
generalities  can  be  drawn  which will aid the evaluator in determining the reason-
ableness of a particular design.


E.I.  SLUDGE  CHARACTERISTICS

The  characteristics  of the sludge  which have the  greatest  impact  on  the design
of combustion systems  are  the  quantity,  moisture content, and  heat value.  Other
characteristics which  will have an effect on the potential  for  air pollution are
the nitrogen, sulfur,  heavy metals  (lead and mercury) and toxic  organic
compounds.


E.I.a.  Type of Processing at  Treatment  Plant

The  type  of  prior processing  at  the plant  will  determine the  sludge  character-
istics  to  the   combustion  process.  The stabilization   process,   if  any,  will
influence the volatile solids/heat  content.  The  dewatering process will determine
the solids content of  the  sludge.  If pressure filters  or  vacuum filters  are used
for dewatering large quantities of  non-volatile  inorganic chemicals may be added.
The design of the piror processing  deserves as  much consideration  as  the design
of  the  combustion process.  Any failure  of  the  prior  processing  to provide  the
design sludge characteristics  will  also  cause failure of  the  combustion process.


E.l.b.  Quantity; Maximum, Average,  Minimum

The  quantity  of  sludge produced will determine  size  of  the combustion  process
equipment. Typically,  the  combustion process will not be  designed for peak sludge
production,  but  for   some  quantity  between peak  and average   production,  with
storage provided  to  make  up the difference.  A portion  of this  storage may  be  in
the sludge process unit processes.  Care  must be  taken  that  any  septic  conditions
which  may  occur  in  sludge  storage  are adequately  considered.  Sludge  quantity
estimates must take  into account  the mass of chemicals added  in the conditioning
and dewatering processes.


E.l.c.  Analysis

The sludge solids and  heat content will, together with sludge quantities, deter-
mine the size and fuel and air  requirements  of  the  combustion  process.  The solids
and  heat  contents should  be  experimentally determined,  whenever  possible,  but
where  necessary  there have   been   several   formulae,  with  varying  accuracies,
developed for heat content estimates (10, 12,  13).  In making heat  content  esti-
mates, the masses and  heats  of the  reactions of  the conditioning  chemicals  must
be considered.

Although nitrogen and  sulfur  affect  the heat content  of the  sludge,  they  are
also important  in determining  the  sludge's   potential  for air  pollution.   Addi-
tional possible  air pollutants are  heavy  metals,   especially  mercury and  lead,
                                        140

-------
and  persistent  toxic  organic  compounds  such  as  pesticides and  polychlorinated
biphenyls.


E.2.  REGULATIONS AND  STANDARDS

Federal,  state and  local  air quality requirements  must  be met  by  the  combustion
process design. Permits and  standards relating to ash disposal  will  be discussed
under the sections for the respective disposal methods.


E.2.a.  Air Quality Requirements

The  federal  "New Source  Performance Standards  for  Sewage Sludge  Incinerators"
(64) establishes the following limitations  for particulate emissions:

     1.  No more than  0.65 g/kg dry  sludge  input  1.30 Ib/ton dry sludge input
     2.  Less than  20  percent  opacity,  except where  opacity  is  due  to  uncombined
         water

The EPA  has  also established a limitation  of 3,200  g/day for  mercury emissions
in the Amendments to the National Emission  Standards  (47).

If PCB's  exceed  25  ing/kg dry  sludge,  95 percent  destruction  must  be  assured  by
the design of  the incinerators. Additional regulations are  being developed under
the Toxic Substances Control Act  (63) and the Resource Conservation  and Recovery
Act (2) which should be consulted in  designing the sludge incineration  system.

Many states,  regional  authorities,  and  local  governments have  established emis-
sion limitations more  stringent than  the  federal  regulations.  In addition to more
restrictive  particulate,  opacity,  mercury,  and   PCB  requirements,  other  limita-
tions may be imposed on emissions, such  as:

         Oxides of nitrogen
         Sulfur dioxide
         Carbon monoxide
         Heavy metals,  especially lead
         Persistent organic  compounds,  such as pesticides
         Hydrocarbons  and carbonyls

In general, a properly designed and  operated sludge  combustion  process will have
little difficulty in meeting emission standards.


E.2.b.  Permits

All appropriate  federal,  state, regional and local permits,  licenses and approv-
als  should  have  been  identified  and  obtained  or applied for  by  the  time  of
design review.
                                        141

-------
E.3.  MULTIPLE HEARTH INCINERATION  OR  PYROLYSIS

A description of these processes  is  given  in Part I,  Section H.I.


E.3.a.  Operating Schedule

The operating schedule will  affect   the  sizing of all components  after  the final
sludge  storage  tank. Eight-hour-a-day,  five-day-a-week  operations are  possible
but not practical because they  require three to   four times  the  equipment  of con-
tinuous operations and are also costly to maintain at  operating temperature with
no sludge feed (67).


E.3.b.  Reactor Design

In designing the reactor,  the key parameter  is  hearth  loading  rate.  Values of 6
to 12 Ibs/sq ft/hr on a total wet sludge basis (68) and  1.47  to 3.32  Ib/sq ft/hr
on dry solids basis  (67). Table  14  illustrates several  typical wet sludge loading
rates and Figure 12  is a plot of  hearth  area vs. design  capacity  on a dry  solids
basis for several actual installations.

The number  of hearths,  reactor  dimensions,  and  rabble  speed  will  be  established
from  the  incinerator manufacturer's data.  Table  15  is  a summary  of the  standard
furnace dimensions  available from one of  the major manufacturers.  Current prac-
tice  favors 5 to 12  hearths  for  sewage sludge incineration  (67). In addition, the
heaviest wall thickness available is generally recommended  (69).

Typical center shaft and  rabble arm cooling  air  flows  as function  of wet  sludge
flow  for several operating incinerators  are  shown in  Figure 13.

The sludge  feed  system should  be designed  for  the  maximum  anticipated  charging
rate  and should include a  sludge weighing or metering  device.  Where pyrolysis is
to be practiced, the  sludge  feed  system  should be designed  to minimize  the entry
of air through the charging  port.


E.3.c.  Auxiliary Fuel System

The auxiliary fuel  requirements fall  into  three categories:   start-up,  continu-
ous operation and  standby.  The fuel supply  system must  have  sufficient  capacity
at  the  greatest  of  those  three rates.  Substantial  quantities  of  auxiliary fuel
are always  required  to bring  a  multiple  hearth furnace  up to the required temper-
atures for  sludge  ignition.  In  addition, these heat-ups, and  cool-downs,  must be
at  very  slow  rates,  typically  20 to 25  F°/hr for  large incinerators,  150 F°/hr
for very  small incinerators,  for temperature changes from  70°F  to 1500°F.  Figure
14 illustrates typical  heat-up  and  standby  fuel  consumption  rates  as a  function
of hearth area.  The  fuel consumption rate  for continuous operation will be  estab-
lished  by  the  mass  and energy  balance calculations.   Standby fuel is  that fuel
required  to maintain  the  furnace  at  a constant,  slightly  reduced,  temperature
during periods in which no sludge is fed.


                                        142

-------
            TABLE 14.  MULTIPLE HEARTH FURNACE LOADING RATES
                                                                Typical
                                  Volatile     Chemical        wet sludge
                          Solids   solids,  concentration,*  loading rate,**
                            %	%	mg/1	lb/hr/sq ft
Type of sludge
 1.  Primary               30
 2.  Primary + FeCl        16
 3.  Primary + low lime    35
 4.  Primary + WAS         16
 5.  Primary + (WAS +
       FeCl3)              20
 6.  (Primary + FeCl )
       + WAS               16
 7.  WAS                   16
 8.  WAS + FeCl            16
 9.  Digested primary      30
                                    60
                                    47
                                    45
                                    69

                                    54

                                    53
                                    80
                                    50
                                    43
 N/A
 20
298
 N/A

 20

 20
 N/A
 20
 N/A
7.0-12.0
6.0-10.0
8.0-12.0
6.0-10.0

6.5-11.0

6.0-10.0
6.0-10.0
6.0-10.0
7.0-12.0
 * Assumes no dewatering chemicals.
** Low number is applicable to small plants, high number is applicable to
   large plants.
   The data in this table developed from manufacturers'  information.
                                    143

-------
er
M

UJ*
U
<


tr
u.
cc

UJ
x
Ul
cc
UJ
a

UJ
cc
<
z

cc

UJ
X
Ul
o
UJ
u.
U.
Ul
10,000
     9
     8
     7
     6

     5

     4


     3



     2
 1,000


     7
     6

     5

     4
      100
          100
                           3   456789
                                         1,000
3   4   56789
               10,000
                DESIGN (AVERAGE) DRY SOLIDS FLOW PER MULTIPLE HEARTH FURNACE, Ib/hr
     Figure  12.   Multiple  hearth furnace hearth  area vs. design capacity.
                  (from data in Reference 67)
                                      144

-------
TABLE 15.  STANDARD SIZES OF MULTIPLE HEARTH FURNACE UNITS (67)

Effective
hearth
area,
sq ft
85
98
112
125
126
140
145
166
187
193
208
225
256
276
288
319
323
351
364
383
411
452
510
560
575
672
760
845
857
944
Outer
diameter,
ft
6.75
6.75
6.75
7.75
6.75
6.75
7.75
7.75
7.75
9.25
7.75
9.25
9.25
10.75
9.25
9.25
10.75
9.25
10.75
9.25
10.75
10.75
10.75
10.75
14.25
14.25
14.25
16.75
14.25
14.25
Number
hearths
6
7
8
6
9
10
7
8
9
6
10
7
8
6
9
10
7
11
8
12
9
10
11
12
6
7
8
6
9
10
Effective
hearth
area,
sq ft
988
1041
1068
1117
1128
1249
1260
1268
1400
1410
1483
1540
1580
1591
1660
1675
1752
1849
1875
1933
2060
2084
2090
2275
2350
2464
2600
2860
3120

Outer
diameter,
ft
16.75
14.25
18.75
16.75
14.25
18.75
16.75
20.25
16.75
18.75
20.25
16.75
22.25
18.75
20.25
16.75
18.75
22.25
20.25
18.75
20.25
22.25
18.75
20.25
22.25
20.25
22.25
22.25
22.25

Number
hearths
7
11
6
8
12
7
9
6
10
8
7
11
6
9
8
12
10
7
9
11
10
8
12
11
9
12
10
11
12

                               145

-------
   3000
   6000
I
LL
CC
00
O
o
EC
O
o
o
o
o
   4000
2000
                                              COOLING AIR
                                                       COMBUSTION AIR
                                                       (INCLUDING
                                                       EXCESS)
                       50
                                      100
                                                       150
                                                                    200
        DESIGN (AVERAGE) WET SLUDGE FLOW PER MULTIPLE HEARTH FURNACE, Ib/hr
     Figure 13.  Multiple hearth  air supply vs. design  capacity.
                   (From data in  reference 67)
                                 146

-------
O
E


LU
o

t-
Q.
O  •)
O  ^


LU


LL

Q_
LL)

X
                                                                                                            1.0
                                                                                                              HI

                                                                                                              c
                                                                                                              O
                                                                                                           0.62


                                                                                                              c
                                                                                                              I-
                                                                                                              a
                                                                                                              c
                                                                                                              c

                                                                                                           0.4-
                                                                                                             w
                                                                                                             o
                                                                                                           0.2
                                     1000                              2000



                                            EFFECTIVE HEARTH AREA, sq ft



           Figure  14.   Multiple hoarth  furnace heatup and  standby  fuel  consumption rate.  (57)
                                                                                                         3000

-------
E.3.d.  Combustion and Excess Air  Requirements


E.3.d.(l)   Incineration  - The  exact  combustion air  requirement  is  determined
from  the  theoretical  oxygen demand (THOD)  of  the sludge and  auxiliary fuel.  Air
is approximately 21 percent  oxygen,  so the actual air  requirement would be (100/
21)  (THOD).  Operating  experience  has  shown  that  excess  air  is  required  for
complete  combustion,  usually on  the order  of  50  to 100  percent of the theoretical
requirement. Assuming 50  percent  excess  air, then, the  actual  air  requirement
would be  (150/21)(THOD).  Figure  13 illustrates typical  combustion air supplies as
a function of dry solids  feed.

E.3.d.(2)  Pyrolysis  -  True pyrolysis  is  fractional distillation  where all heat
is applied externally to  the reactor and  no  oxygen is  introduced.  Pyrolysis, as
proposed  for  multiple hearth  reactors, is starved  oxygen  combustion,  wherein a
portion  of  the  pyrolysis  products  are burned  within  the reactor  as  the  heat
source for the reaction.
E.3.e.  Incineration Ash Systems

The design of incinerators must  include  adequate facilities for handling and dis-
posing of incinerator  ash. Ash handling and disposal  systems  should  be sized for
the maximum anticipated ash  flow,  or  sufficient  storage provided to permit lesser
capacities. The design of  the  ash handling and  disposal  systems should take into
account the potential  for dust problems  which  ash disposal presents.

E.3.e.(l)  Handling  -  Ash  is usually transported by truck or  by  slurry pipeline
to  the  disposal site. The  slurry operation  is   often  combined with  a quenching
operation  to  cool ash discharged from  the  incinerator.  Dewatering  requirements
should be considered for any ash  transported  in  a slurry form, either by truck or
pipeline.

E.3.e.(2)  Disposal  -  Ash  is usually disposed  of by landfilling  or  lagooning of
a slurry. Land application is  technically feasible  but  is  not  being  practiced as
it  is not  generally  considered to offer any advantages.  Ash  has  been  used  as an
amendment  for  road  subgrades  to  improve  freeze-thaw  characteristics,  as  a
building material additive, and as a  quasi-fertilizer for its  phosphate content.


E.3.f.  Pyrolysis Residue Systems

Where pyrolysis is  practiced,  the design  of  the combustion process  must  include
systems for handling and utilizing or disposing  of  residues.  All  of  the residues
may have value  as  fuels,  and if their use  or  sale  is  contemplated,  the handling
system should maximize their recovery.  Pyrolysis char  is  of  dubious  value  as  a
fuel, and  may  lend  itself best  to  disposal  by landfill. Handling   systems  and
utilization should take into account  the corrosive  natures of  the  gases and tars,
as well as their relatively low  rank  as  fuels.
                                        148

-------
E.3.g.  Air Quality Control

After-burners  are  used for  odor control,  hydrocarbon and  carbonyl destruction,
and  for persistent  toxic organic  compound  destruction.   Scrubbers  of  various
types and electrostatic precipitators  are used for particulate removal. The elec-
trostatic precipitator is  more  efficient, but more costly to operate.  The design
of air  quality control equipment should  be based on  the actual volume  of  gases
expected  to  pass  through the  stack  at   the  actual  stack exhaust  temperature.
Equipment design should consider the corrosive nature  of stack gases.

Wet  Venturi  scrubbers  are  the most  common  type.  The  stack  gases  are  passed
through a reduced  cross sectional area throat where  the gas velocity is raised to
200 to 600 feet per second.  Water spray is introduced  into the throat  from above.
The water droplets contact and  adhere  to  particulates  increasing their mass. This
caused  the particles  to  move downward  for collection  in a  gas  liquid separator.
Typical pressure  drops across  a Venturi  scrubber range  from  20 to  30 inches  of
water column and  typical  water consumption rates  range from 5  to  10 gallons per
1000 cubic feet of stack gas.


E.4.   FLUIDIZED BED

A typical fluidized bed  incinerator is shown  in  Figure 5, and  desribed  in  para-
graph H. 1. of  the  facility planning section.


E.A.a.  Operating  Schedule

Because of  the heat  reservoir  afforded  by the  sandbed, fluidized  bed incinera-
tors  are  well  suited  to  intermittent  or batch  operations.  While  the equipment
required for 8-hour, 5-day operations  is   three to four  times  that  for continuous
operation, the fuel required to maintain  the  incinerator near operating tempera-
tures overnight is minimal.


E.4.b.  Reactor Design

Fluidized bed  reactor  loading  rates  for  sewage sludge  are  typically in the  range
of 10 to 20 Ibs/hr/ft2 on  a  dry solids basis  with 12.7  Ibs/hr/sf  being the  aver-
age for eleven installations by one manufacturer  (68).  The  bed  area and diameter
are determined from the sludge  flow and the loading rate.  Figure  15 is a plot  of
sludge  loading rates  vs.  bed  area  for the installations of one  manufacturer  of
fluidized bed  furnaces.  Table  16 is  a tabulation of  typical  loading  rates  on  a
wet sludge basis.
                                        149

-------
   200
   100


    90



-   80
er
(A
LU
cr
<

i
t-
oc
<
til
    70
60
    50
    40
    30
     20

                                              10      12
                                                          14      16
                            CAPACITY, Ib/day dry solids
    Figure 15.  Fluidized bed  furnace  hearth area  vs.  capacity.

                       (From data in reference 68)
                                 150

-------
                 TABLE  16.   FLUIDIZED  BED FURNACE LOADING RATES
Type of sludge
Primary
Primary + FeCl3
Primary + low lime
Primary + WAS
Primary + WAS + FeCl3
Primary + FeCl3 + WAS
WAS
WAS + FeCl3
Digested primary
Solids,
%
30
16
35
16
20
16
16
16
30
Vol.
solids,
%
60
47
45
69
54
53
80
50
43
Chemical
concentration,*
mg/1
N/A
20
298
N/A
20
20
N/A
20
N/A
Wet sludge
loading
rate,
Ib/sq ft/hr
14
6.8
18
6.8
8.4
6.8
6.8
6.8
14
*Assumes no dewatering chemicals.
The required  reactor  volume,  and thus  its  height,  are determined  by the burning
rate and  detention time needed  for satisfactory  combustion of gases.  The  exact
reactor dimensions  would  then be determined by  consulting  a manufacturer's table
of standard dimensions.

The sandbed acts as the heat  transfer  medium and also serves to hold organic par-
ticles until  combustion is complete  and to  grind  ash particles,  preventing the
formation  of  clinkers.  Fluidizing  air  is  the air  flow required to  maintain the
sand in  a fluid  state  without  excess  carry-over of  sand  in  the  exhaust  gases.
Fluidizing air also supplies  the majority of the combustion air.  Air supplied to
the reactor  increases heat  losses. Preheating  of  fluidizing  and  combustion air
can, however, minimize those  losses.


The sludge feed  system should  be  designed  for uniform  distribution  of  sludge
over the  top  of the bed. Where  the  supply of air to  the  process  must be limited,
as for pyrolysis,  the sludge  feed system should  be  designed to minimize the entry
of air.
E.4.c.  Auxiliary Fuel System

The  design  of the  auxiliary fuel  system should  take into  account  the  rate  of
fuel  consumption  for start-up  (and  shut-down),  continuous operation  and standby
operation. The capacity of  the  fuel  system should  be not  less than the greater of
these three rates.
                                        151

-------
E.4.d.  Combustion and Excess  Air  Components


E.4.d.(l)   Incineration  -  The  exact  combustion air  requirement  is  determined
from the theoretical oxygen  demand (THOD) of the sludge and  auxiliary fuel.   Air
is approximately 21 percent  oxygen,  so the actual air  requirement  would be (100/
21)(THOD).  Operating  experience has  shown that  excess  air is required  for  com-
plete  combustion,  usually on  the  order  of  20 to 40  percent of  the  theoretical
requirement.  Assuming 30  percent  excess  air,  then,  the  actual  air  requirement
would be (130/21)(THOD).

E.4.d.(2)   Pyrolysis -  Pyrolysis,  as  proposed  for sewage  sludge reactors,  is
starved air  combustion,  wherein a portion of  the  pyrolysis  products  are  burned
within the  reactor  as  the heat source  for the reaction. Air  supply requirements
will be less  than the theoretical  oxygen  demand.  The exact  air supply requirement
would  be  determined  empirically  for optimum  performance.  One  possible  design
approach would be  to  size  the  air  supply  system  for  incineration  and  provide
controls to permit cutting back the  supply to the level required for pyrolysis.


E.4.e.  Incineration Ash  Systems

Ash handling  and disposal systems should  be sized  for  the  maximum  anticipated
ash flow, or  sufficient  storage provided  to permit  lesser capacities.  All flui-
dized bed  incinerator  ash is  carried from the reactor  in  the exhaust  gases  and
collected by  the air  pollution control  equipment.   Ash will  generally be  dis-
charged from  the scrubbers as  a thin  slurry.

The details  of ash handling  systems  for  fluidized  bed incineration  are  similar
to  those  for multiple  hearth incineration which  are discussed   in  paragraphs
E.3.e, E.3.e.(l) and E.3.e.(2).


E.4.f.  Air Quality Control

After-burners  are not generally required  for fluidized  bed  reactors. Scrubbers of
various types and  electrostatic precipitators  are  used for  particulate  removal,
with  the  electrostatic precipitator  being more  efficacious,  but more  costly to
operate. The   design  of   air  quality  control equipment  should  be  based  on  the
actual volume of gases  expected   to  pass  through the  stack  at  the actual stack
exhaust  temperature.  Equipment design should  consider the  corrosive nature  of
stack gases.

The design of  the air  pollution control system should  take into  account  the  fact
that all the  ash from the process  will  be  carried from  the  reactor in the exhaust
gases together with a quantity of  fine  sand  particles  from  the  incinerator  bed.


E.5.  WET AIR OXIDATION

The wet air oxidation process  is described in Part 1,  paragraph H.I.e.


                                        152

-------
Wet air oxidation is  a  proprietary process and should  be  designed with the close
cooperation  of  the manufacturer.  While no  specific  parameters are  listed here,
the following components  of  the  system  must  be considered in the design.

         Sludge grinder
         Sludge storage
         Sludge pumping
         Air compressor
         Heat exchanger
         Steam generator
         Gas/liquid separator
         Auxiliary fuel system
         Air quality  control
         Residue treatment
              Dewatering
              Handling
              Disposal
              Liquor  treatment


E.6.  OTHER PROCESSES

There  are  several other  processes, most  of  them proprietary,  which  have  been
used or  proposed  for  the combustion of  sludge.   While the  discussions  included
herein do  not  cover  the  design  of these processes,  the  basic elements  of their
design are similar to those  for  multiple hearth and fluidized bed  reactors.


E.6.a.   Cyclonic Reactors

Horizontal cyclonic reactors are described  in paragraph H.I.a.(3)  of the facility
planning section.


E.6.b.   Electric Incinerators

Electric  Incinerators  are   described   in  paragraph  H.I.a.(3)  of  the  facility
planning section.


E.6.C.   Proprietary Pyrolysis

Proprietary pyrolysis processes  are  described in  paragraph H.l.b.  of the facility
planning section.


E. 7.  CO-DISPOSAL

The co-combustion of  sludge with solid  waste generally  takes one of two forms:

     •   Incineration  or  pyrolysis  of  sludge with  the solid  waste  stream in  a
         solid waste incinerator

                                        153

-------
     •   Use  of  shredded and classified  solid  waste as an  auxiliary  stream in a
         sludge  incinerator

The  co-disposal  facility design  should  take into account  the  different handling
equipment  required for  solid  waste and  wastewater sludge.   For  refuse derived
fuel  systems  shredding  and  classification  equipment   should  be included  in the
design.  The  use of unclassified solid waste  could  lead to a  slag production as
well as increased  ash  production.


E.8.  AUXILIARY  FUEL SELECTION

The  term auxiliary fuel  means the  source of additional heat  required,  above the
heat content  of  the sludge,  to  bring the  incinerator  to  operating temperature,
to  begin  sludge  burning, to  maintain  sludge burning  for  non-autogenous sludges,
to hold the incinerator  at  or near operating temperature  during standby periods,
and  to control incinerator  cooling rates during shut-down.  The  auxiliary fuels
presently in use are:

         Gases natural gas,  propane, liquified  petroleum gas
         Fuel oils
         Powdered  coal
         Refuse  derived  fuel
         Electricity

Electricity is used as an auxiliary fuel only  in  electric  incinerators, and will
not be discussed further.

The  value  of  powdered coal  and  refuse derived fuel  is  strictly  as a  source  of
additional heat  for  burning  of  non-autogenous  sludges,  and either  a gas or fuel
oil  system must  be provided  for the other auxiliary fuel functions.  The  use  of
coal or  refuse  as  auxiliary  fuel  should  not be overlooked, however, because  of
their potentially  low  cost per Btu  and the  low  potential for air pollution exhib-
ited by refuse.   In addition, refuse and powdered coal may have  value  as  sludge
conditioners, improving  the yield  of dewatering processes.

Gases and  fuel   oils are the most  common auxiliary fuels,  being   usable  for all
the  auxiliary fuel  requirements.   If  natural  gas  is  elected  as  the  auxiliary
fuel source,  it  may be  an interruptible  service,  in  which case  measures  should
be  taken  to  protect the  incinerator  from damage  from  an  uncontrolled  shutdown.
This will most often take the form  of  a  gas, such as  propane,  stored  on the site
in at least  sufficient quantity to control  temperature  changes  during  shut-down.
Additional qualities may be  provided for some  fixed  period of  continuous  opera-
tion.   Backup sources of fuel  may be  advisable  for  other types  of  gas  or oil
supplies, depending on the circumstances.


E.9.  RELIABILITY  AND  FLEXIBILITY

The  combustion process must  be designed  with  reliability,  operating  flexibility
and  future design  flexibility in  mind.  Facilities must be designed in accordance


                                       154

-------
with the  EPA  Technical bulletin Design  Criteria for Mechanical,  Electric,  - and
Fluid System and Component  Reliability (58).


E.9.a.  Expandable Facilities

When future increases  in sludge production  beyond the capacity  of  the equipment
installed  are  anticipated by  the  facility plan,  the  process should  be designed
with expansion  in mind.  Provisions for future expansions  may include  space  allo-
cations  for  future  equipment, blind  flanges  for  future  piping  corrections  and
provisions for  structural extensions.


E.9.b.  Multiple Units

The provision  of  multiple process units  can  enhance a combustion system's  reli-
ability  by making  it  less   vulnerable to  complete shut-down  due  to  mechanical
failure or routine maintenance.


E.9.c.  Alternative  Reduction  and/or Disposal  Methods

It  may  be necessary to  provide an  alternative means  of  disposing of  sludge  in
the event  of a  failure of the  combustion  process.  A common example is  providing a
means of  loading  unincinerated sludge into  trucks for transportation  to  a  land-
fill. The alternative disposal  or combustion method  should not  be   subject  to
common mode failures with the  principal method.


E.9.d.  Storage

Storage  is often  used to provide  both reliability and operating  flexibility  for
the  sludge management  system. Storage  can  permit scheduling  of  operations  as
desired,  can permit  the  system to  be out  of  service for a  predetermined period of
time,  and can increase  the  effective  capacity  of   the  combustion  system  by
smoothing  the  sludge and  solids flow rate  variations.


E.9.e.  Standby Power

Standby power  should be  provided  when  required  to  prevent  damage  to equipment or
to maintain operation. Examples  of the former condition are  multiple  hearth fur-
nace  shaft cooling  air   fans,  which  should  always  be provided  with  a  standby
source of  power.


E.9.f.  Standby Fuel

Standby  fuel  supplies should  be  provided where  required  to prevent  refractory
damage or  to maintain  continuous operation.
                                        155

-------
E.10.  MASS BALANCE

The calculation of the  expected  flow of mass into and  out  of  the combustion pro-
cess will aid in establishing  its  design parameters.  The mass  balance calculation
must be performed  in  conjunction with the energy  balance  discussed  later in this
section. The mass  of  inputs  to the combustion process must equal the mass of out-
puts. See Appendix C  for sample  calculation.

E.10.a.  Inputs

See part H.2.a. in the  facility  planning section.


E.lO.b. Outputs

See part H.2.b. of the  facility  planning section.


E.ll.  ENERGY BALANCE

The energy  balance,  together with the mass  balance,  provides the basic  data for
establishing the design parameters of  the  combustion  process.  The total input and
output of the combustion process must  be equal.


E.11.a.  Inputs

See part H.3.a. of the  facility  planning section.


E.ll.b.  Outputs

See part H.3.b. of the  facility  planning section.


E.12.  ENERGY RECOVERY SYSTEMS

If energy  recovery is  planned  as a  part  of the  combustion process,  the  energy
recovery system  design should be  closely  coordinated with  the  combustion  system
design.  The design  of  energy  recovery systems  should  take   into  account  the
degree of reliability  of the  energy source.  It may be  necessary to  provide back-
up energy  sources  for critical  uses,  such as  digester heating. Where  pyrolysis
products are to be used as energy  sources  on  or  off-site conditioning systems may
be required  to  make  the product  usable. Energy recovery  systems will be  of the
following types:

     •   Multiple hearth furnace center  shaft  cooling air  recycle
     •   Stack gas heat exchange
     •   Reactor water  jacket
     •   Wet air oxidation effluent  heat exchanger
     •   Pyrolysis product recovery


                                        156

-------
E.I3.  ENVIRONMENTAL  IMPACTS

The  design  of  the  sludge combustion  system  should  consider  the  impact  on  the
environment,  minimizing any  deleterious effects.  Air impacts  are  minimized  by
properly  designed air  pollution  control  equipment.  Land,   surface water,  and
groundwater  impacts   are  a function  of  the   ultimate  disposal  systems and  are
discussed  under  the  appropriate  sections.  The social  and  health impacts  are
closely  tied  to the  air  impacts  and  are minimized by designing for minimum  air
pollution.  The  economic  impact  of the  system  design is  related  to  the  proper
design of the reactor,  selection  of  the auxiliary fuel,  and  design of  the  energy
recovery systems.


Section F - SLUDGE FOR  OFF-SITE USE BY  OTHERS

Systems  which process  sludge  for off-site use  by others  are of  widely varying
types. The principle  processes which produced usable  products are:

     •   Drying
              Flash drying
              Drying  beds
              Drying  lagoons
     •   Composting
              Windrow composting
              Static  pile composting
     •   Combustion
              Incineration ash
              Wet air oxidation residue
              Pyrolysis process residues

Combustion processes  are  discussed in detail in the  preceeding  section  and  will
not  be  discussed  further herein,  except  to mention  that  many  of the  product
safety and  packaging  design features discussed  also  apply to  combustion process
residues.

The  processes discussed  in  this   section  are all  intended  to  produce  a  sludge
product which is useful as a soil  conditioner or fertilizer.
F.I.  SLUDGE CHARACTERISTICS

The characteristics  of  the sludge which  have the greatest  impact on  the  design
of  the sludge  processing are moisture  content  and sludge flow.  Nutrient  (nitro-
gen, phosphorus,  potassium)  content  will affect  the  values  of  the  final  product
as  a fertilizer  while heavy metal,  toxic  organic compound and  pathogen contents
will affect its safety and the suitable markets.
                                        157

-------
F.I.a.  Type of Processing  at  Treatment  Plant

The degree of stabilization may  be  specified by local regulatory agencies to pre-
vent  potential  health  hazards. The degree  of dewatering will  determine  the size
and type of processing facilities.


F.l.b.  Quantity; Maximum,  Average, Minimum

The quantity of sludge produced  will  determine the size  of  the processing units,
the amount  of  land  required  for lagoon,  drying  bed,  and  composting  operations
and  the quantity  of bulking  agent  required for  composting  operations.  Sludge
quantities must take into account chemicals  added to the sludge  in conditioning
and dewatering steps.


F.I.e.  Analysis

The solids  content  of the  sludge will  be  an  important  factor in  sizing  drying
processes,  in   determining   bulking  agent  requirements  for composting,  and  in
assessing the sludge's value as  a supplemental solids source for solid waste com-
posting. Dewatered  sludge moisture  content  of 20 percent are  typical  for sludge
to  be  composted,  while   sludge  flow  to drying   beds  and  lagoons  is  typically
undewatered anaerobically digested  sludge  with  a solids content  of  2-6  percent.
Sludges to be heat  dryed  should  be  dewatered  to  the  lowest  cost-effective solids
content, 20 percent  being typical.

F.2.  COMPOSTING

Composting processes are  described  in Part  I.2.b.  of the facility  planning sec-
tion.  Typical design criteria for  composting operations are summarized  in  Table
17.
F.2.a.  Bulking Agents

The dewatered  sludge  (typically 20 percent) solids  is  delivered to  the  site  and
is usually  mixed  with a  bulking agent. The  purpose of  the  bulking agent  is  to
increase  the  porosity of  the  sludge  to  assure  aerobic  conditions during  com-
posting.  If the composting  material is too dense  or wet it may  become  anaerobic
thus producing odors; or if  it  is  too  porous  the  temperature  of  the material will
remain low.  Low  temperatures  will delay the completion  of composting  and  reduce
the kill of pathogens.
                                        158

-------
                 TABLE  17.  TYPICAL COMPOSTING  DESIGN CRITERIA
Loading Rates

       Dewatered sludge
       Sludge - Bulking agent
         Mix ratio
       Bulking agent


       Composting period

       Curing period

Expected Performance

       Compost production
         Unscreened
         Screened 1/2 inch
          screen)

       Minimum composting
         temperature

       Finished compost
         Moisture content
         Volatile solids

       Bulking agent recovery
Sidestream (Runoff water)
20 to 25 percent solids  1 dry  ton
solids is equal to approximately 7
cubic yards of dewatered sludge
2.5 to 3.0 parts bulking agent  to  1
part dewatered sludge by volume

Requires 17 to 21 cubic yard per
dry ton of sludge.

14 to 21 days

30 days
26 cubic yard per dry  ton sludge
10 to 12 cubic yard per dry ton sludge
55 to 60°C - Forced air static pile;
50 to 55°C - Windrow
40 to 50 percent
40 percent

Variable depending on type of agent,
degree of screening, but in range of
60 to 80 percent following screening.
            Data are not available on runoff water  characteristics  except  that
       the quantity may vary from 6 to  20 gallons per  day  per  pile  containing 50
       cubic yards of sludge during dry weather.
                                        159

-------
Various bulking agents have  been  used  and  several typical agents are:

     •   Unscreened finished  compost
     •   Shredded and classified  solid waste
     •   Wood products wastes
             Wood chips
             Bark chips
     •   Other wastes
             Rice hulls
             Licorice roots
             Peanut shells
             Shredded tires

Generally,  one  part  sludge 20 percent solids is  mixed  with  three  parts  bulking
agent although this mixture  can  be varied depending on  solids content  of  sludge,
type of bulking agent, and local  conditions.


F.2.b.  Sludge Receiving and Mixing

The design  of the sludge  receiving and nixing area  should  include facilities for
sludge storage, bulking  agent storage, a mixing  area, and  sufficient  maneuvering
space for the mixing equipment. At very large plants mixing may be performed by a
composting  auger,  but the majority  of  facilities will  use  a front end  loader.
Surface area requirements  for sludge  mixing  piles are  typically  30 to  60 square
feet  per  cubic  yard of  sludge  to  be  mixed.  To  this   must  be  added  the  area
required  for sludge  and bulking  agent storage and  equipment  maneuvering. Mixing
pile  dimensions  should be suited to  the  mixing  equipment  to be  used.  Concrete
pads are typical.


F.2.c.  Windrow

This  method is described  in Part I.2.b.(l)  of  the  facility  planning  section.
For composting  periods  of  14 to  21  days areas  of  500  to 1500 sq  ft  wet  basins,
are required for each cubic  yard  per  day wet sludge flow.   Approximately 100 per-
cent additional area  is  required for  maneuvering  of equipment.  In locations that
receive substantial rain, windrow areas should be paved  to  facilitate  operation.
F.2.d.  Static Pile

This  process  is described  in Part  I.2.b.(2) of  the  facility  planning  section.
Static  piles  typically require areas of 8  sq  ft/cu yd of mixture or 28  to  33 sq
ft/cu  yd  of sludge. For  composting  periods of  14  to  21 days,  area requirements
are 390 to  690 sq  ft/cu yd/day on  a  wet  sludge flow basis.  Approximately 100 per-
cent  additional  area should be allowed  for  pile construction equipment maneuver-
ing  and  aeration   equipment.  Composting  areas  should  be  paved   to  facilitate
operation.
                                        160

-------
F.2.e.  Mechanical Systems

Mechanical  systems  are  described  in  Part  I.2.b.(3)  of  the facility  planning
section.

Mechanical  composting systems  are  proprietary  and should  be designed  in close
cooperation with the  equipment  manufacturers.


F.2.f.  Curing

Following composting,  the  product  is  removed from  the windrow or  static  pile and
cured in  storage piles for 30 days or  longer.  Curing  may be  performed before or
after screening. Curing  piles  should  be  as large  as  possible to  minimize space
requirements. Heights  of 10 feet and  widths of  20 feet  are the maximum dimensions
practical with  a  typical  front end loader. Large  operations  with  more sophisti-
cated equipment can  build  more space  efficient  curing  piles. For  30  days  curing
pile  areas  of  170  sq  ft/cu yd of  curing  compost are  typical. Approximately 100
percent additional  space  should be allowed for  equipment maneuvering. Screening
of compost prior to  curing can  significantly reduce curing area requirements.

The curing  area may  not  be paved for  ease of handling,  and  should be accessible
for movement of the  product to  the  screening or packing  stage.

F.2.g.  Screening

Compost is  typically screened  with a horizontal rotary  type screen  with  1/4 to
one inch  openings.   Vibratory  screens have  also  been  successful.  Bulking  agents
retained  by the screen is  recycled  to  the mixing  stage.  Screening  may be  per-
formed before or after curing.


F.2.h.  Facilities

The bulking  agent  storage areas should be adjacent to  the   receiving and  mixing
area  and  should be  accessible  for  new bulking agent  deliveries  and  movement of
recycled  bulking  agent   from  the  screening  area.  Screening  areas should  be
covered  in  regions  which  experience  heavy  rainfall.  Consideration should  be
given to  equipment  parking,  maintenance  and fuel  needs.  Covered  storage  may be
advantageous.  Maintenance  will usually  be performed  off-site.  On-site  fueling
facilities  should be provided  for all but  the smallest  facilities.  In addition to
possible  covered  equipment storage,  a small  building  with  office space,  and  a
locker room with showers  should be provided.  The building should  also include  a
lunch  room, which  may be  combined  with   the  office  space.  Fencing  around  the
entire  site is  advisable. Eight   foot  high  chain link  fences   with three  top
strands of  barbed wire  are  usually  satisfactory,  although  the  fencing  may be
reduced in areas where the potential  for  vandalism is  low.
                                        161

-------
F.2.1.  Equipment

Table  18 lists  the  equipment  requirements for typical windrow and forced air sta-
tic  pile  operations.  Actual  equipment   requirements  will  vary  widely  with  the
equipment available,  the size  of  the operation,  and possible alternate  uses  of
the equipment at other  sites.


	TABLE  18.   COMPOSTING EQUIPMENT	

	Windrow	Forced air static pile	
Specialized windrow turner         Rubber tired front loader, 4 cu yd

Dump truck (*)                     Dump truck (*)

Rubber tired front  loader,         Aeration blower assemblies and pipe
  4 cu yd

Drum screen                        Drum screen

                                   Composting machine (**)

 * Requirement  will depend  on  site and operation
** May be helpful for  mixing  on larger applications
F.3.  DRYING

F.3.a.  Drying Beds

Drying  beds  are  generally   used   for   dewatering  of  well  digested  sludges.
Attempts  to air dry  raw  sludge usually  result  in odor problems.

The  drying  of sludge  on sand beds is  accomplished by  allowing water  to  drain
from  the  sludge mass  through a  base  of supporting  sand to drainage  piping  and
natural evaporation  to  the  air. As  the  sludge  dries, cracks develop  in  the sur-
face  allowing  evaporation to  occur from the  lower layers which  accelerates  the
drying process.

Drying beds are generally open to the  weather but  may  be covered with ventilated
green-house type of  enclosures where it  is necessary to  dewater  sludge in wet or
cold climates.

Figure 16 is a cross-section  of  a typical sludge drying bed.

The  required  surface area for sludge  drying beds  is dependent on  such  climatic
factors as air  temperature,  relative humidity,  amount  and  rate  of precipitation,
percentage of sunshine,  and wind  velocity.
                                        162

-------
  SLUDGE — ||j-«-
       COLLECTION

         SYSTEM-*
DRAINAGE
          -*-fl-
                                              SLAB
                        o°    GRAVEL-     o*
                        re°ot> oo o^*!.^.^
I
Figure  L6.   Typical  sludge drying  bed construction.
                         163

-------
Table 19 is useful in  evaluating the adequacy of  the  total  surface area.  Sludge
beds consist of perforated  or  open  joint  drainage pipe laid within a gravel base.
The  gravel  is  covered  with a  layer  of sand. Partitions  around  and  between  the
drying beds may be of  concrete,  wood  or earthen  embankment.
     Condition
                       TABLE  19.  DRYING BED LOADING RATES
 Open beds
Covered beds
Primary digested sludge,
   sq ft/cap

Primary and humus
   digested sludge,
   sq ft/cap

Primary and activated
   digested sludge,
   sq ft/cap

Primary and chemically
   precipitated digested
   sludge, sq ft/cap

Solids loading rate,
   Ib/yr/sq ft

Moisture content of dried
   sludge, percent
1.0  - 1.6


1.25 - 1.75



1.75 - 2.5



2.0  -2.5



 up to 25


  50 - 60
0.75 - 1.0
1.0  - 1.25
1.25 - 1.5
1.25 - 1.5
 up to 40
  50 - 60
Table 20  is  useful  in evaluating  sludge  loading depth, base  design,  wall design
and underdrain design.

Many design  variations are used  for  sludge drying  beds including  the  layout of
the  drainage piping,  thickness  and  type  of  materials  in  the  gravel  and  sand
layers, and  construction materials used  for the partitions.  The  major variation
is  whether  or not  the  beds  are  covered.  Any  covering structure  must  be  well
ventilated.  In  the  past, some  beds were  constructed  with flat  concrete bottoms
for  drainage  without   pipes,   but   this  construction   has   not   been   very
satisfactory.

Consideration must  be  given to sludge  removal.  Hand removal  by  shoveling sludge
into trucks  is typical  for  small  plants.  Mechanical removal of sludge from drying
beds has  been practiced  for many  years  at some large treatment plants, but now it
is  receiving more attention because of  the need  to  minimize labor costs.  Mechan-
ical devices  can  remove sludges of 20  to 30 percent solids while cakes  of  30 to
40  percent are  generally required  for  hand removal. Small  utility  tractors  with
modified  front end  loaders  are  often  used for  removal.
                                        164

-------
                     TABLE  20.   DRYING BED DESIGN PARAMETERS
       Design parameter	Typical design values

       Sludge depth,  inches                             8-12

       Gravel layer depth,  inches,                     12 - 18
         typically 3-inch  layers
         graded from  coarse  at
         bottom to fine  at  top

       Sand  layer depth,  inches,                        6-12
         typically 0.55  mm  size

       Drainage pipe  spacing,                           8-20
         feet typically  6-inch
         diameter

       Typical module size,  feet:
           Length                                      20 - 100
           Width                                       20 - 25
Most removal systems,  either  hand  or  mechanical, benefit by the provision of con-
crete  treadways  in the drying  bed  for mechanical  equipment  or  trucks.  Beds can
also  be designed  with flexible  plastic  drainage  pipe  to  allow  tractors  with
floatation tires directly  on  the beds.

In  some instances  drainage  of the  sludge can  be  speeded  up  or  increased  by
adding  chemicals.  Where  it is known that  a  sludge  is  relatively  difficult  to
dewater  by  mechanical methods,  it will  most  likely  be  difficult  to  dewater  by
sandbeds, drain  poorly and dry slowly. Addition  of conditioning chemical facili-
ties should be provided in these cases.

F.4.b.   Drying Lagoons

Sludge  is  periodically  drawn  from a  digester,  placed  in  the  lagoon,  removed
after  a period of drying,  and  the cycle  repeated.  Drying  lagoons  are  not   typi-
cally  provided with an underdrain  system as most of the drying is accomplished by
decanting supernatant  liquor  and by  evaporation.   Plastic or  rubber fabrics may
be  used as  a  bottom lining,  or  they  may be  natural earth  basins.  Supernatant
liquor  and  rainwater  drain  off  points  can be  provided,  with  the  drained off
liquid  returned  to the plant  for further  processing.

Table  21 presents  some typical  parameters for  the design of drying  lagoons.
                                        165

-------
                TABLE  21.   DRYING LAGOON DESIGN PARAMETERS (7)
Design parameter	Range of design values	

Solids loading rate                    2.2 - 2.4 Ib/yr/cu ft of lagoon capacity
Area required:
 Examples:
  Dry climate, primary  sludge          1  sq ft/capita
  Wet climate, activated  sludge        3-4 sq ft/capita
Dike height                            2  ft
Sludge depth after decanting           15 in
  (depths of 2-4 ft have  been
  used in very warm climates)
Drying time for depth of  15 in         3-5 months
  or less
The  design  of  the  drying  lagoons  must  also  include  adequate  provisions  for
decanting  the lagoon and  for removal  of  sludge.  Methods for decanting the lagoons
include overflow weirs,  partially or  completely along  one  end  of  the lagoons and
stand pipes.  For  shallow  lagoons  sludge can be removed  by front end  loader and
truck.  Deep  lagoons  (>4'  deep)  may  require a  dragline  or   clamshell.  Lagoons
should be  ramped for equipment  access  and,  if permanent,  berms should be designed
to support the  constant  use  of heavy equipment.  Temporary berms can  be rebuilt
after every  use.

F.3.c.  Heat Drying

Flash dryers  and  rotary kilns are sized on  the  basis of the  solids  loading rate
and heating  requirements.  The principles that apply  are  similar  to  those used in
designing  sludge  incinerators.  Flash  dryers  and rotary  kilns  are  usually avail-
able in several module  sizes  with sludge drying  capacities  typically ranging from
40 pounds  per hour to 2,400 pounds per hour  of  sludge  feed.  The  expected perfor-
mance from a flash  dryer or rotary kiln is  a dried sludge with a  solids content
ranging from 90 to  98  percent.  Heat  dryers  are usually  designed with  the  close
cooperation  of  one  or  more manufacturer  of  drying equipment  and  specific design
factors such  as loading rates are functions  of  the equipment  used.  There are two
basic types  of heat dryers,  flash dryers and rotary kilns.

F.3.c.(l)   Flash  Dryers  -  Before introduction  into  the  flash dryer,  the sludge
must undergo  thickening and dewatering.  The  incoming  dewatered sludge  is blended
with a  portion  of the  previously heat dried sludge  in a mixer. (See  Figure 9).
Hot  gases  from the  furnace at approximately 1,200° to  1,300°F  (650°  to 700°C)
then are mixed with  the blended sludge before drying  in  the  cage  mill.  Agitation
in the cage or  jet  mill  dries  the sludge  to approximately 2 to  10  percent  mois-
ture and  reduces  the  temperature to  approximately 300°F  (150°C)  before cyclone
separation  of  the  solids  from the  gases.   A  portion of  the  dried solids  are
recycled to the mill and  the rest are  stored for use or  incinerated.  The  gases
from the cyclone  separators  are  conveyed  by the  vapor fan to  the  deodorization
preheater  in  the  furnace  where  the temperature  is  raised to  approximately 1,200°


                                        166

-------
to 1,400°F (650° to 760°C).  The  deodorized gases release a portion of the heat to
the  incoming  gases and  release  more heat  in the  combustion air  preheater.  The
temperature is reduced  to  approximately 500°F (260°C)  before the  gas is scrubbed
for  particulate  removal and conveyed to  the stack  by  the induced draft  fan.  If
the dried solids are not used  in the furnace as a  fuel,  then auxiliary fuel such
as gas, oil, or coal is necessary.

The  design  of flash drying systems must  take into  account  the  following  major
subsystems:

     •   Flash drying cycle
              Wet  sludge conveyor
              Sludge dry product mixer
              Cage or jet mill
              Cyclone

     •   Incineration cycle
              Combustion air fan
              Furnace
              Combustion air preheater

     •   Effluent  gas cycle
              Deoderizing air  preheater
              Combustion air preheater
              Dust collector
              Induced draft  fan

     •   Product handling cycle
              Dry  product conveying
              Product storage
              Product loading  or packaging

Dust control  must  be given  careful  consideration in  flash  drying systems.   The
product is a light, finely  divided,  combustible,  abrasive material which presents
serious  safety,  maintenance,  and  housekeeping  problems  if not  properly  con-
trolled. When mixed  with air  the  dust  can be highly explosive  and  when  inhaled
could  aggravate  respiratory problems.  The dust  is a  major  cause of  mechanical
equipment  failures at   existing  plants  due  to  its  action  on bearings  and  other
moving parts. Adequate  measures  must be included in  the  project  design to reduce
airborne dust to a minimum  and to  prevent  conditions conducive to explosions.

F.3.c.(2)    Rotary Kiln  Dryers  -  Rotary  kiln dryers   are  described  in  Part
I.2.a.(3)(b) of the facility planning section.

The design should  consider  the following major  components of  the  system:

     •   Rotary kiln
     •   Sludge feed system
     •   Effluent  gas system
     •   Product handling system
                                        167

-------
While dust  is  not  as  severe a problem as  with  flash dryers, its  control  must be
considered  in  the project design.

F.3.c.(3)   Air Pollution Control -  Heat  drying  in  general, produces  an  exhaust
that contains  unacceptable quantities  of air  pollutants.  Therefore,  the  system
design usually includes  equipment necessary  to  reduce the emissions to acceptable
levels. This may require particulate collection efficiencies as high  as  96 to 97
percent. Air pollution  control requirements  for  heat drying are  very similar to
those for sludge incineration and the reduction  section of this  manual  shall be
consulted.  In  addition  to cyclonic  and wet  scrubber  and electrostatic precipita-
tors, dust  filters are  sometimes  used  for  heat  drying systems.

F.3.c.(4)    Auxiliary  Fuel  -  Substantial  quantities  of  auxiliary  fuel  are
required for heat drying systems. The  fuels  most  often used are:

     •   Cas
     •   Oil
     •   Coal
     •   Dried sludge

Gas, oil,  and  coal are used for cage mill  flash  dryers.  Dried  sludge  is  also
sometimes used, but an  additional supply of  gas or oil  must be provided  for sys-
tem startup and sludge  ignition in that  event.  Gas  and oil are  suitable fuels for
both jet mill  flash dryers  and rotary  kilns.


F.4.  COMPOSTING WITH REFUSE

Co-composting  of sludge  with  refuse  generally falls  into one of  two categories:

     •   Use of refuse  as a bulking  agent  in sludge  composting
     •   Use  of  sludge  as  a  nutrient  and  moisture  source   in  solid  waste
         composting

The design  of  co-composting systems  must  take into  account the  differing  require-
ments for sludge and solid  waste  composting.

F.4.a.  Refuse As a Bulking Agent

Sewage  sludge  has  too high a  moisture content for  successful  windrow or  static
pile construction  without the aid of  a  bulking  agent.  The cellulose  (paper and
some garbage)  fraction  of solid  waste may offer  a suitable and  economical bulk-
ing agent.  Design  of  systems  for using  refuse  as a  bulking agent  should  include
adequate shredding and  classifying  facilities. If  the product  is  to  be  screened
with a  finer  screen  that the typical  shredded  refuse  partical   size,  classifi-
cation facilities may be unnecessary.


F.4.b.  Sludge As a Nutrient  Source

Solid waste generally  requires supplemental  nitrogen  and  moisture for successful
composting.  Sewage sludge  has been suggested as  an  economical  source   of  the

                                        168

-------
additional  nitrogen (54).  Composting  facilities  to  use sludge  for supplemental
nitrogen should provide  facilities  for distributing sludge and mixing it with  the
solid waste.  It should  be recognized  that sludge  generally has a higher pathogen
content than  solid  waste, and  great  care must be taken in its handling.


F.5.  NUTRIENT ENRICHMENT

It  may  prove  cost-effective to  increase the market  value  of  the  sludge product
by  nutrient enrichment.  While  nitrogen and  phosphorus  (phosphoric  acid) contents
can  be  increased  with  a subsequent  increase   in value,  the greatest  nutrient
shortcoming of  most  sewage sludge  products is  the  potassium  (potash)  content.
Nutrient enrichment  processes  may be part of the sludge management  system or they
may  be  practiced  by fertilizer processors  who  purchase the  unenriched product
from the wastewater  agency.

Nutrient  enrichment  is   a  fertilizer   manufacturing  process  and  the  design  of
nutrient  enrichment facilities  should involve  the close  cooperation  of  a pro-
ducer or producers  of fertilizer manufacturing  equipment.


F.6.  PACKAGING

The project design  must  provide facilities  for  some  combination  of product pack-
aging,  loading,  and transportation.  The  design  of  these  systems will  depend
heavily on the end  use of the  product.


F.6.a.  Pick-up By  User

By far the most common system  of  delivering sludge for  off-site  use  by others  is
to  allow  or  encourage individuals to  pick up lagoon or bed dried sludge  at  the
treatment plant.  In this event,  provisions  should be  made  to  avoid  disrupting
other plant operations.  Sludge  may be  loaded by  the user or by utility  personnel.
If  it is planned  for the user  to remove  dried  sludge directly from  drying beds,
provisions should be included  in the design to prevent  damage  to sand  layers  and
underdrain systems  caused by  untrained personnel  removing  sludge  from  bed.  The
same concept  is  sometimes applied  to  larger deliveries,  with user  owned  trucks
loaded with sludge  during regularly scheduled drying  bed or lagoon  cleanings.


F.6.b.  Bulk  Delivery to  User

Sludge products are  often delivered  in  bulk to  the users. Trucks,  railroads  and
barges have been  used.  The section  on sludge transport has more  information  on
the design of sludge transportation facilities.
                                        169

-------
F.6.c.  Bagged

Bagging facilities  should  be designed in close  cooperation with manufacturers of
suitable bagging  equipment.  If the bagged  product  is  to be  sold  on-site a sepa-
rate covered  storage  and marketing area should  be  provided and located  so as to
avoid interference with  other  plant operations.

If the bagged product  is to  be sold off-site  suitable  loading and transportation
facilities must be provided.


F.6.d.  Instructions and Guidelines for  Use

Each bulk  pick-up or  delivery and each  bag of  sludge  should be  accompanied by
detailed instructions  and guidelines  for use,  explaining the following:

     •   The exact nature of the  material
     •   The guaranteed  nutrient  analysis
     •   Any limitation  on its  use, such as application to food chain crops
     •   Other suggestions and  pointers  on  its use

In the case of bagged  product,  it is  usually  convenient  to print  the suggestions
and guidelines directly  on the  bag.


F.6.e.  Brand Name

The selected brand  name  should be prominently displayed on  bags  and instruction
sheets, and in other appropriate  ways.


F.7.  ENVIRONMENTAL IMPACTS

The design of the  sludge processing system  should  minimize any deleterious envi-
ronmental impacts.

The only system considered which  has  a significant impact  on  air  quality is heat
drying. Air  impacts,  especially  airborne   dust  can  be  minimized  by  adequately
designed emission control equipment and  by  including  dust control  measures in the
project design. The impacts  of  the  system  on the land are  a  function of  the pro-
duct quality.  Impacts are  both  positive,   improved  moisture  holding  character-
istics and nutrient levels,  and negative,  heavy metals,  toxic organics, an patho-
gens.  In  most cases,  the wide dispersion  of  the  sludge  product  will  minimize
deleterious effects.  Adequate  warning  should  accompany any  product,  indicating
recommendations for restricted use when distributed  to the public.   Runoff from
drying beds,  drying lagoons, and  composting operations can  affect  surface water
quality if not  collected and  treated.  Provisions  should  be  made  in the project
design for collecting  and treating  the runoff.   In  most  cases  this  will  be by
returning  the runoff  to  the  wastewater   treatment  process,  although  separate
treatment facilities may sometimes be more  cost-effective.  Surface water impacts
due to product  use will generally  be minimal  due  to  the wide dispersion  of  the
product. Groundwater impacts of sludge  processing systems are due to infiltration

                                        170

-------
composting  operations.  Groundwater impacts  from product use  are  generally mini-
mal,  but  may be  significant  in exceptional cases. Infiltration  and percolation
can be minimized  by  proper  design  of  sludge  lagoons,  including impermeable liners
when necessary.

Social impacts  of all sludge  processing systems  include odors and  noise. Odors
are a  particular  problem with lagoons and drying  beds and are  best  minimized by
only drying well  stabilized sludges.  Composting operations present potential odor
and noise problems.  Odors can  be reduced by  proper composting procedures.  In sta-
tic pile composting  the  provision  of  a small deodorizing pile of finished  compost
on the blower  discharge  has been  found  helpful. Heat drying  systems may  require
deodorizing burners  or heaters  to  control odors from volatile hydrocarbons vapor-
izing in the process.

The safety  of  the  product  is  a  primary concern  in  sludge  processing  systems.
While  little  can be  done  within  the  processing system  to  control  heavy metals
and toxic organics  contents,  the system  must provide  adequate pathogen reduction
for the end use.  Lagoon  and drying bed sludges  may require disinfection.  Properly
operated  composting  and heat  drying  operations will  generally provide  adequate
pathogen  reduction.   Control  of disease vectors,  such  as  flys,   mosquitos,  and
rodents, must be  given adequate  consideration.  Flys are a problem with all sludge
processing  systems,  but  particularly  with sludge drying beds.

Mosquitoes  are  best  controlled by  design of the  site grading  so  that  potential
breeding spots, such  as  standing pools of water, are  eliminated.
                                        171

-------
             PART H!

      OPERATION AND
MAINTENANCE  MANUAL

-------
                        OPERATIONS  AND MAINTENANCE MANUAL

                                  INTRODUCTION
The operation  and  maintenance manual  is  the key  to  a successful  sludge manage-
ment system. An  inadequate manual can doom  the  best planned  and  designed system
to  failure,  while  a  good  manual can  enable the  plant  personnel to  operate  and
maintain the plant  at an  optimum effectiveness  level. The  operation  and mainte-
nance manual should be prepared  in accordance with Considerations for Preparation
of Operation and Maintenance  Manuals (70). The design  concepts  should be clearly
explained  and  procedures  for operating  and maintaining  the  facilities  must  be
delineated. The manual is  intended to  be  a guide  for  the  operators  of the treat-
ment  facilities  and  will   help  to  ensure that  they understand  the  key design
features and the objectives for  which the system  was  designed.  The  manual should
include maintenance schedules, monitoring programs, and recommendations  for man-
power  utilization.  Additionally,  potential  problem areas,  symptoms  of process
malfunction,  and methods   of  control of adverse impacts  should be  described.
Special considerations,  such  as  agricultural practices for  land  application sys-
tems,  should also be  included.

The format of  this checklist  has been selected to  enable  the  reviewer to enter a
checkmark or comment  to  the right of  each item.  There are  5 major categories:

     A.  Sludge Transport
     B.  Land Application
     C.  Landfill
     D.  Combustion
     E.  Sludge Products for  Off-Site  Use by Others

Within each  category  are  numerous sub-elements.   Consideration  of one or  two  of
the major categories  may be required  for  a particular review.

It  is  not  necessary  to  include  all  the  sub-elements.  Only those  concerned with
the operation  and maintenance of the selected sludge  management  system should  be
considered.
                                        173

-------
                        OPERATION AND  MAINTENANCE  MANUAL

                                    CHECKLIST
A.    SLUDGE TRANSPORT
     1.  PIPELINE
     2.  TRUCK
         a.  Description of Equipment
             (Number and type of trucks,  capacity  of  trucks.)
         b.  Description of Facilities
             (Loading, unloading, washdown,  fueling,  and  maintenance)
         c.  Normal Operation
             (Operating schedule: Loading,  time, travel time,  unloading
             time, return time,  fueling and  daily  maintenance  time;
             route: normal and alternate;  loading  and unloading
             procedures)
         d.  Emergency Procedures
             (Vehicle breakdown, sludge spill)
         e.  Vehicle Safety Rules
         f.  Impact Control
             (Environmental: air pollution,  health disease  vector
             control; Social:  Noise, odor,  traffic.)
         g.  Personnel
     3.  BARGE
         a.  Description of Equipment
             (Number and type of barges,  capacity  of  barges.)
         b.  Description of Towing Arrangements
             (Tow contractor, operating hours, haul distance  and  route,
             barges per tow.)
         c.  Description of Facilities
             (Loading, unloading, washdown and maintenance.)
         d.  Normal operation
             (Operating schedule:  loading time, travel time,  unloading
             time, return time;  route: loading procedures,  unloading
             procedures.)
         e.  Emergency Procedures
             (Tow vessel breakdown, sludge spill.)
         f.  Safety
         g.  Impact Control
             (Environmental:  air pollution,  surface  water  pollution;
             health: disease vector control;  social:  noise, odor.)
         h.  Personnel
     4.  RAILROAD
         a.  Description of Equipment
             (Number and type of cars, capacity, ownership)
         b.  Description of Facilities
             (Loading, unloading, washdown and maintenance.)
         c.  Description of Haul Contract
             (Pick-up and set-out points  and  times)
                                        175

-------
         d.  Normal Operation
             (Operating schedule:  loading time, haul time,  unloading
             time, return time; loading procedures,  unloading  procedures,
             pick-up and set-out procedures, moving  cars on-site.)
         e.  Safety
         f.  Impact Control
             (Environmental:  air pollution; health:  disease  vector
             control;  social:  noise, odor.)
         g.  Personnel

B.    LAND APPLICATION
     1.  PERMITS AND STANDARDS
         a.  Solid Waste Disposal                                       	
             (Permit number, renewal date, if applicable,  permit
             requirements, permit application guidelines,  applicable
             Federal/State laws and agency regulations.)
         b.  Discharge Permits for Runoff and Leachate
             (Permit number, renewal date, if applicable,  permit
             requirements, permit application guidelines,  Federal/State
             laws and agency regulations.)
         c.  Crop marketing
     2.  APPLICATION EQUIPMENT
         a.  Description of Equipment
             (Number and type of application vehicles and  capacities.)
         b.  Description of Facilities
             (Washdown, fueling, maintenance, records and
             administration.)
         c.  Startup Procedures
             (Equipment check, application schedule  for  the  day.)
         d.  Normal Operation
             (Field pattern, log sheet, applicator speed.)
         e.  Shutdown
             (Equipment cleanup, completion and  filing of  log.)
         f.  Emergency Procedures
             (Vehicle breakdown, sludge spills,  injector clogging.)
         g.  Safety - Vehicle Safety Rules
         h.  Impact Control
             (Environmental: soil pH, etc.; health:  disease  vectors;
             social: odor, noise )
         i.  Personnel
             (Number, qualifications or training required)
     3.  FARM MANAGEMENT
         a.  Description of Equipment
             (Tillage equipment, harvest  equipment,  other  equipment.)
         b.  Description of Facilities
             (Maintenance shops, crop storage,  seed  storage.)
         c.  Crop Management
             (Crops grown, rotation schedule, consultants  used,
             custom harvesting contracts.)
         d.  Contingency Procedures
             (Equipment breakdown, crop problem  identification
             [e.g. disease].)

                                       176

-------
         e.   Emergency Procedures
             (Unacceptable increase in heavy metals or a toxic  element,
             extreme or unusual weather conditions)
         f.   Personnel                                                   	
             (Number, qualifications.)
     4.   MONITORING
         a.   Parameters to be Measured                                   	
         b.   Procedures                                                  	
         c.   How to Use Results                                          	
         d.   Reporting Procedures                                        	

C.    LANDFILL
     1.   PERMITS AND STANDARDS                                           	
         a.   Solid Waste Disposal
             (Permit number, renewal date,  if applicable,  permit
             requirements, permit application guidelines,  Federal/State
             laws and agency regulations pertaining to sanitary landfills.)
         b.   Discharge Permits For Runoff and Leachate                   	
             (Permit number, renewal date,  if applicable,  permit
             requirements, permit application guidelines,  Federal/State
             laws and agency regulations.)
         c.   Reporting Procedure for Spills of Raw or Inadequately       	
             Treated Wastewater
             (Federal/State laws and/or agency regulations requiring
             reporting of bypass/spill conditions; owner's responsi-
             bilities, penalties; reporting procedure including telephone
             numbers and sample report format.)
         d.   Water Quality Standards                                     	
             (Runoff receiving stream, adjacent  streams where  there  is
             a potential of a spill, state  stream classification  system.)
     2.   DESCRIPTION OF LANDFILL
         a.   Definition of Sanitary Landfill                             	
         b.   Design Criteria                                             	
             (Trench fill or berm dimensions, cover dimensions,
             site life.)
         c.   Description of Site                                         	
         d.   Generalized Description of Operations                       	
     3.   RELATIONSHIP TO OTHER UNIT PROCESSES
         a.   Pretreatment Processes                                      	
         b.   Sludge Transport                                            	
         c.   Runoff and Leachate Treatment                               	
         d.   Co-disposal With Refuse                                     	
     4.   MAJOR COMPONENTS
         a.   Facilities                                                  	
             (Leachate control, gas control, runoff control,  roads,
             soil stockpiles, inclement weather  areas,  structures,
             utilities, washracks, monitoring wells,  equipment  fueling
             and maintenance.)
         b.   Equipment                                                   	
             (Excavating, sludge handling,  backfilling, mixing,
             compacting, grading,  road construction.)
                                        177

-------
     5.  MONITORING
         a.  Parameters to be Measured
             (Sludge, leachate, runoff,  gas.)
         b.  Procedures
         c.  How To Use Results
         d.  Reporting Procedures
             (Regulatory agencies, sample  record  and  reporting forms.)
     6.  STARTUP PROCEDURES
         (Monitoring background conditions,  initial  trench,  fill,  or
         berm location, initial trench dimension,  soil  stockpile
         locations, liners, if any.)
     7.  NORMAL OPERATION
         a.  Trench, Fill or Berm Locations
         b.  Trench, Fill or Berm Dimensions
         c.  Handling of Soil Removed From Trench
         d.  Imported Soil
         e.  Co-disposal Procedures
         f.  Liners
     8.  EMERGENCY OPERATION AND FAIL-SAFE FEATURES
         a.  Inclement Weather Operations
             (All weather roads, minimum on-site  haul distance.)
         b.  Gas Control
             (Permeable methods, impermeable methods, monitoring.)
     9.  LANDFILL COMPLETION
         a.  Ultimate Use
         b.  Grading at Completion of Filling
         c.  Final Grading
         d.  Landscaping
         e.  Continued Leachate and Gas  Control
    10.  SAFETY
         a.  Soil Stability
         b.  Equipment Operation
         c.  Gas Control
    11.  IMPACT CONTROL
         (Environmental: Leachate, runoff; health: vectors,  gas
         control, attractive nuisance; social: odors, noise.)
    12.  PERSONNEL

D.   COMBUSTION
     1.  PERMITS AND STANDARDS - AIR DISCHARGE PERMITS  AND  PERMIT
         REQUIREMENTS
         (Permit number, renewal date, if  applicable, permit
         requirements, permit application  guidelines, Federal/State/
         Local laws or agency regulations  dealing with  incinerator
         discharge permits.)
     2.  DESCRIPTION OF FACILITY
         a.  Design Criteria
             (Sludge loading rate, sludge  characteristics,  air
             pollution criteria, energy  recovery.)
         b.  Process Description
                                        178

-------
     3.  RELATIONSHIP TO OTHER UNIT  PROCESSES
         (Pre-treatment process, sidestream  treatment,  ash disposal,
         co-disposal with refuse.)
     4.  MAJOR COMPONENTS
         a.  Sludge Charging
         b.  Reactor
         c.  Auxiliary fuel
         d.  Air Supply
         e.  Steam Supply
         f.  Energy Recovery
         g.  Air Pollution Control
         h.  Ash Handling
     5.  MONITORING
         a.  Parameters
             (Sludge, stack emissions,  temperatures,  air flows,
             fuel consumption.)
         b.  Procedures
         c.  Using Results
         d.  Reporting Procedures
             (Regulatory agencies, sample  record  and  reporting forms.)
     6.  STARTUP
     7.  NORMAL OPERATION
     8.  EMERGENCY OPERATION AND FAILSAFE  FEATURES
         (Unit process downtime procedures,  flame safety system.)
     9.  SHUTDOWN
    10.  SAFETY
         (Flame safety system, auxiliary  fuel  safety,  reactor safety. )
    11.  IMPACT CONTROLS
         (Environmental: air; social: odors.)
    12.  PERSONNEL

E.   PROCESS FOR OFF-SITE USE BY OTHERS
     1.  PERMITS AND STANDARDS
         (Air discharge permits and  permit  requirements,  Federal/State/
         Local requirements for sale  of fertilizers.)
     2.  DESCRIPTION OF FACILITY
         a.  Design Criteria
             (Sludge loading rate, sludge  characteristics,  bulking
             agents, product production rate,  product  quality.)
         b.  Process Description
     3.  RELATIONSHIP TO OTHER UNIT  PROCESSES
         (Pretreatment processes, sludge  transport, sidestream
         control and treatment, ash  disposal,  co-disposal with refuse.)
     4.  MAJOR COMPONENTS
         a.  Mixing
         b.  Aerating
         c.  Handling
         d.  Screening
         e.  Drying Beds or Lagoons
         f.  Ash Disposal
         g.  Auxiliary Fuel
         h.  Air Supply

                                        179

-------
     i.  Air Pollution Control
     j.  Nutrient Enrichment
 5.   MONITORING
     a.  Parameters
         (Sludge, product, stack emissions, temperatures,  oxygen
         air flows, fuel consumption.)
     b.  Procedures
     c.  How to Use Results
     d.  Reporting Procedures
         (Regulatory agencies, sample record and reporting forms.)
 6.   STARTUP
 7.   NORMAL OPERATION
 8.   EMERGENCY OPERATION
 9.   SHUTDOWN
10.   SAFETY
     (Flame safety system, auxiliary fuel system, equipment
     operation safety, dust control.)
11.   IMPACT CONTROL
     (Environmental: air, runoff; health: finished product,
     disease vectors; social: odors, noise, dust.)
12.   PERSONNEL
                                   180

-------
                        OPERATION  AND  MAINTENANCE MANUAL
                              SUPPORTING  COMMENTARY
The EPA  publication Considerations for  Preparation of Operation  and  Maintenance
Manuals  (70),   referred  to  as Considerations  in  this  publication,   includes  a
detailed  checklist  and  accompanying  text  describing  the  information  to  be
included in a comprehensive  operation  and  maintenance  manual.

Considerations  and  the information  included herein are  intended  to  be  flexible
guidelines  for  the  operation and  maintenance manual evaluator  and   author  and
must  be  tailored   for  the  individual  facility.    It   may  be  desireable,  for
example,  to  prepare a  separate manual  for  the  sludge  disposal  site  if  it  is
remote  from  the wastewater  treatment facility.    In  that case,  the   chapter  on
wastewater treatment facilities could  be eliminated.
Section A - SLUDGE TRANSPORT

Manuals for  sludge  transport systems  can generally  follow the format  listed  in
Considerations for pumping  stations  and  pipelines,  with modifications to suit the
sludge transport system used.

The  following  discussion  highlights  the  factors  which  are  pertinent  to  the
efficient  operation  and  proper  maintenance  of  sludge  transport.    It  is by  no
means intended to be all-inclusive or  to  deal with  every topic in  great  detail.


A.I.  PIPELINE

The  format  and  requirements for  manuals for  pumping stations and  pipelines  are
described in great detail in Considerations  and  will  not be repeated herein.


A.2.  TRUCK

Truck  transport  equipment  and  facilities   will   require  regular  maintenance
checks.  A schedule  of  routine  maintenance should  be  followed to  insure trouble-
free operation of the transport trucks and avoid untimely emergencies.


A. 2.a.  Description  of Equipment

A full  description  of the  type and  number of trucks should be available  to  the
drivers and  other  plant personnel.   Maintenance manuals must be  readily acces-
sible  so  that  routine and  emergency repairs  can be  made  quickly  and  correctly.
Proper operation of  the  truck  transport  system  depends  on  maximum utilization  of
the trucks without exceeding safe-load capacities.


                                       181

-------
A.2.b.  Description of Facilities

A  complete  description  of  all  transfer  facilities  should be  available  to  the
operating staff.  Procedures for  loading  and  unloading sludge should  be clearly
described and  the  staff given  instruction on  the  function and  proper operation
of all components.  A maintenance schedule should  be  established and followed to
insure efficient operation  and  maximum  performance  of  the equipment.


A. 2.c.  Normal Operation

Records of normal  operation should be  kept  and periodically  reviewed  as  a check
of the efficiency  of operations.   The operating schedule  and  time spent perform-
ing each function  (loading, unloading,  haul,  etc.) should be monitored.   It  can
provide useful  information  for improving  current  operations  and  planning future
changes. A map  of  the normal  route  and alternate  routes  should  be  available at
all times.   The  drivers (regular  and  substitute) should be familiar with  the
various routes between the  treatment  plant  and disposal site.

The operating  staff must be  familiar  with  the procedures  for  safe handling of
the sludge.   These should be as simple  as possible  so  the  operation is efficient
and the potential  for accidents  is minimized.


A.2.d.  Emergency  Procedures

Emergencies are inevitable  in  this type of operation;  however,  their effects  can
be minimized if the operators  are  trained and  prepared  for  them.   Procedures  for
dealing with various  types  of   emergencies,  both general and  specific,  should be
clear, concise and readily  available.

Perhaps the  two most  obvious  emergencies would be vehicle breakdown  and sludge
spills.   The former  will  be  minimized  with  regular  maintenance.   However,  an
adequate supply of spare parts,  particularly  those which  commonly fail  or  are
difficult to  replace,  should be  stored at the  treatment  plant.    A maintenance/
repair  manual  should contain  all the  information  necessary  for  repairing  dis-
abled  transport  vehicles.    Sludge spills  at  the  plant site  can be  avoided to
some  degree  if  the transfer equipment  is   easy  to  operate and  the staff properly
trained.   Spills  resulting from  accidents  involving  the  transport vehicle  can
result  in unsafe  road conditions  and present a threat  to  public  health.   These
should  be  cleaned  up as   quickly  and  thoroughly   as  possible  to  minimize  the
inconvenience they cause.

The manual should  outline  spill notification  procedures  identifying the agencies
to be notified, such as  the state  health,  highway and pollution  control  agen-
cies,  give the telephone numbers  for  such notification, and include copies of  the
reporting forms for the subsequent written report of the spill.
                                        182

-------
A.2.e.  Vehicle Safety Rules

Only  qualified  personnel  or supervised trainees should  be  operating the transfer
and transport equipment.   Safety rules should be posted  and  all  drivers aware of
highway rules and other considerations which will  make their jobs safer.


A.2.f.  Impact Control

Although  mitigating measures  to reduce  adverse  environmental  impacts  are  con-
sidered during design,  impact  control should be practiced  on a day-to-day basis.
Air  pollution equipment  on the  transport  vehicles  should be  functioning  prop-
erly.  The exposure  of the operation and  general  public to  sludge  should  be
minimized.  Transport  activities should  be  carried out  with  the  least  amount of
disruption to public activities;  this  involves  minimizing noise, odor and traffic
congestion.


A.Z.g.  Personnel

Plant  personnel  should  be  adequate  in  number  and  experience   to operate  the
transport  facilities  efficiently.    They  should   be  specially  trained for  the
functions  they  perform, familiar  with the  duties  of other  operators,  and  pre-
pared to handle any emergencies  which  may arise.


A.3.  BARGE

As  with  truck  transport,  barging  facilities require regular maintenance.   The
following  discussion  describes the  general  requirements for  operating  an  effic-
ient barging  system.


A.3.a.  Description of Equipment

All barging equipment  should be fully  described.   The number,  type and capacity
of  the barges are important  information for  the operators to  have.


A.3.b.  Description of Towing  Arrangements

The towing  arrangements should  be  clearly spelled  out  for the  operating  staff.
The tow contractor, operating  hours and phone number  should  be  clearly  posted in
an  obvious location.    The  route,  haul  distance  and  travel  time  should  be
recorded so that  present  operations can  be monitored  and future  activities  plan-
ned.  A  record  of the  number  of barges  towed  per  trip  and  the  amount  of  sludge
transported should also be  kept.

A.3.c.  Description of Facilities

A  complete description of all  transfer  facilities  should be  available to  the
operating  staff.  Procedures for  loading  and unloading  sludge should  be clearly

                                        183

-------
described and the  staff  given  instruction on the function and proper operation of
all  components.   A maintenance schedule  should be  established and  followed to
ensure efficient operation  and  maximum performance  of the equipment.


A.3.d.  Normal Operation

Records of  normal  operation should be  kept  and periodically reviewed  as  a check
of the efficiency  of  operations.   The operating schedule  and  time  spent perform-
ing each function  (loading,  unloading,  etc.) should be monitored.   It can provide
useful information  for  improving current operations  and  planning  future changes.
A map of the barge route should be  available for tracking and emergencies.

The  operating  staff must  be familiar  with  the procedures  for  safe  handling of
the sludge.  These  should be as simple  as  possible  so the  operation is efficient
and the potential for accidents is  minimized.


A.3.e.  Emergency Procedures

Emergencies  are  inevitable  with  this type  of  operation,  however,  their  effects
can be minimized if the  operators  are trained and  prepared for  them.   Procedures
for dealing  with various types of emergencies,  both  general  and specific, should
be clear, concise and readily  available.

Perhaps  the two most  obvious  emergencies  would  be   the  towing vessel  breaking
down and accidental sludge  spills.   The former  is  the  responsibility  of the  tow-
ing company  unless  self-propelled  barges are used, in  which  case  regular mainte-
nance  practices  will  minimize  equipment failures.   Sludge  spills  at  the  plant
site can be  avoided  to  some degree if  the  transfer equipment is easy  to operate
and the staff properly  trained. Spills  resulting from accidents during transport
can  result  in serious  water pollution  and  associated  health  problems.   Sludge
should  be  contained  as  well  as  possible  and  transferred to  another  barge as
quickly as possible to reduce  risks.

The manual  should  outline  spill notification  procedures,  identifying  the  agen-
cies  to  be notified, such  as  the  state health and  pollution  control agencies,
give  the  telephone  numbers  for  each notification  and  include  copies  of  the
reporting forms for the  subsequent  written  report  of  the spill.


A.3.f.  Safety

Only qualified personnel or supervised trainees should  be  operating the transfer
and transport equipment.  Safety rules  should be posted and strictly enforced.


A.3.g.  Impact Control

Although mitigating measures  to reduce  adverse environmental  impacts are   con-
sidered during design,  impact  control should be practiced  on  a  day-to-day basis.


                                        184

-------
Air pollution equipment  on the towing vessels should  be  functioning properly and
measures  must  be taken  to avoid surface  water  pollution.   The exposure  of the
operators and the general  public  to  sludge should  be minimized.   Transport activ-
ities should be  carried  out with  the least amount  of disruption to public activi-
ties; this  involves minimizing  noise,  odor  and  other nuisances  associated  with
the barging activities.


A.3.h.  Personnel

Plant  personnel  should  be  adequate in   number  and  experience  to operate  the
transfer  facilities  efficiently.    They  should  be  specially  trained  for  the
functions they  perform,  familiar  with the duties of  other  operators and  prepared
to handle any emergencies  which may  arise.


A. 4.  RAILROAD

Railroad  transport  of  sludge is not  common;  however,  it  can be  economically
competitive with other  methods   (16.)   The  following sections  briefly  describe
general considerations for operating rail  transport  facilities.


A. 4.a.  Description of Equipment

The railroad  cars,  whether leased  or purchased,  should  be described  in detail.
The description  should include the  number and type,  the capacity  and ownership
status  of  all cars.   Operation  and maintenance  procedures  should  be described
and available for use  by the  plant operators.

A.4.b.  Description of Facilities

Sludge  transfer facilities  should   be  described  in  detail  along with operating
procedures for loading,  unloading and general maintenance.

A.4.c.  Description of Haul Contract

The details of  the  transport  arrangement  pertinent  to  the  efficient operation of
the system should be  readily available to  the plant operators.   The  pick-up and
delivery  schedule of  the railroad should  be  posted  and any modifications  to the
regular schedule clearly noted.


A.4.d.  Normal Operation

A complete, detailed  description  of  normal operations  should  be available  to the
plant operators.   Records of  the time  required for various functions should be
kept  for  historical  purposes and to provide information  for  estimating  future
operations.   All procedures  for  loading  and unloading the  cars and  moving  them
about at  the plant  site  should be outlined and reviewed periodically by the plant
staff.
                                        185

-------
A.A.e.  Safety

Only  qualified  personnel  or supervised trainees should  be  operating the transfer
or transport equipment.   Safety  rules  should  be  posted and  strictly enforced.


A.4.f.  Impact  Control

Although mitigating  measures  to  reduce adverse  environmental  impacts  are consid-
ered  during  design,  impact  control should be  practiced on  a  day-to-day  basis.
Air pollution controls  are the responsibility of  the  railroad.  The  exposure of
the operators and the general public  to  sludge should  be  minimized.   Transport
activities should be carried out with the  least  amount of disruption  to  public
activities;  this  involves minimizing  noise,  odor  and other nuisances  associated
with  rail transport.


A.4.g.  Personnel

Plant personnel should be adequate  in  number  and experience to operate the trans-
fer facilities  efficiently.   They  should be  specially  trained  for the functions
they  perform, familiar with the  duties of other operators  and prepared to handle
any emergencies which may arise.


Section B -  LAND  APPLICATION

The land application system should  be  operated and maintained  in such  a way that
sludge  is  applied to  the land without  creating a nuisance  or causing  environ-
mental  degradation.    Accurate  record keeping  is essential  to safe  operation.
The operation and  maintenance  manual should be  written  with  these  concerns in
mind.  Loading rate determination  is presented in Appendix A.


B.I   PERMITS AND  STANDARDS

Numerous permits  are required  to  operate  a  land  application system. As well, cer-
tain  standards  must  be upheld  and reporting  procedures for  non-compliance clearly
specified.  Land  application  systems  are often  considered  solid   waste  disposal
systems from a  regulatory agency  viewpoint.


B.I.a Solid Waste Disposal

The information  pertinent to operating  the  system   which  is  specified in  the
solids waste disposal  permit  should be readily  available.  The  operators should be
familiar  with   specific  information such as  the  issuing  agency,   permit number,
renewal date and  specific requirements.  In  addition,  they should be aware of more
general  information  such  as  permit application  guidelines  and laws  and regula-
tions pertaining  to  land  application systems.
                                        186

-------
B.l.b.  Discharge Permits  for  Runoff and Leachate

Permits will be  required  for the discharge of all  uncontained and treated runoff
and leachate.  The  operators should  be familiar  with  the permit,  including  such
information as  the number,  renewal  date  and  specific requirements  contained in
it. Copies of  all  permits should be readily available for reference. Information
such  as  application guidelines  and  general requirements should  be  available to
operators.

B.I.e.  Crop Marketing

Regulations concerning  crop  marketing or future  crop  production  on the  site  must
be  followed.  There may  be  restrictions  on the  ultimate use  of  crops  grown on
sludge-amended soils.


B.2.  APPLICATION EQUIPMENT

Application equipment  for injection of  sludge  can be  attached  to the  back  of a
tank  truck or  pulled  by a farm  tractor  usually,  the  track-laying  type.   Surface
spreading  can  be  accomplished by trucks or conventional farm  manure  spreading
equipment.If the sludge  is in  liquid form, spraying may  be  accomplished by large
nozzle sprinkler.


B.2.a.  Description of Equipment

The O&M manual  should contain a  complete description of  the  equipment  including
number, type, and capacities of  all  application  vehicles.


B.j.b.  Description of Facilities

The site facilities or  those related to  application will  usually consist of wash-
down,  fueling and  maintenance  facilities  and   an  office  or area  for  records
keeping and  administration.   These  facilities along  with equipment  within  them
should be described in  the O&M manual.
B.2.c.  Startup Procedures

Startup procedures  can be divided into  those  required for  daily  or intermittent
startup and  those  required for  seasonal  startup.   Daily  procedures include lub-
rication and  liquid level checks as well as usual  checks  on all  equipment.   The
seasonal  checks consist  mainly  of  preventive  maintenance  and  cleaning.    The
daily startup  includes provision of a drawing or  map telling  the  operator  which
areas are to be covered and what  quantities  are  to  be applied.
                                        187

-------
B.2.d.  Normal Operation

Normal  operation  procedures  should  be very  specific  with  step-by-step instruc-
tions included. The operating instructions  should include a field pattern for the
application  plan.  This  should show  the  areas  to be  covered and  the  order  of
application. At 'the  end of the day the operator  should file a log  sheet showing
areas and  quantities  applied. A  sample  log sheet should  be included  in  the O&M
manual. The O&M manual  should provide a nomograph or  tables to correlate applica-
tor  speed  with amount  applied (wet   tons/acre).  This  correlation is  specific  to
the type of sludge and  equipment  used.


B.2.e.  Shutdown

Specific  procedures  need  to  be  provided  to  insure equipment  readiness  for the
following day. Injectors  should  be flushed with  water  to  remove  residual solids.
These instructions should be  included in the  manual.  The O&M manual  should pro-
vide  instructions   on  completion   and   filing   of   the   log   sheet  mentioned
previously.


B.2.f.  Emergency Procedures

Emergency procedures  should be provided with the  O&M manual.  They should include
the  following items.   The  manual  should  provide instructions   concerning  what
action  to take  when  a vehicle  breaks  down.  This  should  include  options  for
removing  sludge  before  it  goes  septic.   Cleanup,   containment  and  reporting
instructions for sludge spills should be included in the  manual.  Injector clogg-
ing  can be  caused by  a minor obstruction  or  by  faulty or  damaged  equipment.   A
troubleshooting table  should  be  provided  on how to correct this  problem.


B.2.g.  Safety - Vehicle  Safety  Rules

Safety  rules specific  to  the  injection operation  should be provided.


B.2.h.  Impact Control

There  are  several  environmental  problems  that   should  be prevented.  Specific
instructions  on  control  measures should  be  included  in  the manual.  Prevention
programs  for  disease  vector or rodent breeding areas  should be  provided  as part
of  the  O&M  manual.   Odor  control measures should  be   explained  even  if  proper
stabilization  processes and application  procedures have been provided. Noise con-
trol measures  are  generally not  a problem  in rural areas.  In exceptional cases,
however, noise control  programs  should be provided.


B.Z.i.  Personnel

The manual  should  include a  recommended  staffing level and a description  of the
qualifications  required  and/or  specialized  training  needs.   There   are  no

                                        188

-------
established  manpower  requirements  because  of  variation  in  application  time
periods,  loading rates,  sludge solids  concentrations,  and  type  of  application
equipment.  Personnel  requirements must  be  considered on a case-by-case basis.


B.3.  FARM MANAGEMENT

This  section  is  required  for  those  agencies  who  wish  to  conduct  the  farming
operation with their own  staffs and  equipment.


B.3.a.  Description of Equipment

The farming equipment  including tractors, trucks, tillage  equipment  and harvest-
ing equipment  should  be  described  and  manufacturers  operating and  maintenance
schedules  included.  Lubrication  schedules  should  be  part   of  the  maintenance
schedule.
B.3.b.  Description of Facilities

The  O&M manual  should provide  a  complete  description  of  the  farm  facilities
including the equipment within  each facility.  One of  the  most  important  areas of
a farming operation  is  the maintenance shop. There  will  be a  large  inventory of
specialized  equipment  within  this  shop.  Complete  operation  and  maintenance
instructions  for  this equipment should  be included  in  the manual.  Crop  storage
facilities generally  consist of bins  or  buildings with little mechanical  equip-
ment  other  than the  loading and unloading  facilities.  Maintenance  instructions
plus rodent control procedures should  be  provided.

These  facilities  are  similar to crop storage  except more  specialized  handling
procedures must be delineated.


B.3.c.  Crop Management

Instructions  should be  provided  for each  crop grown  specifying planting  and har-
vesting schedules. Recommended methods of  tillage,  weed  control,  and pest  control
should also be included.  Crop marketing  practices  should  also be  discussed.   Sup-
plemental  fertilizer computation  procedures  should  be  delineated.  Methods  for
adjusting pH should be shown.

Each  item in  the  above  section should be  discussed  for  each crop  grown.   Recom-
mended  crop  rotation  schedules  should  be provided  along with  a discussion  of
changes in application procedures necessary  to adjust to  different  crops.   Recom-
mended  areas  requiring  specialized expertise  should be  outlined.  The  agency  can
then  be  prepared to  obtain consulting  services as  recommended.  The  O&M  manual
should provide guidance on how  to  obtain  custom or  contract  harvesting.  A sample
contract or contract  format  should  be  provided with  the manual.
                                        189

-------
B.3.d.  Contingency Procedures

There  are  two  areas  where   emergency  procedures   or  contingency  plans  are
required.  They  are  related  to  equipment operation  and  crop disease  control.
Farm equipment breakdown  can  be considered an emergency  if  this  breakdown occurs
at planting time or at harvest.  The O&M manual should provide  guidance  on how to
continue  or  modify operations  with  alternate  equipment.  Unusual  problems  will
require a specialist but  there  are  many problems  that  can be identified with min-
imal  training.  These  problems  include pests, weeds,  nutrient deficiencies,  and
poor drainage. This information should be  included in  a  troubleshooting format.


B.3.e.  Emergency Procedures

The two  major emergency  conditions  that can develop  with  the farming  operation
(not related  to  equipment)  are  discovery of excessive heavy metals and extremely
cold or wet weather.

If sludge or  soil monitoring  shows  unacceptable levels  of  heavy metals,  then the
sludge must  be applied at  a lower  rate or application  site shifted  to  another
area. Changes may also be made  at the treatment plant to  modify  these concentra-
tions. Plans  for operating under  these circumstances should be   included  in the
O&M manual.

Some  climate  extremes  such as  cold  or wet weather  can  result   in  operational
problems  or a major crop  loss.  For example, when  faced  with late  spring,  it may
be useful  to  switch from  corn to soybeans  or sorghum  to make use  of  the  shorter
season.  These  circumstances  and   the  solutions  to   minimize  losses  should  be
discussed in  the manual.
B.3.f.  Personnel

Personnel  requirements  are  somewhat  complicated  due to  the  seasonal  nature  of
farming. The manual should  show  the number  of  personnel  required for each farming
task. Along with this the  timing of  each task should be  provided.  This should be
shown in such  a  manner  that seasonal  variations  can be  easily  recognized.  Along
with the personnel requirements  listed  above,  individual qualifications should be
shown.  If special training  is  required,  this  should  be  shown also.


B.4.  MONITORING

A complete monitoring program  should  be established.  Background conditions should
be determined  so that the effects  of  land application can be assessed.


B.4.a.  Parameters to be Measured

Soils monitoring should  include pH,  CEC,  nitrogen,  phosphorus,  potassium,  and
heavy metals  (Cd, Cu,  Zn,  Pb,  Ni). The  nutrient  analyses are necessary for good
crop  growth  and for preventing  excessive  amounts of nitrogen  or  phosphorus  in

                                        190

-------
succeeding  applications  or for  determining  additional nutrient  needs. Potassium
is  not  normally a  problem but  monitoring is  necessary  to  determine additional
needs for good  crop growth. The  pH,  CEC and metals  determinations are necessary
for preventing metals accumulations  in soils  or crops. Pathogen monitoring should
be as specified by  the regulatory agency.

Crop  monitoring  should  include  yield,  crop  disease, and crop  pest evaluations.
Tissue analysis may  be required  periodically  for food-chain crops. Crops destined
for human consumption should be  monitored  for pathogens.

Surface  waters  and  intermittent streams  (when flowing)  should  be  monitored as
required by the appropriate regulatory agencies. Monitoring points should include
at least one sampling station  upstream of  the application area and one downstream
from  the application  area. Frequencies depend  on  circumstances of  each  site.
Minimum  parameters  include BOD^,  suspended  solids,  nutrients,   and  coliforms.
Nearby domestic  wells should  be  tested prior  to  project startup  and  then moni-
tored  periodically.  On-site  monitoring wells  should  be placed  and  sampled as
required by the appropriate regulatory agency.  At a minimum, tests should include
nitrates, total dissolved  solids  and  coliforms.


B.4.b.  Procedures

The procedures  for  sample  collection  and  analysis should be  clearly outlined in
the operations guide. These will vary depending on the specific chracteristics of
the site, but for any site,  they should be closely followed.


B.4.c.  How to Use  Results

The  results  of the  monitoring and sampling  program will  be  used  to  assess  the
operation. The  interpretation  of the  data  collected can indicate the success of
the  current operation,  may lead to  develop  procedural  changes  to  improve or
streamline activities,  suggest design modifications  and  provide  a useful tool in
planning  future  expansions.   Based  on  the   monitoring reports,  a  complete  and
through assessment  of operations  should be made periodically.


B.4.d.  Reporting Procedures

The operators  should be familiar with the reporting  requirements and procedures
outlined  in the  operating  permits.  Submitting  regular  reports  to  the  various
agencies  having  jurisdiction  over  the  operation  is important. The  operators
should be fully aware of  the penalties involved in failure to do  so.

Sample reports and  record-keeping practices  should be available to the operators.
All data, logs and  reports should be  kept  in  an orderly manner in a safe place.
                                        191

-------
Section C - LANDFILL

The  successful operation  of a  sludge landfill  is  a  relatively  straightforward
task although  it  requires  attentive  surveillance. The following sections describe
the  information  and  procedures  necessary  to operate  and  properly maintain  a
sludge landfill.


C.I.  PERMITS  AND STANDARDS

Numerous permits  are  required to operate  a landfill. As well,  certain  standards
must  be   upheld   and  reporting  procedures   for  non-compliance   are  clearly
specified.


C.I.a.  Solid  Waste Disposal

The  information pertinent to  operating the landfill which  is  specified  in  the
solid waste disposal  permit  should  be readily available. The  operators  should be
familiar  with  specific  information  such  as  the  issuing  agency,  permit  number,
renewal  date   and  specific requirements.  In  addition,  they  should  be  aware  of
more general information such  as permit  application  guidelines and laws  and regu-
lations pertaining to sanitary landfill  operations.


C.l.b.  Discharge Permits  for Runoff  and Leachate

Permits will be required  for the discharge of  all uncontained and treated runoff
and  leachate.  The operators should  be familiar  with  the  permit, including  such
information as the number,  renewal  date  and  specific requirements  contained  in
it. Copies of  all  permits  should be readily available  for  reference. Information
such  as  application guidelines  and  general requirements  should  be  available  to
operators.


C.l.c.  Reporting Procedure  for  Spills of  Raw  or  Inadequately Treated Wastewater

All  violations of discharge requirements  must be reported  to the jurisdictional
agency.  The  reporting  procedures  and  emergency  phone  number should be  clearly
posted and  the operators  familiar  with them.  A sample report  format  should  be
available. The. owner  and  operators  should be  informed  of  their  responsibilities
for  violating  the  discharge standards and the possible penalties which could  be
levied.
C.l.d.  Water Quality Standards

It is the responsibility  of  the  operating agency to conform  to  the  quality stan-
dards of  any waters  affected by  the  landfill  operation. The operators  should be
aware of  local streams  receiving runoff from the landfill  and  of  their classifi-
cations  and beneficial  uses. Particular  care  should  be  taken  to prevent  the
accidential  pollution of  quality sensitive  streams or  water  supplies  near  the
landfill.
                                        192

-------
C.2.  DESCRIPTION OF LANDFILL

A detailed  description  of the landfill will  be  useful to  the  regular operators,
new  or  substitute  operators, owners,  jurisdictional  officers and  consultants.
This should include narrative  and  graphical  information defining the method land-
fill  operations,  the  design criteria,   the site  and  unusual  or  outstanding
features. A general  description  of the normal and emergency operating procedures
should be  included.  The  description  of  the   landfill  should be simple  and clear
enough  for a  non-technical  audience yet  comprehensive  enough  for those  more
familiar with such systems.


C.3.  RELATIONSHIP TO OTHER  UNIT PROCESSES

Landfill  is the last  step  in an  often  complex chain of  wastewater and  sludge
treatment processes. In order  to fully understand  its  function and operation, the
operators should be aware of  its relationship with these  other processes.


C.3.a.  Pretreatment Processes

The processes upstream  of landfilling will  determine  the nature  and  quantity of
sludge to  be disposed  of. The operators  should  be  aware  of what  these  processes
are and how their operation  or elimination will  affect the  sludge  characteristics
and landfill operations.


C.3.b.  Sludge Transport

The  sludge  transport   operations  directly   influence  the  landfill  operations.
Ideally,  a  more-or-less  continuous  or  at least  regularly   scheduled  delivery of
sludge  should  be  expected  at  the  landfill.  The  landfill operators should  be
informed of any  variations  in the  transport  schedule  and alerted  to  any emergen-
cies so their operations  can  be modified  accordingly.


C.3.c.  Runoff and Leachate  Treatment

If  runoff  and  leachate treatment  facilities are  located  at  the  landfill  site,
the operators should be familiar with them.  If these  flows  are  pumped or trucked
to an off-site  location for treatment the operators  should be  familiar  with the
transport system.


C.3.d.  Co-disposal With  Refuse

If  sludge  is  to be  included in a  refuse landfill,  close  coordination  will  be
necessary. A clearly defined disposal plan and a regular transport  schedule  will
simplify  operation  and reduce the potential problems associated  with  combining
the two operations.
                                        193

-------
C.4.  MAJOR COMPONENTS

The  successful  operation of  a sludge  landfill  depends, in  part,  on  the  under-
standing and operation  of ancillary  facilities  and equipment. These must be main-
tained to insure reliable operations.


C.4.a.  Facilities

The operating staff  should  be familiar with the operation  and  maintenance  of all
facilities at the  landfill  site.  In  addition  to  the manufacturer's  O&M instruc-
tions, an  operations manual  should  be available  and  reviewed periodically.   It
should include  such information  as  a  regular  maintenance  checklist,  a trouble-
shooting guide,  an  emergency  operation plan and safety  guidelines.  Features such
as  leachate,  runoff and  gas  controls,  roads,  soil   stockpiles  and  inclement
weather areas are  essential  to  the  day-to-day  operation  of  the landfill.  Other
facilities such  as  offices,  utilities  and equipment yards are provided for the
operators' comfort  and  convenience;  these must  be maintained in the  interest  of
safety  and aesthetics. Monitoring  wells  and  equipment   are  to  safeguard  the
public health, protect  against adverse  environmental  impacts  and  to aid in  future
operations planning; these  should  be  maintained  and operational at  all times.


C.4.b.  Equipment

The mechanical  equipment for periodic  and day-to-day operations such as  excava-
tion, sludge handling,  and  processing,  filling  and cover  must be  operational  at
all  times.  Daily  maintenance  checks  and preventive  repairs are  a  necessity.
Periodic  troubleshooting can reduce  the unscheduled downtime  of  this  equipment
and minimize  costly work stoppages.  Maintenance and operations  schedules  should
be carefully planned, clearly posted  and  followed  as  closely  as possible.


C.5.  MONITORING

A  complete  monitoring  program  should be  established  prior  to  the  startup  of  a
sludge landfill. Background conditions  should  be determined so  that the operation
and effects of the  landfill can  be assessed.


C.5.a.  Parameters  to be Measured

It is possible  to  measure  numerous parameters  at  a landfill site,  however, only
those features yielding useful information should  be  studied. The characteristics
of  the  sludge such as   source,  solids  content,  quantity   application,  location,
etc.  should be  recorded daily.  The  quantity  and  quality  of  leachate  and  runoff
should also be measured.  Climatic conditions  should  also  be  noted.

The number and type  of  monitoring wells is highly site-specific.  It  is essential
that  these wells be  sampled according  to  the specified  schedule.  Maintaining sur-
face  and   groundwater   quality   is  an  essential  task   associated  with  landfill
operations.

                                        194

-------
C.5.b.  Procedures

The procedures  for  sample collection  and  analysis should  be  clearly outlined in
the operations  guide.  These will  vary depending  on  the  specific characteristics
of the landfill, but for  any site,  they  should be closely followed.


C.5.C.  How to Use Results

The results  of the  monitoring and  sampling  program will  be  used  to  assess the
landfill  operation.  The  interpretation  of  the  data  collected  can  indicate the
success  of the  current  operation,  may  lead  to  develop  procedural  changes  to
improve or streamline activities,  suggest  design modifications and provide a use-
ful tool  in planning future expansions.  Based on the monitoring reports,  a com-
plete and through assessment of  operations  should be  made periodically.


C.5.d.  Reporting Procedures

The operators  should be  familiar  with the reporting  requirements and procedures
outlined  in  the  operating permits.  Submitting  regular  reports to  the  various
agencies  having jurisdiction over  the  landfill is important. The operators should
be fully  aware of the penalties  involved in failure to do so.

Sample  reports  and  record-keeping practices  should  be  available to  the  opera-
tors.  All data,  logs and  reports  should be  kept  in  an orderly  manner  in  a safe
place.


C.6.  STARTUP PROCEDURES

Several  steps  are necessary  in  starting  up  a sludge  landfill.  These  will  vary
with  the  site and  type  of fill operation,  however certain basic  practices  should
be followed.  During operation it  would  be prudent to  check  nearby  aquifers and
surface waters against  the original background conditions  to  be  sure that  opera-
tions have not  adversely affected  their quality. The  initial work  site must  be
prepared  according  to  the landfill plan. This  work will depend  on  the  method  of
fill  to be used and  the measures designed  for environment impact  mitigation.  The
initial trench dimension  should  be  in  accordance with the filling plan. Depending
on the  degree  of  success  of the startup operations,  the trench  size may  be kept
the same  or modified  somewhat.  A soil  stockpile should  be  established  at the
landfill  site.  Depending  on the  method  of  operation, the  stockpile  will  be com-
posed of  native soil excavated during  initial trenching,  imported soil to be used
as a  bulking agent or cover, or  a  combination of the  two. The  stockpile should be
in a  convenient location  for  both  normal and  inclement  operations.  Trench  liners
may be an essential  element in the landfill  design.  Whether constructed of  soil,
or natural or artificial  material  they must be carefully placed prior to filling.
The liner specifications  should be followed  and an  inspection  made  before any
lined trenches are used.
                                        195

-------
C.7.  NORMAL OPERATION

After initial  startup,  normal operations  should  follow a  simple,  routine set of
procedures. These will  vary  depending  on the method of filling and may need to be
modified periodically.  The  operators should be informed  of any modifications and
instructed on  operational changes.


C.7.a.  Trench, Fill, or Berm Locations

After the  initial startup  the landfill  operation should  follow a  logical  fill
sequence. The  operators should be instructed  on  the  location  of  subsequent  fill
areas. A plan  of these  areas  should  be  included in the O&M instruction manual and
periodically reviewed by the  operators.


C.7.b.  Trench, Fill, or Berm Dimensions

The  size  of the  fill  areas  should roughly duplicate  those  initially  created;
they may,  however,  vary depending  on  the terrain.  The filling plan  included in
the  operators' manual  should clearly  specify any  deviation  in  the  established
operating scheme.


C.7.c.  Handling of Soil Removed  from  the Trench

Native material excavated during trenching should  be stockpiled  for  future use
as a bulking agent or cover  material.  The stockpile location should be convenient
and near the area where it  is to  be used. The  methods for  removing,  placing, and
storing this material should  be described in the  O&M manual.


C.7.d.  Imported Soil

The type and quantity of imported soil,  if any, should be described in the opera-
tions guide.  If more than one type  of  soil  is to be used at  the  landfill,  the
stockpiles should be clearly  identifiable and separate.


C.7.e.  Co-disposal Procedures

The  procedures for  co-disposal   of  sludge and  refuse,  if  practiced, should be
clearly  delineated  in  the  operating  instructions.  The  operators  should  be
instructed on  the procedures  for  mixing the sludge and refuse  as  well as for the
actual filling operations.


C.7.f.  Liners

Since liners are  critical  to the long-term  operation of  a  landfill,  if  they are
required  at  all,  their placement  and  maintenance  is  an  important  operational


                                        196

-------
item.  The materials  and  procedures  for  constructing  liners  should  be clearly
described  in the  O&M manual;  the  operators  should be  made  familiar  with this
information.
C.8.  EMERGENCY OPERATION AND  FAIL-SAFE  FEATURES

A contingency plan  for  emergency operation should be  included  in a separate sec-
tion of the O&M manual.
C.S.a.  Inclement Weather Operations

In general,  the  procedures  for operation  in inclement weather  should follow the
same  basic  steps as  normal  operation.  The  difference in  the  operation  is  the
location of  the  fill.   A separate fill area with  paved or all-weather  roads is
designated for use  during inclement weather. This  area  is  generally located near
the  main  entrance  to   the  landfill  to  minimize  the  sludge  haul  distance.  Any
special procedures  for using  this portion  of  the site  or  for filling  when  the
weather is bad should be identified and  easily  found in the O&M manual.

C.S.b.  Gas Control

The  accumulation  of gas produced  during filled sludge  decomposition  can present
a hazard at  the  fill  site.  Methane is  particularly dangerous since  it is explo-
sive under certain  conditions.

The  gas control systems should be  completely described  in  the  O&M manual.  Emer-
gency  operations  should  be   reviewed  periodically  so  the operating  staff  is
familiar with  them. Regular maintenance and  monitoring  will reduce the potential
for  emergency  operations. This cannot be overstressed  in  the  operation and main-
tenance manual, in  operator training  sessions,  or  on the job.


C.9.  LANDFILL COMPLETION

In completing  a  sludge landfill,  a certain set of  criteria must  be  met  to make
it  publically  acceptable.  These   criteria  will be  established  according  to  the
type of landfill and the location, size and ultimate use  of the site. The proce-
dures for site closure  should  be included  in the operations manual and updated or
modified if the original landfill  plan  is  not followed.


C.9.a.  Ultimate Use

The  ultimate use of the site  should be described and illustrated  in the O&M man-
ual  or a separate document  which describes  the  completion of the site. The actual
work involved  in  completing the site will  depend  on  its ultimate  use  and on  the
care taken in  day-to-day fill  operations.
                                        197

-------
C.9.b.  Grading at Completion  of  Filling

When each  section  of  the landfill is  complete,  the final cover  should be graded
according  to  a pre-determined  plan.   It  is  imperative that  no sludge  become or
remain exposed after the  grading  has  been completed.


C.9.c.  Final Grading

The  final  grading  is  to  be  performed  after  a sufficient  period  of  time  has
passed for  initial settlement  to  have occurred. The  final  grading  plan will be
designed  according to  the  ultimate   intended  use  of  the landfill  site.  It is
important  that  all sludge  be  completely covered  with  the  prescribed  depth of
cover material.


C.9.d.  Landscaping

The  landscaping  plan  should  reflect   the  intended  ultimate  use  of  the landfill
site. Where practical, landscaping may be done on completed  sections prior to the
completion of the entire  fill  project.


C.9.e.  Continued Leachate and  Gas Control

Since decomposition  of the  organics   in  the  sludge may  continue even  after  the
landfill has  been  completed, an  ongoing monitoring  and  control program must be
maintained. Leachate and  gas must  be  controlled even  after the filling operations
have  stopped. A   program for  doing  this  should  be clearly outlined in  the
completion plan.
C.10.  SAFETY

Providing a safe working  environment  at  the landfill should be a part of the gen-
eral O&M of the site. Certain  safety  features will be a part  of  the design, how-
ever,  day-to-day  practices  to  provide  safe  working  conditions  must  also  be
followed. The  O&M manual should have a  separate  safety  section  as well  as spe-
cific safety guidelines for  each operation  and  feature of  the  landfill.


C.10.a.  Soil Stability

The stability of  the soil at the  fill site,  particularly  near  the work  areas can
present a critical  safety problem,  particularly with  the  use  of  large equipment.
The  bearing  strength of  all disturbed areas should  be  checked  prior  to  moving
fill equipment  on them.  Caution should  be  used when  approaching muddy  areas  or
those subject to erosion.
                                        198

-------
C.lQ.b.  Equipment Operation

The operation  of  large earth moving  equipment  presents the  potential  for numer-
ous minor and  major  accidents.  Only fully trained  operators  should be  allowed to
operate such equipment.  Regular maintenance and  safety  checks  can greatly reduce
the number of  accidents  associated  with  equipment failure.


C.lO.c.  Gas Control

Caution must be  practiced when  dealing  with gas control equipment. Methane gas
can  be highly explosive.  The   O&M   manual should  contain  a  complete  set  of
instructions on the  safe  servicing  of  gas  control and monitoring equipment.   Ver-
bal instruction on  the operation of  this  equipment  should be  given periodically
at operation and safety  training sessions.
C.ll.  IMPACT CONTROL

The protection of  the  environment  and of the public  health  are important aspects
of the landfill operation  which cannot be overlooked.  The O&M manual should con-
tain  guidelines  for providing this  protection and  the  actual  operation  should
reflect these practices.

Environmental protection  is  generally focused  on leachate and runoff controls to
prevent surface and  groundwater contamination.  Trench  liners  must  be kept  intact
during and  after  filling  operations.  Drainage  systems should be checked  to see
that  they  are  functioning   as   designed.   If  monitoring   shows   that  adverse
environmental impacts  have occurred or pose a  threat,  immediate  action should be
taken to mitigate  them.

Protection  of  public  health  should  be  a  foremost  concern in the  operation  of
sludge landfills.  Protection  of water supplies  and  sole source aquifers  is  an
obvious responsibility.  In addition,  the control  of  disease  by  the  reduction of
vectors such as flies,  the adequate venting of  explosive or toxic  gases, and the
restriction  of  access  to  the landfill   site are  the  responsibility  of  the
operators.

Minimizing  the  aesthetic impacts  of  a sludge  landfill can  greatly  increase the
public acceptability of such  a project. The control  of odors,  noise  and  other
nuisances is  generally straightforward  and can  be  accomplished as  part  of the
daily operating routine. All  efforts should be  made  to reduce the  social impacts
of  the  fill operation  particularly if  the  site  is  located  in an accessible  or
populated area.


C.12.  PERSONNEL

The personnel requirements will vary depending  on the  specific features and size
of  the landfill  operation. Adequate  personnel  should  be  maintained  to  fill all
functions of  the   operation  and allow for  vacation  relief  and  emergencies.  The
staff should  be  properly  trained  to  perform their primary  duties  and  should  be

                                       199

-------
familiar with  the other  operations  at  the  site. Regular  training  sessions  and
safety incentive  programs will  encourage efficient  landfill operations.


Section D - COMBUSTION


D.I.  PERMITS AND STANDARDS - AIR  DISCHARGE  PERMITS  AND PERMIT REQUIREMENTS

All applicable  federal,  state  and  local emission limitations  and  permit require-
ments should be fully explained in the  operation  and maintenance manual. Included
should be permit  numbers, renewal  dates, permit  requirements and instructions for
making  renewal applications  and  a   summary of  all  federal,   state,   local,  or
regional laws and regulations pertaining to  the operation of incinerators.


D.2.  DESCRIPTION OF FACILITY


D.2.a.  Design Criteria

The facility description  must include a summary  of  the system design criteria:

     •    Anticipated minimum,  maximum,  and  average  sludge  loading rates
     •    Anticipated  sludge   characteristics,   especially  moisture   and  heat
          contents
     •    Design  criteria which relate  to  air  pollution, such as temperatures and
          detention times
     •    Design  criteria for  the energy recovery  systems,  including  operating
          temperatures, uses, and  anticipated  yields


D.2.b.  Process Description

The facility  description should include a description  of  the  combustion process
used.  The  process  description  should  follow  the sludge through  the  combustion
process, explaining the reactions  that  take  place.  For example, a multiple hearth
incinerator description would  describe   the  drying,  combustion  and cooling  zones;
the  action  of  the  rabble  arms;  and  the  flow  of   sludge  and  air through  the
reactor.


D.3.  RELATIONSHIP TO OTHER PROCESSES

The relationships of  the combustion  process to  the other  wastewater and  sludge
treatment  processes must  be explained. Included  in  the  explanation  should be
parameters  for optimizing the  relationships between  the combustion process  and
the related unit  processes.
                                        200

-------
P.3.a.  Pretreatment Processes

The relationship  of the sludge  pretreatment  processes to  the  combustion process
must be outlined. Typical  relationships  which should be discussed are:

     •    The effects  of  thickening and dewatering  system  efficiency on moisture
          content and  fuel consumption
     •    The  effects  of  chemical addition  on moisture  content,  heat  content,
          fuel consumption,  and  ash volume
     •    The effects  of wastewater treatment process operation on sludge volumes
          and characteristics

The combustion  system  sidestreams such  as  wet-air  oxidation liquor and scrubber
effluent water on wastewater treatment  processes  should be  explained.

Consideration should be given to the  effects  of the  rest  of the unit processes on
the ash disposal system, including:

     •    Sludge production  from wastewater  treatment processes
     •    Increases in ash quantities from  chemical  conditioning processes
     •    Effects on ash quantity and quality of  combustion process operation

Where co-disposal with municipal refuse is to  be  practiced,  the operating param-
eters of  the refuse  processing  system must  be   explained.  Data  concerning  the
approximate ratio of solid waste to sludge expected  or desired,  and the composi-
tion and quality (i.e., degree of classification,  particle  size, moisture content
and heat content) of the refuse  should  be  identified.


D.4.  MAJOR COMPONENTS

Each  of  the major  components  of  the combustion   process should be  described  in
detail,  identifying the design criteria  and  critical operating  parameters of each
item or system. The major  items  or systems  which  should be  included are:

          Sludge charging  system, including  pumps, grinders,  and conveyors
          Process reactor  or furnace
          Auxiliary fuel supply  and control  systems
          Combustion,  cooling,   fluidizing   and   wet-air   oxidation  air  supply
          systems
          Wet-air oxidation  steam supply systems
          Energy recovery  systems,  including  heat  exchangers,  turbines,  etc.
          Air pollution control  equipment
          Ash handling and disposal systems


D.5.  MONITORING

The operation  and  maintenance manual  should include  a detailed program  for  the
combustion  process.  The monitoring  program  should  cover  those  parameters  which
affect  compliance  with federal,  state,  regional  and local air  quality require-
ments as well as  those which pertain to incinerator operation.  Figure  17 illus-
trates a typical monitoring  program for  a  multiple hearth  incinerator.
                                        201

-------
•z
3
Z
2
D
UJ
H
c/)
UJ
a
o
 z
 o
 (-
 CL
 O

TEMPERATURE
TOTAL
VOLATILE
SOLIDS
TOTAL SOLIDS
STACK GAS
COMPOSITION


















UJ
N
tSI
t—
2 0
< 0
£ £



Z


















TEST
FREQUENCY
Mn
VD1
1/D1
Z


















LOCATION OF
SAMPLE
A
F
p
F
P
S


















METHOD OF
SAMPLE
Mn
G
G
Z


















REASON
FOR TEST
P
P
P
R


















                                                    ESTIMATED UNIT PROCESS SAMPLING AND
                                                               TESTING NEEDS
                                                   INCIN ERATION
                                                     FEED
                                                                   (MULTIPLE HEARTH)

1








I
A

A

A



nJ
•>,
s*r
A

A




| * STACK GASES
S
•"•s»_
-*" HEARTHS


PRODUCT
r
p
                                                    A.  TEST FREQUENCY
                                                         H =. HOUR     M - MONTH
                                                         D- DAY      R - RECORD CONTINUOUSLY
                                                         W- WEEK     Mn=» MONITOR CONTINUOUSLY

                                                    B.  LOCATION OF SAMPLE

                                                         I  = INFLUENT
                                                         E  = EFFLUENT
                                                         S= STACK GASES
C. METHOD OF SAMPLE

    24C-24 HOUR COMPOSITE
    G = GRAB SAMPLE
    R = RECORD CONTINUOUSLY
    Mn= MONITOR CONTINUOUSLY

D. REASON FOR TEST
    H - HISTORICAL KNOWLEDGE
    P = PROCESS CONTROL
    C =« COST CONTROL
    R = TO MEET REGULATIONS
E. FOOTNOTES:
     1. THESE  TESTS SHOULD ALSO  BE RUN ON RECEIVING
        WATER, ABOVE AND BELOW OUTFALL. ON A
        PERIODIC BASIS, DEPENDING ON LOCAL CONDITIONS.
     2.  AS REQUIRED TO MEET AIR QUALITY STANDARDS
                Figure  17.   Typical  multiple hearth  furnace monitoring  program.
                                              202

-------
D.5.a.  Parameters

Sludge monitoring should  include  total  sludge  flow,  total solids,  and total vola-
tile  solids.  Additional  monitoring  may be  required  by air  quality  regulations,
such as mercury or PCB  content. Stack emission monitoring should be in accordance
with  air  quality regulations.  In addition  to  the data  required  by  air  quality
authorities,  such information  as  carbon  monoxide  and  hydrocarbon   content  are
often  useful in  analyzing  reactor  performance.  Temperatures  are   the  critical
parameters  in  reduction system operation. Temperature  is usually monitored  con-
tinuously at several points  in  the process.  These monitoring  points  should be in
accordance with the combustion  process  manufacturer's recommendations. Monitoring
of combustion air,  cooling,  air,   fluidizing air,  or wet-air  oxidation  air flows
is often  useful  and  should be  included  in  the monitoring program  if recommended
by  the manufacturer.  Fuel  consumption  records  are  valuable  in  optimizing  the
operation of the combustion  and dewatering processes.


D.S.b.  Procedures

The manual  should explain all  monitoring  and  record-keeping  procedures,  includ-
ing sampling frequencies, methods,  and locations.  Laboratory  procedures  should
include  step-by-step  instructions  together  with  reference  to  the  appropriate
chapters  in Standard  Methods  for  the  Analysis  of  Water and  Wastewater   (9)  or
other laboratory desk  reference.


D.5.C.  Using Results

The operation and maintenance  manual should explain  the  purpose and  use  of  each
test.  Where monitoring  is  for  operational  parameters,  explanation should  be
included  as to  the  control actions which  should be  taken in  response   to  the
measurements.
D.5.d.  Reporting Procedures

The manual  should include  detailed instructions for  reporting required  data  to
regulatory  agencies.   The  agency,  required  parameters  and  reporting  frequency
should be identified.  Sample  record and reporting forms are valuable  aids to  the
operator and should be included.


D.6.  STARTUP

The startup  procedures  should include  a  sequence  of operations for  starting  the
combustion  system,  maximum safe  heating rates  for  reactors,   expected  auxiliary
fuel  consumption  and  operating temperatures which must be  attained  before opera-
tion  can begin.
                                        203

-------
D.7.  NORMAL OPERATION

Normal  operating  procedures should  include the  economical  range  of  sludge feed
rates,  the  range  of  air  supply  rates,  the range  of  auxiliary  fuel  consumption
rates,  normal  operating temperatures,  and operating  parameters  for  putting the
reactor  on  standby status  during periods  of  low sludge  flows,  or at  night for
daytime-only operations.


D.8.  EMERGENCY OPERATION AND  FAIL-SAFE FEATURES

A description  of  emergency procedures  should  be included,  including  the actions
to  be  taken in the  event  any component  of  the  combustion system experience  a
mechanical  failure.  The emergency procedures  should identify the  amount of time
expected  to be available  for  corrective  action and advise  the  operator  of any
consequential  problems  which may  result.  This  section  of the manual is the appro-
priate place to describe facilities  for improving reliabilities  such as:

     •    Standby power
     •    Standby fuel
     •    Duplicate process units
     •    Alternative sludge management systems


D.9.  SHUTDOWN

Shutdown  procedures  should include  a  detailed  sequence of  operations  for shut-
ting  down the combustion  system, maximum safe  cooling  rates  for reactors  and
expected auxiliary fuel consumption  during cooling.


D.10.  SAFETY

Detailed  safety  procedures should  be  described  for the  combustion system.  Most
safety  requirements  are  those  generally  applicable  to  wastewater  treatment
plants, but certain additional safety factors should be  called  to  the operator's
attention.  The flame safety  system's  purpose,  operation and features  should  be
called  to  the  operator's attention.  Special  instructions should be  included for
the safe use of the auxiliary  fuel and  associated equipment.

Safety  rules  for  the  reactor  should be  outlined,   including  such  things  as the
use  of  air  masks  within  the  reactor  and viewing burning  sludge only through
smoked glass.


D.11.   IMPACT  CONTROL

The manual  must  identify for  the operator those operating  parameters  which are
vital to  minimizing  deleterious  environmental  impacts.  Most of  these parameters
relate  to air quality  or  odor  control  and  include such things  as  maintaining
adequate  excess air  supply, insuring adequate incineration  temperatures  and gas
detention times, and  adequate  maintenance of  air pollution control  equipment.

                                        204

-------
D.12.  PERSONNEL

The  manual  should outline  operating and maintenance  personnel  requirements  for
the  combustion  and energy  recovery  systems.  Manpower requirements  for  incinera-
tion are given in  reference 71.  Emphasis should be given  to  any special qualifi-
cations  or  training recommended  by  the equipment  manufacturers.  Certain  energy
recovery equipment may  require a  qualified  stationary  engineer, for instance.


Section E - PROCESS FOR OFF-SITE  USE OF  SLUDGE  BY  OTHERS


E.1.  PERMITS AND  STANDARDS
All applicable  federal,  state and local emission  limitations  and  permit require-
ments should be fully explained  in  the  operation  and maintenance manual. Included
should be permit numbers,  renewal dates, permit  requirements and instructions for
making  renewal applications  and  a  summary  of  all  federal,   state,   local,  or
regional  laws  and  regulations  pertaining  to  the  operation of  flash  dryers  or
incinerators.

The manual should  include  a summary of all federal,  state  and  local requirements
concerning the  sale or  use of sewage  sludge  as  fertilizer. Some  states restrict
the  use  of   sludge  to  certain  applications.  Other  states  establish  minimum
nutrient  levels for  a  product  to  be  termed  "fertilizer".  Sludge products  not
meeting  the  minimum requirements may  be  required to  be  labeled as  "soil  condi-
tioner".  Requirements  for  labeling  of bagged product  should  be  summarized,  and
any necessary  warning labels  identified.  The requirements  for establishing  the
nutrient  analysis  of the  product (nitrogen,  phosphorus and potassium)  should  be
presented together  with  the labeling  requirements.


E.2.  DESCRIPTION  OF FACILITY
E.2.a.  Design Criteria

The facility description  should  include  a summary of the  design  criteria  for the
system. The summary should  include,  as a  minimum,  the following  information:

     •    Anticipated minimum, average,  and  maximum  sludge loading rates
     •    Anticipated sludge  characteristics including  moisture,  nitrogen,  phos-
          phorus,   potassium,  heavy  metals,   toxic   organic   compounds,   and
          pathogens
     •    Bulking   agent    description    and   anticipated   consumption   rate
          (composting)
     •    Anticipated product production  rate
     •    Anticipated product characteristics,  including  those  items  listed for
          sludge.
                                        205

-------
E.2.b.  Process Description

The  facility  description should  include a  detailed  description of  the  process.
The  description should  follow  the  sludge  through the  process, describing  the
reactions that  take place. A windrow composting process  description, for example,
would describe  mixing with the  bulking  agent,  construction of windrows, the aero-
bic   digestion   process   known  as   composting,   windrow  turning,   curing  and
screening.


E.3.  RELATIONSHIP TO OTHER  UNIT  PROCESSES

The  relationship of  the  sludge processing  system to other wastewater  and sludge
treatment  processes  must  be explained in  detail.  Included  in the  description
should  be  parameters and  procedures for optimizing  the  relationships  among  the
processes.

The  effects of  the  operation of the  wastewater treatment system on the quantity
and  quality of  product should be  discussed  in  detail.

The  relationship of  the sludge  and product   transport  systems  to the  process
should  be  explained, together  with  information  on optimizing  the  delivery  and
removal time for sludge  and  product.

The  effects  on  the  wastewater  treatment  process  of  the  return or  sidestreams
should be explained. Among the  sidestreams  of  concern  are:

      •    Composting process  runoff
      «    Flash dryer scrubber  effluent
      •    Lagoon supernatant
      •    Drying bed underflow

For  flash  drying using  dried sludge as fuel  systems  the effects on  ash  produc-
tion  of various  production  rates  and operating modes should  be  explained.  If  ash
is  returned  to the  wastewater  treatment process,  the  effects  of  the increased
load  on the treatment process should be explained.

Where co-composting  with municipal refuse is  practiced,  the  operating  parameters
of  the  refuse  processing system must be explained.  Data  concerning the approxi-
mate  ratio  of  sludge  to solid waste  expected or desired,  the composition  and
quality  (i.e.  degree of classification, particle  size  and  moisture  content  of
(i.e.  moisture  content  and  nutrient  analysis)   of    the  sludge   should   be
identified.
E.4.  MAJOR COMPONENTS

The  major  components of  the system  should be  described  in  detail,  identifying
the  design criteria and  critical operating  parameters of  each item  or  system.
Major items and systems which  should  be  included are:
                                        206

-------
          Mixing (composting)
          Aerating (composting)
          Handling
          Screening (composting)
          Drying beds or lagoons
          Ash disposal  (flash  drying)
          Auxiliary fuel (flash drying)
          Air supply (flash drying)
          Air pollution control (flash drying)
          Nutrient enrichment
E.5.  MONITORING

The  operation  and maintenance  manual  should include  a detailed monitoring  pro-
gram for  the  process.  The  program should include  those parameters which  affect
compliance  with  federal,  state,  regional  and  local   air  quality  requirements,
those which pertain to  the safety and  utility  of the  final  product, and  those
which pertain to  system operation.


E.5.a.   Parameters

Sludge monitoring should include:

     •    Total sludge flow
     •    Total solids
     •    Total volatile solids
     •    Monitoring  required to  assure  safety  such  as  heavy metals, PCB's  and
          pathogens
     •    Additional monitoring  required  by  air  quality requirements
     •    Nutrient content  including nitrogen, phosphorus  and  potassium

Product parameters which should  be monitored  include:

          Production
          Bulk  density
          Moisture content
          Nutrient content  including nitrogen, phosphorus  and  potassium
          Monitoring  required to  assure  safety  such  as  heavy metals, PCB's  and
          pathogens

Stack emission  monitoring  should  be in  accordance with air quality regulations.
In addition to  the  data  required by air quality authorities,  such  information as
carbon monoxide and hydrocarbon  content  are  often  useful in analyzing  flash dryer
performance.

Compost  pile  temperatures  should  be  monitored   to   assure  a  proper  rate  of
stabilization.  Temperatures  should be  taken  at the inside  of  the  compost  pile.
                                        207

-------
Temperatures  are  the  critical  parameters  in  flash  dryer  system  operation.
Temperature  is  usually monitored continuously  at several points  in  the process.
These  monitoring points  should be  in accordance with  the  dryer manufacturer's
recommendations.

Oxygen readings  indicate  the  performance  of  the composting operation and serve as
the  basis  for turning  windrows and  adjusting  aeration  blowers   for  static  pile
composting.

In  static  pile  composting,  monitoring of air  flows may  be  useful  in  assessing
system  performance.  This  can be most easily  accomplished  by monitoring  blower
running time.

Monitoring of combustion  air  flows  is often useful and should  be  included  in the
monitoring program if recommended by  the  dryer  manfacturer.

Fuel consumption records  are valuable in optimizing  the  operation  of  the  flash
drying processes.


E.5.b.   Procedures

The  manual  should explain all  monitoring and record-keeping procedures,  includ-
ing  sampling frequencies, methods,  and  locations.  Laboratory procedures  should
include  step-by-step instructions  together  with references  to   the  appropriate
chapters  in Standard Methods for  the Analysis  of  Water and  Wastewater  (9)  or
other laboratory  desk reference.


E.5.c.   Using Results

The  operation  and maintenance manual  should  explain  the  purpose  and  use  of  each
test.  Where  monitoring  is  for  operational parameters,  explanation should  be
included  as  to  the  control  actions  which  should be  taken  in  response  to  the
measurements.
E.5.d.  Reporting Procedures

The  manual  should include  detailed instructions  for  reporting required  data  to
regulatory  agencies.  The  agency,  required  parameters and  reporting  frequency
should be identified.  Sample  record and reporting forms are  valuable  aids to the
operator and should  be  included.

E.6.  STARTUP

The  startup  procedures  should include  a  sequence of operations for  starting the
process. This  is  particularly true for flash drying systems  which should include
such  data  as maximum  safe  heating  rates  for  reactors,  expected  auxiliary  fuel
consumption  and  operating temperatures which must  be  attained before  operation
can  begin.


                                        208

-------
Manuals  for  composting  and  bed and  lagoon drying  systems may  be able  to omit
separate  startup  instructions as  the  startup of  these  systems may  be indistin-
guishable from normal operation.


E.7.  NORMAL OPERATION

Normal  operating  instructions for sludge  processing systems should  identify the
economical range  of  sludge  feed rates and product packaging  and  loading instruc-
tions. Composting system descriptions  should  also  include:

          Mixing  instructions,  including  sludge-to-bulking  agent  ratios
          Windrow or static  pile construction  instructions,  including dimensions
          Windrow turning instructions and frequency
          Static pile aeration  schedules
          Normal range  of pile  temperatures
          Composting time
          Windrow or static  pile removal  instructions
          Curing instructions
          Curing  time
          Screening instructions
          Bulking agent  recycle  instructions

Flash drying systems should  include  the following  instructions:

     •    The normal range of air  supply  rates
     •    The normal range of auxiliary fuel  consumption
     •    Normal operating temperatures
     •    Instructions  for putting the system  on  standby status

Lagoon  and  bed drying  system instructions should  include  expected  drying  times
and sludge removal procedures.


E.8.  EMERGENCY OPERATION AND FAIL-SAFE FEATURES

A description  of  emergency  procedures  should  be  included,  including  the  actions
to  be  taken in the  event  any  component  of the  processing  system experiences  a
mechanical failure.  The emergency procedures  should identify the  amount  of time
expected  to  be available for  corrective   action  and advise the  operator of  any
consequential  problems  which may  result. This  section  of   the   manual  is  the
appropriate place to describe facilities  for improving  reliabilities  such as:

          Standby power
          Standby fuel
          Duplicate process  units
          Alternative sludge management systems
          Availability  of back-up  equipment from  other  sites  or agencies,  or from
          rental agencies.
                                        209

-------
E.9.  SHUTDOWN

The  shutdown procedures  should  include  a  sequence of  operations  for  shutting
down the process. This  is  particularly true for flash drying systems which should
include such data as  maximum safe cooling  rates  for reactors,  expected auxiliary
fuel consumption during cooling.

Manuals for  composting and  bed  and  lagoon drying  systems may  be able  to  omit
separate shutdown instructions  as the shutdown of these  systems  may be indistin-
guishable from normal operation.


E.10.  SAFETY

Detailed  safety  procedures  should  be described  for the processing  system.  Most
safety  requirements  are  those  generally  applicable  to  wastewater  treatment
plants, but  certain additional  safety factors  should be  called  to the operator's
attention.

A flash dryers  flame safety system's purpose, operation and features  should be
called to  the  operator's  attention.  Special instructions  should  be  included for
the safe use of the auxiliary fuel  and associated equipment. Safety rules for the
reactor should be outlined,  including such things as the use  of  air masks within
the reactor  and viewing burning  only  through  smoked glass. Dust  is  a particular
safety and maintenance  problem  for  flash  drying systems.  The process product is a
very  dry,  finely divided, light,  abrasive, combustible  dust.   The  dust  can  be
highly  explosive  and  can  also  cause equipment  failures  due   to its  abrasive
nature. Adequate measures  must  be detailed  in  the manual to insure control of the
dust.

Manuals for  composting  operations  should  include safety rules for the operation
of heavy construction equipment.


E.ll.  IMPACT CONTROL

The manual  must  identify  for the operator  those operating parameters  which are
vital to minimizing deleterious  environmental  impacts.

Environmental impact  control relates primarily to air  quality  control from flash
drying processes and runoff  control from  composting  operations.   Air quality con-
trol can be  enhanced by the  operator  by maintaining  an  adequate  excess air supply
to the dryer furnace, insuring  adequate burning temperatures and detention times,
adequate maintenance  or air pollution control  equipment, and  proper dust control
procedures.  Health impacts of sludge  processing systems include  the safety of the
finished product and  control of  disease vectors  at  the site.   The  safety of the
finished  product  is  to a  large degree,   a function  of the  composition  of  the
sludge  entering  the  process.  The  pathogen  component  can,  however,  be  greatly
affected  by the operation  of  the  process.  Proper   composting  and  flash drying
operation  can  greatly  enhance  product safety.  Disease  vectors   are  potentially
troublesome  in  drying bed,  drying  lagoon and  composting operations  and detailed
measures  for their  control  should  be included in the  operation  and maintenance
manual.
                                        210

-------
Social impacts  such as odors, noise  and  dust are  potential problems  for  sludge
processing systems, and adequate measures  for  their control  should be identified.
Odors are usually minimized  by  proper operation of the process while the  effects
of noise can often  be minimized by scheduling  of  operations.

Dust  is  a  particular problem in flash drying systems and  its  control  is  essen-
tial to successful  operation.


E.12.  PERSONNEL

The  manual  should  outline operating  and  maintenance  personnel requirements  for
the sludge processing system  (See references  71 and 72 for  personnel  requirements
for  composting,  sandbeds and sludge  lagoons). Emphasis  should be  given  to  any
special  qualifications  or   training recommended   by   equipment   manufacturers.
Composting  operations,  for  instance, will require a qualified  heavy  equipment
operator.
                                        211

-------
REFERENCES

-------
                                   REFERENCES
 1.  Process Design  Manual for  Sludge  Treatment and  Disposal EPA-625/1-79-011,
     (September, 1979).

 2.  "Resource Conservation and Recovery Act," P.L. 94-580.

 3.  "Guidance for Preparing Facility Plans,"  EPA Office of Water Program Opera-
     tions, (May, 1975).

 4.  "Federal Water Pollution Control Act Amendments of  1972," P.L. 92-500.

 5.  Metcalf and  Eddy,  Inc., Wastewater  Engineering  -  Collection  Treatment and
     Disposal,  McGraw-Hill, Inc., (1971).

 6.  1968  National  Survey  of   Community  Solid  Waste  Practices,   USEPA,  USPHS,
     (1968).

 7.  Process Design  Manual for  Sludge  Treatment and  Disposal,  EPA-625/1-74-006
     (October,  1974).

 8.  Sommers, L.E.,  "Chemical Composition of Sewage Sludges and Analysis of  Their
     Potential  Use  as  Fertilizers,"  Purdue  University  Agricultural  Experiment
     Station, Journal Paper 6420.

 9.  Standard Methods  for the  Examination  of Water  and  Wastewater,  APHA-AWWA-
     WPCF, 14th Edition, (1975).

10.  Owen,  M.B.,  "Sludge  Incineration,"  Journal  of   the  Sanitary  Engineering
     Division,  Proceedings of the ASCE,  Vol 83, No.  SA-1, (February, 1957).

11.  Liao,  Paul  B. ,  "Fluidized-Bed  Sludge  Incinerator  Design,"  Journal  of the
     Water Pollution Control Federation, Vol. 46, No.  8. pg. 1895C, (1974).

12.  Fair, B.M., and Moore,  E.W.,  "Sewage Sludge Fuel  Value  Related  to Volatile
     Matter," Engineering New-Record,  p. 681, (1935).

13.  Fair,  G.M.,  and   Geyer,  J.C.,  Elements  of  Water  Supply  and  Wastewater
     Disposal.

14.  "Federal Pretreatment Standards",  (40 CFR 128).

15.  Evaluation of Land Application Systems.  EPA-430/9-75-001, (March, 1975).

16.  Transport of Sewage Sludge, EPA-600/2-77-216, (December, 1977).

17.  Knezek, B.D. and Miller, R.H.  (ed.), "Application of Sludges and Wastewaters
     on Agricultural  Land:  A Planning  and  Educational  Guide" Ohio Agricultural
     Research  and  Development  Center,  Wooster,  Ohio,  Research  Bulletin   1090,
     (October, 1970).
                                       213

-------
18.  Brough,  Kerry,  "Some Hot  News About  Sludge,"  Water  & Wastes  Engineering,
     (August, 1977) pp.22-26.

19.  Counts, C.A. and  Shuckrow,  A.J.,  Lime Stabilized Sludge: It's Stability  and
     Effect on Agricultural Land, EPA-670/2-75-012,  (April,  1975).

20.  California   Fertilizer   Association,   Western  Fertilizer   Handbook,   The
     Interstate Printers and Publishers,  Inc., Danielle,  111.,  (1975).

21.  Sommers,  L.E.  et  al,  "Principals  and  Design  Criteria for  Sewage  Sludge
     Application  on Land"  USEPA  Sludge Treatment and Disposal, EPA-625/4-78-012,
     (October, 1978).

22.  Proceeding,  Recycling Municipal Sludges  and Effluents on Land,  USEPA,  USDA,
     National Association  of State  Universities and Land-Grant  Colleges,  (July
     9-13, 1973).

23.  Council  for Agricultural   Science  and  Technology,  Application  of  Sewage
     Sludge to Cropland:  Appraisal of  Potential Hazards of  the  Heavy Metals  to
     Plants and Animals, EPA-430/9-76-013,  (November, 1976).

24.  Weber, B.A.  et al, Land Application  of Treated  Sewage Sludge:  Guidelines  for
     Communities  and  Farm  Operators,  Oregon  State  University Extension  Service,
     Corvallis, Oregon, (February,  1978).

25.  State of  Colorado,  Department of Health, Guidelines for Sludge  Utilization
     on Land, (1976).

26.  Keeney, D.R. et  al,  Guidelines For  the  Application of Wastewater Sludge  To
     Agricultural Land in Wisconsin,  State  of  Wisconsin Department  of  Natural
     Resources, Technical BulletiiT#88, Madison, WI,  (1975).

27.  Life  Sciences  and  Agricultural  Experiment Station,  Maine  Guidelines  For
     Municipal Sewage Treatment  Plant Sludge  Disposal on  the  Land,  Report  No.  175
     University of Maine, Orono,  Maine,  (November, 1975).

28.  Ohio  Agricultural Research and  Development  Center,  Ohio  Guide  for Land
     Application  of Sewage  Sludge,  Ohio  State University,  Columbus,  Ohio,  (May,
     1976).

29.  "Criteria  for  the  Classification of  Solid Waste   Disposal  Facilities  and
     Practices (40 CFR 257), Federal Register. (September 13,  1979).

30.  Knezek, B.D. and  Miller, R.H.  (ed.), Application of Sludges and  Wastewaters
     on Agricultural  Land:   A Planning  and Educational  Guide, MCD-35, reprinted
     by EPA (March, 1978).

31.  Black,  C.A.  ed., Methods  of  Soil  Analysis,  American  Society of Agronomy,
     Inc., Madison, Wise., (1965).
                                       214

-------
32.  Ellis R. , et  al,  "Sampling and Analysis  of  Soils,  Plants, Wastewaters,  and
     Sludge, Suggested Standardization  and  Methodology," Kansas State  Experiment
     Station, Research Publication No.  170, Manhatten, Kansas.

33.  Official  Methods  of  Analysis,  Association  of Official  Analytic  Chemists,
     12th Edition, (1975).

34.  Process Design Manual  for  Municipal Sludge Landfills, EPA-625/1-78-010,  SW-
     705, (October, 1978).

35.  Folks, N.E., "Pyrolysis  as  a  Means of  Sewage Sludge Disposal," ASCE  Journal
     of Environmental Engineering Division, (August  1975).

36.  Lewis,  P.M.,   "Thermodynamic  Fundamentals  for  the  Pyrolysis  of Refuse,"
     Stanford Research Institute,  (May,  1976).

37.  Schultz, Dr. H.W.,  "Energy from Municipal Refuse:  A  Comparison of Ten Pro-
     cesses," Professional Engineer, (November, 1975).

38.  Weinstein, N.J. and Toro, R.F., "Thermal Processing of Municipal Solid Waste
     for Resource and Energy  Recovery," Ann Arbor Science, Michigan,  (1976).

39.  Sieger, R.B., and Bracken, B.D., "Sludge, Garbage May Fuel California Sewage
     Plant," American City and County,  p. 37, (January,  1977).

40.  Energy Conservation  in Municipal Wastewater Treatment,  Gulp,  Wesner, Gulp,
     EPA-430/9-77-011,  Task 9,  (1976).

41.  Sebastian, Frank  P.,  "Fertilizer  Manufactures  - Multiple  Hearth  Incinera-
     tion," Environmental Engineering Handbook, Chilton  Book Co.

42.  Blattler, Paul X., "Wet  Air Oxidation at Levittown," Water and  Sewage Works,
     (February, 1970).

43.  "Background Information  for New Source  Performance  Standards"  (Vol.3), EPA-
     450/2-74-003, APTD-1352C,  (February, 1974).

44.  Balakrishman, S., Williamson, D.E., and Okey, R.W., "State of  the  Art Review
     on  Sludge  Incineration  Practice,"  Federal  Water Quality  Administration
     Report, 17070-DIV 04/70, (1970).

45.  Burd, R.S.,  "A Study  of  Sludge  Handling  and  Disposal,"  Federal Water Pollu-
     tion Control Administration Publication WP-20-4,  (1968).

46.  Jones, J.L., Bomberger,  D.C., Jr., and Lewis, F.M., "The Economics  of Energy
     Usage and Recovery  in Sludge Disposal," presented  at  the  49th WPCF  Confer-
     ence, (October, 1976).

47.  "Amendments to the National Emission Standards" (40CFR61.52).

48.  "Air Pollution  Aspects  of  Sludge  Incineration," Technology  Transfer,  EPA-
     625/4-75-009, (June,  1975).

                                        215

-------
49.  Hathaway, Steven W. ,  and  Olexsey,  Robert A., "Improving Sludge  Incineration
     and  Filtration Requirements  With  Pulverized  Coal"  Journal  of  the  Water
     Pollution Control Federation, p. 2420,  (December,  1977)"^

50.  "User  Acceptance   of  Wastewater  Sludge  Compost," EPA-600/2-096,   (August,
     1977).

51.  Burd, R.S.,  A Study of Sludge Handling and Disposal, Federal Water Pollution
     Control Administration Publication WP-20-4,  (1968).

52.  Bryan, A.C.  and Gannett, M. T. Jr.,  "What  Do  You Do With Sludge? Houston Has
     An Answer,"  Public Works,  p.44, (December, 1972).

53.  "Sludge  Treatment  and  Disposal,  Volume   1,   "EPA-625/4-78-012,   (October
     1978).

54.  Wiley, John S. , "A Discussion of Composting  of  Refuse  With Sewage  Sludge,"
     Presented at   the   1966   APWA  Public  Works Congress,  Chicago,  Illinois,
     (September 13, 1966).

55.  "Cost Effectiveness Guidelines," Federal Register  (40CFR35-Appendix  A).

56.  A Guide  to  the Selection of Cost  Effective Wastewater  Treatment  Systems,
     EPA-430/9-75-002,   (July, 1975).

57.  An Analysis  of Construction Cost Experience  for  Wastewater Treatment  Plants,
     EPA-430/9-76-002,  MCD-22, (February, 1976).

58.  Design  Criteria  for Mechanical,  Electric,  and  Fluid  System  and Component
     Reliability,  EPA-430/99-74-001, (1974).

59.  "Grants  Regulations  and  Procedures   Revision   of  40CFR30,420-6,"   Federal
     Register, (May 8,  1975).

60.  Patterson, Donald J. and Heiner, N.A., Emissions from Combustion Engines and
     Their Control, Ann Arbor Science, (1972).

61.  Sebastian, Frank P.,  Allen,  Terry D.,  and Laughlin, William  C.  Jr.,  "Think
     Thermal," Water and Wastes Engineering, p.47, (September, 1974).

62.  "Uniform Relocation Assistance and Land Acquisition Policies Act of  1970."

63.  "Toxic Substances  Control Act" (P.L. 94-469).

64.  "New  Source   Performance  Standards  for  Sludge   Incinerators"   (40CFR60-15,
     Appendix IV.).

65.  "Clean Water Act"   (P.L. 95-217).

66.  Alternate Waste Management Techniques  for  Best  Practicable  Waste Treatment,
     EPA-430/9-75-014.
                                       216

-------
67.  Sebastian,  Frank  P.,  "Advances  In  Incineration  and  Thermal   Processes,"
     University of California at  Berkeley  Short  Courses on the Theory and Design
     of Advanced Waste Treatment Processes.

68.  Mayrose,  D.P.,   "Fluidized  Bed  Reactor Ease  Problems,"  Water  and Wastes
     Engineering, (October, 1976).

69.  Unterberg, W., Sherwood, R.J.  and  Schnecters,  G.R. , Computerized Design  and
     Cost  Estimation  for  Multiple  Hearth  Incinertors,  EPA  Project  17070  EPB,
     Contract 14-12-547, (July, 1971).

70.  Considerations   for  Preparation   of   Operation   and  Maintenance   Manuals,
     EPA-430/9-74-001, (1974).

71.  Gulp, Gordon L. ,  Handbook  of Sludge Handling  Processes, Garland, New York,
     (1979).

72.  "Estimating  Staffing  for  Municipal Wastewater  Treatment  Facilities,"   EPA
     Contract No. 68-01-0328, (March, 1973).
                                       217

-------

-------
                                   BIBLIOGRAPHY

This Bibliography  is  a  list  of several representative works  on  sludge management
published over  a  five year  period.  It is not comprehensive  as  over  1500  books,
papers, articles and  patents relating to sludge management were  published  during
that period.  An extensive literature review is  published annually  in  the  June
issue  of  the  Journal  of  the  Water  Pollution  Control  Federation.   This  is  an
excellent source of additional  Bibliographic  information  regarding  all aspects of
water  pollution control  including  the  treatment,  utilization   and  disposal  of
wastewater sludges.

Alter,  J.H., "Nu-Earth—Chicago's  Merchandising Program."  Compost Sci.,  16,  3, 22
(1975).

Banerji,  S.K.,  and O'Connor,  J.T.,   "Designing More Energy-Efficient  Wastewater
Treatment Plants." Civil Engr.,  47,  7, 76  (1977).

Banks,   C.F.,   et   al,   "Biological and  Physical  Characterization  of  Activated
Sludge:   A  Comparative  Experimental  Study at Ten  Treatment Plants."  Water  Poll.
Control (C.B.), 75, 492 (1976).

Battelle  Memorial  Institute,  Pacific Northwest Laboratories,  "Municipal  Sewage
Treatment—A Comparison of Alternatives." Kept,  prepared  for Council  on Environ.
Qual.,  Washington,  B.C. (1974).

Benefield,  L.D.,   et  al.,   "Estimating   Sludge  Production  Aids  in  Facilities
Design." Water  & Sew. Works,  122,  8,  52 and  122, 9,  100  (1975).

Bergstedt, D.C., "Energy  Conservation and Recycling Program of   the  Metropolitan
Sewer  Board  of  the   Twin  Cities  Area."  Proc.  Natl.  Conf.  on  Municipal  Sludge
Management,  Information Transfer,  Inc., Washington,  D.C.,  187  (1974).

Berry,   C.R.,  and Marx,  D.H.,  "Growth of Loblolly  Pine  Seedlings  in  Strip-Mined
Kaolin  Spoil  as Influenced  by  Sewage  Sludge." Jour.  Environ.   Quality, 6,  379
(1977).

Black,   S.A.,  "Utilization of Digested Chemical  Sewage  Sludges  on  Agricultural
Lands  In  Ontario." Proc.  Natl.  Conf. on  Municipal Sludge  Management,  Information
Transfer, Inc., Washington,  D.C.  107  (1974).

Bolitho,  V. ,  "Economic Choices in  Sludge  Treatment and  Disposal."  Water  Poll.
Control (G.B.), 72, 195 (1973).

Bonner, R.F.,  Jr., "Thermal  Conditioning  Cuts Energy Load." Water  &  Wastes  Eng.,
13, 11, 47 (1976).

Brooten,  G. , "Public  Acceptance of Wastes as a Resource." Compost.  Sci.,  16,  3,
30 (1975).

Bursztynsky,  T. ,   and Davis,  J.,  "Sludge  Management  Alternatives  for Coastal
Cities."  Proc.  1975  Natl.   Conf.  on  Municipal  Sludge Management  and  Disposal,
Information Transfer, Inc.,  Rockville, Maryland, 65  (1975).

                                       219

-------
Carroll, I.E.,  et  al.,  "Review of Landspreading of Municipal  Sewage Sludge." EPA
Technol. Series, EPA-670/2-75-049, Washington,  D.C.  (1975).

Chatterjee,  S. , "A  Methodology  for  Assessing  Land  Application  of  Sludges  and
Wastewaters." Proc.  Inst. Environ. Sci.,  107  (1977).

"Chicago Reclaiming  Strip Mines with  Sludge." Civil Eng.,  44,  6,  43 (1974).

Cho, P., "A Sludge Cake Incineration  Process  and Pollution Control System."  Water
& Sew. Works, R-76 (1974).

Claydon, M.B.,  et  al. ,   "Disposal  of Municipal Sludges  to Agriculture."  Proc.
Symp.  on Disposal  of Municipal  and  Industrial Sludges and Solid  Toxic  Wastes,
Inst. of Water  Poll. Control,  London,  74  (1973).

Cohen,  B.J.,  et  al. ,  "Sludge Incineration—The  Pragmatic Solution?"  Environ.
Poll. Management,  6,4, 107  (1976).

Council for Agricultural  Science  and  Technology, "Application  of  Sewage Sludge to
Cropland:   Appraisal  of Potential  Hazards  of the  Heavy  Metals  to  Plants  and
Animals." CAST  Report No. 64,  Coucil  for  Agricultural Sci. & Technol., Ames, Iowa
(1976).

Cox, J.L., et al. ,  "Conversion of Organic  Waste to  Fuel Gas." Jour.  Engr., 100,
EE3, 717 (1974).

Dalton, F.E.,  and  Murphy,  R.R.,  "Land Disposal IV:    Reclamation  and Recycle."
Jour. Water Poll Control  Fed., 45, 1489  (1973).

Dean,  R.B.,  "The Meaning of  Ultimate Disposal."  Proc. Natl.  Symp.  on  Ultimate
Disposal of  Wastewaters   and  Their  Residuals,  Water  Resources Res.  Inst.,  North
Carolina State  Univ., Raleigh, 13  (1974).

Dean,  R.D.,  "Disposal and  Reuse of  Sludge  and Sewage—What  are  the Options?"
Compost. Sci.,  14, 5, 12  (1973).

Dicks, R. I.,  "Sludge Handling and Disposal—State  of the  Art." Proc.  Natl. Symp
on  Ultimate  Disposal of  Wastewaters  and Their Residuals,  Water  Resources Res.
Inst., North Carolina State Univ., Raleigh, 127 (1974).

Dicks,  R.I.,  and  Simmons,  D.L.,  "Optimal Integration of  Processes  for  Sludge
Management." Proc.  3rd Natl.  Conf. on  Sludge  Management Disposal  and Utilization,
Information Transfer, Inc., Rockville, Md., 20  (1977).

Diosady, L.L.,   "Recycling  of Incinerator  Ash."  Environment   Canada  Research  &
Report No.  19 (1974); Water Res.  Abs., 8,  23, W 75-11714  (1975.)

Dove,  L.A.  "Total  Wastewater Recycling  and Zero  Discharge  in   St.  Petersburg,
Florida."  In  Energy, Agriculture, and Waste Management,  W. J.  Jewell  [Ed.].  Ann
Arbor Sci.  Publishers, Inc.,  Ann  Arbor, Mich.,  187  (1975).
                                        220

-------
Ehreth,  D.J.,   "Municipal  Sludge  Management:     Problems  and   Research   and
Development." Eval. Current Developments  in  Municipal  Waste  Treatment,  ERDA Symp.
Series CONF 770108, Energy Res.  and  Devel. Admin.,  61  (1977).

Ember, L.R. ,  "Ocean Dumping:  Philadelphia's  Story." Environ.  Sci.  & Technol.,  9,
916 (1975).

Epstein, E.,  and  Wilson,  G.B.,  "Composting  Sewage  Sludge."  Proc.  Natl.  Conf.  on
Municipal  Sludge Management,  Information Transfer,  Inc.,  Washington,   D.C.  123
(1974).

Ettlich, W. F. "Economics  of  Transport Methods  of  Sludge." Proc. 3rd Natl.  Conf.
on  Sludge  Management  Disposal  &   Utilization,  Information   Transfer,   Inc.,
Rockville,  Md.,  (1977).

Ettlich, W.F.,  "Whats's Best  for Sludge Tranport?" Water  &  Wastes  Eng.,  13,  10,
20 (1976).

Ettlich, W.F.,  and Lewis,  A.K.,  "Is  There  a  'Sludge Market1?"  Water   &  Wastes
Eng., 13, 12, 40  (1976).

Farrell,  J.B.,   "Design   Information  of  Dewatering   Properties  of Wastewater
Sludges."  Sludge Handling  and  Disposal  Seminar Conf.  Proc.  No,   2,269  (1974);
Water Res.  Abs.,  8, 23, W75-11722  (1975).

Farrell, J.B.,  "Overview  of  Sludge Handling and  Disposal."  Proc.  Natl.  Conf.  on
Municipal  Sludge Management,   Information  Transfer,   Inc.,  Washington,  D.C. ,  5
(1974).

Garber,  W.F.,  et al.,  "Energy-Wastewater  Treatment and  Solids  Disposal."  Jour.
Environ. Eng. Div., Amer.   Soc.  Civil Engr.,  101,  319  (1975).

Gates,  D.W.,  "Incinerator is  Part  of Integrated Waste Disposal System."  Public
Works, 105, 5,  64 (1974).

Grandt,  A.F., "Use of  Sewage  Sludge  for Land Reclamation—A  Coal Company's  Point
of View."  Proc.  3rd  Natl. Conf.  on  Sludge  Management Disposal  &  Utilization,
Information Transfer,  Inc., Rockville, Md.,  46  (1977).

Hall,  G.W.,  "Public  Relations  Aspects of the  Prairie  Plan:  A  Sewage   Sludge  on
Land Project."  Proc. 3rd Natl.  Conf. on Sludge  Management  Disposal  & Utilization,
Information Transfer,  Inc., Rockville, Md. ,  54  (1977).

Hays,  B. D.,  "Is There a Potential  for Parasitic Disease  Transmission  From Land
Application  of  Sewage  Effluents and  Sludges?" Jour.  Environ.  Health, 39,  424
(1977);  Water Res. Abs., 10, 23, W77-11750 (1977).

Hecht,  N.L.,  et  al,  "Charaterization and Utilization of Municipal and  Utility
Sludges  and Ashes, Summary." EPA Technol.  Series, EPA-670/2-75-033  (1975).
                                        221

-------
Helle, S.C., "Estimating Costs  of  Wastewater  Sludge Disposal." Public Works, 108,
3, 56 (1977).

Hillmer,  T.J.,  Jr.,  "Economics  of Transporting Wastewater  Sludge." Pub.  Works,
108, 9, 110  (1977).

Hinesly, T.D., "Sludge Recycling—The  Most  Reasonable  Choice?" Water Spectrum,  5,
1, 1 (1973).

Hyde, H.C.,  "Utilization of Wastewater Sludge for  Agricultural Soil Enrichment."
Jour. Water  Poll. Control Fed.,  48,  77 (1976).

Jones,  J.L., et  al.,   "Municipal  Sludge  Disposal  Economics."  Environ.  Sci.  &
Technol.,  11, 968 (1977).

Jorgensen,  S.E.,  "Do  Heavy  Metals Prevent  the  Agricultural  Use  of  Minicipal
Sludges." Water Res. (G.B.),  9,  2,  163 (1975).

Kalinske,  A. A.   "All  Cost  Must  be  Counted."  Water  &  Wastes  Eng.,  11,   3,  49
(1974).

Kalinske,  A.A.  et  al.,  "Sludge  Disposal  Alternatives." Water & Sew.  Works 122,
11, 61 (1975).

Kelling,  K.A. ,   et   al. ,   "The   Effect of  Wastewater  Sludge  on  Soil  Moisture
Relationships  and  Surface  Runoff."  Jour.  Water  Poll.  Control  Fed.,  49,  1698
(1977).

Kellogg, C. , "The  Business  of Processing and Marketing Wastes  as  Fertilizer and
Soil Conditioner." Compost Sci.,  16, 3, 25  (1975).

Kirkham, M.B., "Disposal  of  Sludge on Land:   Effect on Soil,  Plants,  and  Ground
Water." Compost Sci., 15, 2,  6  (1974).

Kirkham,  M.B. ,  and  Dotson,   G.K.,  "Growth of  Barley  Irrigated With  Wastewater
Sludge Containing Phosphate  Precipitants."  Proc.  Natl. Conf.  on  Municipal  Sludge
Management,  Information Transfer,  Inc., Washington,  D.C.,  97  (1974).

Knapp,  I.M., "City  Reaps  Income  from Sludge Processing  System." Public  Works,
108, 10, 103 (1977).

Kostolich,  M.S.,  "Hauling Digested  Sludge  in  Tank Cars." Proc.  Natl. Symp.  on
Ultimate Disposal of Wastewaters  and Their  Residuals,  Water Resources Res.  Inst.,
North Carolina State Univ., Raleigh, 178  (1974).

"Land as a Waste Management Alternative." R.C.  Lehr  [Ed.],  Ann Arbor  Publ.,  Inc.,
Ann Arbor, Mich. (1977).

Larger, D.,  "Sludge Drying and  Incineration." Prog.  Water  Tech.,  7, 161 (1975).

Lund, E.,  "Disposal of Sludges."  Viruses  in Water,  Amer. Pub.  Health  Assn.,  Inc.,
Washington,  D.C., 196 (1976).

                                        222

-------
Lund, L.J., et al.,  "Nitrogen  &  Phosphorus  Levels  in Soil Beneath Sewage Disposal
Ponds." Jour. Environmental  Quality,  5,  1,  26  (1976).

Lynam, B.T.,  et  al., "Automation  of  Sludge Processing,  Transport  and  Disposal."
In Research Needs  for Automation  of  Wastewater  Treatment Systems, H. 0.  Buhr,  et
al.  [Eds.], Clemson  Univ., Clemson, S.C., 70  (1975).

Hears, D.R.,  et  al.,  "Thermal and Physical  Properties  of  Compost."  In  Energy,
Agriculture,  and Waste  Management, W.J.  Jewell  [Ed.], Ann Arbor  Sci.  Publishers,
Inc., Ann Arbor,  Mich.,  515  (1975).

Miller,  R.H., "Microbiology  of  Sewage   Sludge  Disposal  in  Soil."  Natl.  Tech.
Inform. Serv., Springfield,  Va., PB-237  817 (1974).

Miller,  S.S., "Sludges: There  are  Options."  Environ.   Sci.  &  Tech.,  9,  613
(1975).

Moore, B.E.,  et  al. ,  "An  Assessment   of  Potential Health  Risks  Associated  with
Land Disposal of  Residual Sludges."  Proc.  3rd Natl.  Conf.  on Sludge  Management
Disposal and Utilization, Information Tranfer, Inc.,  Rockville, Md.  108 (1977).

Municipality  of  Metropolitan  Seattle,  "Park  Development   with  Wet  Digested
Sludge." EPA Report, EPA-R2-73-143  (1973).

Municipal  Sludge   Management." Proc.   Natl. Conf.  Municipal  Sludge   Management,
Information Transfer, Inc.,  Washington,  D.C.  (1974).

National Academy of  Sciences,  "Multimedium  Management  of  Municipal  Sludge, " Vol.
IX of Analytical Studies for the U.S.  Environmental  Protection Agency,  Commission
on Natural  Resources, National  Research Council,  National  Academy of  Sciences,
Washington, D.C.  (1977).

Niessen, W. ,  et al.,  "  A Review of Techniques for Incineration of Sewage Sludge
with  Solid Wastes." U.S.  Environmental  Protection  Agency,   Cincinnati,  Ohio,
Environ.  Protect.   Technol. Series  EPA-600/2-76-288  (1976).

O'Donnell,  J.M.,  "Successful Sewage  Sludge Recycling Through  Enrichment."  Proc.
3rd  Natl.  Conf.   on  Sludge  Management   Disposal   & Utilization,   Information
Transfer, Inc.,  Rockville, Md.,  84  (1977).

Parker,  D.S.,  et   al.,   "Sludge   Processing  for   Combined   Physical-Chemical-
Biological  Sludges."  Environ.  Protection Technol.   Ser.,   EPA-R2-73,250,   EPA
(1973).

Patterson,  J.C.,   "Enrichment   of   Urban Soil  with  Composted  Sludge  and  Leaf
Mold—Constitution Gardens." Compost  Sci.,  16, 18  (1975).

Ruf,  J.A.,  and  Brown,  H.T.,  "Generation  of Electrical Energy  from  Municipal
Refuse and Sewage  Sludge." Pub. Works, 108,  1, 38  (1977).

Schmitt,   C.R.,    and   Hall,   J.E.,   "Analytical   Characterization   of   Water
Treatment-Plant Sludge." Jour. Amer.  Water  Works Assn., 67,  40 (1975).

                                       223

-------
Schwing, J.E.,  and  Puntenney,  J.L.,  " Denver Plan."  Water & Wastes  Eng.,  11,  9,
24 (1974).

Sebastian,  P.P.,  "Modern Technology Battles  Ancient  Traditions." Water  &  Wastes
Eng., 10, 2, 20  (1973).

Seitz,  W.D.,  "Strip-Mined  Land  Reclamation with   Sewage  Sludge:  An  Economic
Simulation." Amer.  Jour.  Agr.  Econ., 56,  799  (1974);  Water  Res.  Abs.,  8,  18,
W75-09236 (1975).

Shilesky,  D.M.,  and  Wyatt,  J.M.,  "Combustion  Processing  of  Sludge—Potential
Health  and  Nuisance Considerations." Proc.  3rd  Natl. Conf. on  Sludge Management
Disposal & Utilization,  Information  Transfer,  Inc., Rockville,  Md.,  154 (1977).

Silvester,  O.K.,  and  Lewis, K. ,  "The  Ultimate  Disposal  of Sludge."  Pub.  Health
Eng., 4, 153 (1976).

Singley,  M.E.,  "Bridgeton,   N.J.    Sludge  Composting   Project—A   City-Farm
Relationship."  Compost Sci., 14,  5,  18 (1973).

Slvinski,  H.D.,  "Overview of  the  ERDA/EPA Program  in  Treatment  of  Municipal
Sludge." Evaluation of  Current  Developments in Municipal  Waste Treatment,  ERDA
Symp. Series CONF 770108,  Energy  Research  &  Development  Admin., 15  (1977).

Smith,  E.M., and  Daly, A.R.,  "The Past,  Present, and Future Prospects of Burning
Municipal  Sewage Sludge Along  with Mixed  Municipal Refuse."  Proc.   1975  Natl.
Conf. on  Municipal  Sludge  Management  and Disposal,  Information Transfer,  Inc.,
Rockville, Maryland (1975).

Smith,  J.E.,   "Inventory  of  Energy  Use  in  Wastewater  Sludge  Treatment  and
Disposal."  Ind. Water Eng.,  14,  4, 20  (1977).

Smith,  J.E., and  Farrell, J.B., "Sludge Disposal  Practices: How Safe  Are  They?"
Water & Wastes  Eng., 10,  12, 39  (1973).

Smith,  J.L., and Houck,  C.P.,  "Subsurface  Injection  Solves  Sludge  Problems."
Water & Wastes  Eng., 13,  9,  46  (1976).

Smith,  R. ,  and  Eilers, R. G., "Computer Evaluation  of  Sludge Handling and Disposal
Costs."  Proc.   1975 Natl.  Conf.  on Municipal  Sludge  Management  and  Disposal,
Information  Transfer, Inc.,  Rockville, Maryland, 30  (1975).

Sobsey, M.D.,  et  al.,  "Virus Removal and Inactivation by  Physical-Chemical Waste
Treatment."  Jour. Environ.  Eng.  Div.,  Proc.  Amer.  Soc. Civil Engr.,  99,  EE3,  245
(1973).

"Soils  for  Management  of Organic  Wastes and Wastewaters." L.F. Elliott  and  F. T.
Stevenson  [Eds.],  Soil  Sci.  Soc. Amer.,  Amer.  Soc.  Agron.,   Crop  Sci.  Soc.  of
Amer., Madison, Wis. (1977).
                                        224

-------
Solid  Waste Management  Committee  Environ.  Eng.Div.,  "Sanitary Landfill."  ASCE
Manuals and Reports on Eng.  Practice No.39,  Amer.  Soc. Civil Eng.,  New York City
(1976).

Sopper,  W.E.,   and  Kardos,  L.T.,  "Recycling  Treated Municipal  Wastewater  and
Sludge  Through  Forest  and   Cropland,"   The   Pennsylvania   State   Univ.   Press,
University Park  (1973).

Stern,  G. ,  "Processing,  Economics,  and Sale  of  Heat  Dried  Sludge."  Proc.  1975
Natl.  Conf.  on Municipal  Sludge Management and Disposal, Information Transfer,
Inc., Rockville, Maryland, 235  (1976).

Stone, R. , "Landfill Disposal  of Liquid Sewage Sludge." Jour.  Environ.  Eng.  Div.,
Amer.  Soc. Civil Engr.,  101, 91  (1975).

Strain, R.E., "Kansas Treatment  Plant Uses Subsurface  Injection  of  Sludge."  Water
& Sew. Works, 124, 11, 42  (1977).

Sussman, D.B., "Co-Disposal For  Solid Wastes  and Sewage Sludge." Waste  Age,  8,  7,
44 (1977); Water Res. Abs.,  10,  24,  W77-12426  (1977).

Taflin, C.O. ,  and  Weber, N.F.,  "Minneapolis  Keeps  on Truckin'."  Water &  Wastes
Eng.,  12, 5, 24  (1975).

Takeda, N. ,  and  Hiraoka, M.  ,  "Combined Process of  Pyrolysis  and  Combustion  for
Sludge Disposal." Environ. Sci.  &  Technol., 10,  1147 (1976).

Task  Force  on Land  Application of  Sewage Sludge,  "Land Application  of  Sewage
Sludge." Bulletin 598, Cooperative Extension  Service,  Ohio State Univ., Columbus,
Ohio  (1975).

United  States  Environmental  Protection  Agency,  "Municipal  Sludge Management:
Environmental  Factors."  Municipal  Construction  Div., Office   of  Water  Program
Operations,   U.S.   Environmental   Protection  Agency,   Washington,   D.C.,   EPA
430/9-77-004 (1977).

Vesilind, P.A.,  "Treatment and Disposal of Wastewater  Sludges."  Ann Arbor  Science
Publishers,  Ann Arbor, Mich. (1974).

Wadehra, P.K.,  and Adelman,  M. , "Phosphorus  Leaching  from Sewage  Sludge Used  as
Landfill." Water Poll.  Res.  (Can.), 8, 202  (1973);  chem. Abs., 84, 22,  155287g
(1976).

Walker,  J.M.,  "Trench  Incorporation   of  Sewage  Sludge." Proc Natl.  Conf.  on
Municipal Sludge Management,  Information Transfer,  Inc.,  Washington,  D. C. ,  139
(1974).

Walker, W. R.,  and  Cox, W.E.,  "Health  and Nuisance  Considerations: The Basis  of
Legal  Constraints  in  Sludge  Management."  Proc. of the 3rd Natl. Conf.  on  Sludge
Management Disposal and  Utilization, Information Transfer, Inc., Rockville,  Md. ,
104  (1977).
                                        225

-------
Waller,  R. ,  "Impact of  Sewage  Treatment  and  Operations  on  Sludge Handling  and
Disposal." Proc.  3rd Natl. Conf.  on  Sludge Management Disposal  and Utilization,
Information Transfer, Inc., Rockville, Md. ,  3-6  (1977).

Weinstein, N.J.,  and Rai,  C. ,  "Pyrolysis/State  of  the  Art."  Pub.  Works,  106,  4,
83 (1975).

Weismantel, G.E.,  "Sludge Pyrolysis  Schemes Now Head  for Tryouts." Chem.  Eng.,
82, 26, 90 (1975).

Wilson,  G.R.,  "Impact  of  Land  Disposal  of  Sludges on  Groundwater."  Proc.  1975
Natl.  Conf. on Municipal  Sludge  Management and  Disposal, Information  Transfer,
Inc., Rockville, Md., 193  (1975).

Wyatt,  J.M.,   and  White,  P.E.,   Jr.,   "Sludge   Processing  Transportation,  and
Disposal/Resource Recovery: A Planning Perspective." Report Submitted  to the U.S.
Environmental  Protection Agency, Washington, D.C.,  189  pp (1976).
                                        226

-------
APPENDICES

-------
                                    APPENDIX A

                       DESIGN  OF  LAND  APPLICATION SYSTEMS
                  FOR  AGRICULTURAL  UTILIZATION OF SEWAGE SLUDGE
INTRODUCTION

Utilization of  sludge  as  a soil amendment  can  be very beneficial  to  crop growth
or, if mismanaged,  can have disastrous results.  Benefits  include the addition of
nitrogen,  phosphorus,  and organic matter.  Nitrogen and phosphorus  are necessary
plant  nutrients.  Organic  matter  improves  drainage  of clay  soils  and  moisture
holding  capacities   of  sandy  soils.  Tillage  characteristics  of soils  are  also
improved.  Generally,   the   soil   conditioning   properties  of   sludge  are  more
significant  than the  nutrient  additions.  Mismanagement  of  a  land  application
system  can  result  in  public  health  problems,  odor  nuisances,  and/or  soil
destruction from excessive  heavy metal  buildup.  A land application system must be
designed  to  provide maximum benefits  from  the sludge  without  creating problems.
The design  should  therefore include  rate  determination schedules  and  methods to
be used  by operators.   Monitoring  requirements should  also  be  specified  to  help
prevent  nuisance  conditions  from  developing.  This appendix  has  been developed
with  emphasis  on  the  agricultural  management   aspects  rather  than  the  public
health.

Sludge Analysis

Prior to  applying sludge  to  cropland,  the  following tests  should be run:

                                 Sludge Analyses

                            Nitrogen  content and  forms
                                 Organic nitrogen
                                 Ammonia
                                 Nitrates
                            Phosphorus
                            Potassium
                            Heavy metals
                                 Cadmium
                                 Lead
                                 Copper
                                 Zinc
                                 Nickel
                            Percent  solids
                            Tests required  by  local health  agencies

These tests should  be  run monthly for  three  to  six months  prior to  starting the
land  application  system so  that averages  can be  computed.  After  the  system has
begun  operation,  annual  monitoring  should  be   continued   so   that   changes  in
constituent levels can  be detected and  application rates adjusted.
                                       A-l

-------
Site Preparation

Prior to applying  sludge  to  a particular site, the  soil  should be tested for  pH,
cation exchange  capacity,  and phosporus and  potassium  availability.  The existing
crops grown  should be reviewed  for  adaptability  to  sludge amended  soils.  If an
unacceptable crop  is  being grown (e.g.,  a raw vegetable), then another crop would
be  required.   Crop selection  would  have  to  be  consistent  with local  farming
practices and  locally marketable.

Futher site preparation can  then be  done after a  crop  or crops have  been chosen.
Site  work  includes  drainage  control,  monitoring  wells,  pH  adjustment  by  lime
addition (if necessary),  and field preparation fot  eh  crop to be grown. Drainage
control  is  essential  for  good  agricultural  practice  as  well  as protection of
downstream water  quality.  In general,  natural  drainage  courses should  be  left
undisturbed. If  a  drainage course passes  through  a site,  field  runoff should be
diverted but the drainage  course left in place.  Runoff from adjacent areas  should
be diverted around the land  application  site.

Monitoring wells  should be  placed throughout  the site.  Depth  of well  would be
based on ground  water  location.  Location of  well  is  usually based on  site  layout
and groundwater  flow  direction.  Diameters should be large enought to provide  easy
sampling.

pH adjustment  is  necessary  for  those  soils with pH values  less than  6.5.   The
adjustment is  usually accomplished by lime  addition.

Field preparation  is  the  tillage required for crop planting.  If sludge is surface
spread,  then field preparation will  usually follow immediately so that the  sludge
is tilled into the soil.

Application Rate Calculation

The  application   rate  calculation   is  usually   based   mainly  on   the  nitrogen
requirements of  the  crop  to  be  grown.   The  computed  rate  is then  adjusted, if
necessary,   to  prevent   excessive   heavy   metal   or    phosphorus   buildups.  A
step-by-step procedure follows:

Step 1 Determine Application Rate by  Nitrogen Balance

     a.  Analyze  sludge  nitrogen content.  Determine  organic  nitrogen,  ammoniun
         nitrogen  and  nitrate nitrogen (if aerobically digested) concentrations.
         Typical  nutrient contents   for  anaerobic  sewage  sludges  are  shown on
         Table A-l.

         For this  example,  assume the organic nitrogen  is 80  Ib/ton  and ammoniun
         nitrogen  is  30 Ib/ton.

     b.  Determine nitrogen  requirement  of  the  crop  from Table  A-2.  For  this
         example  assume  corn is  grown   (  expected  yield  of  180 bu/acre).   The
         nitrogen  requirment  is  240 Ib/ac.
                                       A-2

-------
     TABLE A-l.  COMPOSITION OF REPRESENTATIVE ANAEROBIC SEWAGE SLUDGES (8)
    Component
                  Range
                 Lb/ton**
Organic nitrogen
Ammonium nitrogen
Total phosphorus
Total potassium
1% -
1% -
1.5% -
0.27% -
5%
3%
3%
0.8%
20 -
20 -
30 -
4 -
100
60
60
16
*Percent of oven-dry solids
**Lb/ton dry sludge

       TABLE A-2.  ANNUAL NITROGEN,  PHOSPHORUS,  AND POTASSIUM UTILIZATION
                   BY SELECTED  CROPS*
                                  Nitrogen
     Crop
Yield
 Phosphorus
Lbs. per Acre
                                              Potassium
Corn

Corn silage
Soybeans

Grain sorghum
Wheat

Oats
Barley
Alfalfa
Orchard grass
Brome grass
Tall fescue
Bluegrass
150 bu
180 bu
32 tons
50 bu
60 bu
8,000 Ib
60 bu
80 bu
100 bu
100 bu
8 tons
6 tons
5 tons
3.5 tons
3 tons
185
240
200
257
336
250
125
186
150
150
450
300
166
135
200
35
44
35
21
29
40
22
24
24
24
35
44
29
29
24
178
199
203
100
120
166
91
134
125
125
398
311
211
154
149
* Note that this hypothetical  illustrated  case  does  not agree with Table 8
  values.  Values will  vary  with  yield  and regional  crop practices.

     c.  Determine  the  amount of nitrogen available from mineralization  of pre-
         viously  applied organic nitrogen and  the amount that  will  be available
         from  present  application.   Crops utilize  nitrogen  when it  is  in the
         ammonium  or nitrate  forms.  Organic  nitrogen  must  be  converted  to the
         ammonium ion before it  can  be  utilized  by the  plant.  The conversion or
         mineralization rate  varies  with  climate  and  soil  type, but  a  typical
         mineralization rate would  be 20 percent  the  first  year and  3 percent of
         the  remaining  organic   nitrogen   each  year  for subsequent   years.  The
         release  rates  of nitrogen  by  this  process are  shown  on Table  A-3 for
         different  sludges.
                                       A-3

-------
  TABLE A-3.  RELEASE OF RESIDUAL NITROGEN  DURING SLUDGE DECOMPOSITION IN SOIL

         Year after                	Organic N content of sludge, %	
     sludge application	2.0   2.5    3.0   3.5   4.0   4.5   5.0
                                   	Lb.  N  Released per Ton or Sludge Added
1
2
3
1.0
0.9
0.9
1.2
1.2
1.1
1.4
1.4
1.3
1.7
1.6
1.5
1.9
1.8
1.7
2.2
2.1
2.0
2.4
2.3
2.2
         The  example  sludge has 80  Ib/ton organic  nitrogen.  Assume  this  is  the
         fourth  year  of land  application. The  previous  applications were  at  10
         tons/acre with  sludge having an 80 Ib/ton  or 4  percent  organic nitrogen
         content. The amount of available  nitrogen  is  computed as follows:

         Previous Year:  1.9(10) +  1.8(10) =  1.7(10) = 54 Ib/acre
         This Year:  30  Ib/ton + 80  Ib/ton x  .20(%  available)  = 46 Ib/ton

     d.  Compute Application Rate
         Nitrogen Required - Nitrogen Available  = Nitrogen to  be  applied
              240 Ib/acre - 54 Ib/acre =  186  Ib/acre
         Tons sludge required:   186  Ib/acre t  46 Ib/ton = 4 tons/acre

Step 2 Check Metals Accumulation

The  maximum  tolerable   heavy  metals  accumulations  depend  on  the   soil  cation
exchange capacity  (CEC). These maximuras are  shown  on Table A-4.  These  are  valid
as  long  as the soil pH  is  maintained  greater than 6.5.   At lower pH values  the
metals are  taken up by  the  crops, resulting in plant damage or possible  injury to
crop  consumers.  The metals  concentrations are  cumulative so  previous  additions
must be  considered.  Table  A-5 shows  heavy metal concentrations  assumed  for this
example.

	TABLE A-4. TOTAL AMOUNT  OF SLUDGE  METALS ALLOWED ON AGRICULTURE LAND	

                            Soil cation exchange  capacity  (Meq/100 g )	
Metal	       0-5                   5-15	15	
                         	Maximum  amount of metal (Ib/acre)	

Pb                       500                   1,000                  2,000
Zn                       250                     500                  1,000
Cu                       125                     250                    500
Ni                        50                     100                    200
Cd                          5                      10                     20

Determined  by the pH 7 ammonium acetate  procedure
                                       A-4

-------
                 Table A-5.  EXAMPLE HEAVY  METAL  CONCENTRATIONS
                                   Concentration
Metal
                                                             Ib/ton
Pb
Zn
Cu
Ni
Cd
500
750
1,000
500
75
1.0
1.5
2.0
1.0
0.15
The cumulative metal additions are shown  on  Table  A-6.

                      TABLE A-6.  METALS  ADDITIONS (Ib/acre)
Metal
Year 1
Year 2
Year 3
This Year
Total
Pb
Zn
Cu
Ni
Cd
10 (1.0)
10(1.5)
10(2.0)
10(1.0)
10(0.15)
10(1.0)
10(1.5)
10(2.)
10(1.0)
10(0.15)
10(1.0)
10(1.5)
10(2.0
10(1.0)
10(0.15
4(1.0)
4(1.5)
4(2.0)
4(1.0)
4(0.15)
34
51
68
34
5.1
^tons/acre of dry sludge
 Ib/ton of dry sludge

The  totals  in the last column  of Table 6  are then  compared  with  the  values  in
Table  4.  For this  example  the tons/acre  application rate  results  in  a  cadmium
total  addition greater  than 5 Ib/ac.  If  the  cation exchange capacity is less than
5 meq/100 grains,  the  safe cadmium level has  been exceeded. The  application rate
would  then  be  lowered   for  this  year  and   no   futher  application  allowed  in
subsequent  years. The  allowable   cadmium  concentration  is 5  Ib/acre.  Previous
applications  resulted  in  4.5  Ib/acre.   The  allowable   application   rate  is
determined as follows:  5 lb/ac-4.5 Ib/ac =  3.33  tons/acre
                                .15 Ib/ton
The  nitrogen  balance  would  be  recalculated  and  supplemental nitrogen added or a
decreased yield accepted.

For  this  example assume  the CEC is  greater than  5 so  sludge   application can
continue.
                                       A-5

-------
Step 3 Determine Supplemental Nutrient  Requirements

Phosphorus  and  potassium  balances  are  checked.   For   this  example,  assume  a
phosphorus  content  of 40 Ib/ton  and  a potassium for  corn growth are 44  and 199
Ib/ac/yr, respectively.  At  10  tons/acre for three  years,  the  phosphorus addition
has been 1,200 Ib/ac  with only  132  Ib/ac being  utilized.  Therefore,  no additional
phosphorus  is required.

Potassium additions  have been  100  Ib/ac/yr  at the  10  ton/ac  application  rate,
while crop  requirements  have been 199 Ib/ac/yr. At  the 4  ton/ac  application rate,
the potassium added  is  40  Ib/ac.  Therefore, 159 Ib/ac  supplemental  potassium (or
potash) is  required.

Step 4 Determine Wet  Application  Rate

All calculations  above  were based  on  a sludge  dry  weight.  The  operator  will  be
applying sludge with  varying concentrations  of  water.  For subsurface injection or
spray systems, the  liquid  sludge  will  generally be less   than 10  percent  solids.
The dry weight used above of 4  tons/acre  is  40  wet  tons/ac or  9,592  gal/ac.

Assuming a  spreading width  of  9  feet  and an  application flow  of  800 gpm,  the
necessary application vehicle speed is  calculated as follows:

                         9,592  gal/ac x 9  feet  = 1.98 gal/ft
                         43,560 sq  ft/ac


                             800  gpm x  60  min/hr     = 4.59 raph
                         1.98 gal/ft x  5,280  ft/mile

or developing  a  conversion factor  for  this  equipment, the  speed is  computed  as
follows:

                         800 x  60 x 43,560 = 44,000 (conversion  factor)
                          9 x 5,280


                             1      x (44,000) = 4.59 mpg
                           9,592

Once the  equipment  has   been  selected,  the  appropriate  conversion  factor  can  be
computed by the approach shown  above.

SUMMARY

Essentially,  as  shown by  the  preceding example,  the correct  sludge  application
rate depends  on  the  constituent  concentration  of  the sludge and  the  composition
of the  soil receiving the sludge.  A  sludge application  rate  may be safe at  one
site but hazardous  at another  site. The  preceding   information was  developed  for
agricultural purposes only. Local health officials  and  regulatory agencies should
be contacted for pretreatment requirements and  application technique restraints.


                                      A-6

-------
                                   APPENDIX  B

                                 LANDFILL DESIGN


SLUDGE-ONLY LANDFILL AT A PRESELECTED  SITE

TREATMENT PLANT CHARACTERISTICS

•     Service Population = 150,000.

•     Average Flow = 15 mgd.

•     Liquid processes include preliminary  screening  and  grit  removal  and  primary
      treatment  followed  by  activated  sludge,  secondary   sedimentation   and
      chlorination.

•     Solids processes  include gravity  thickening,  mixing, anaerobic  digestion,
      and vacuum filtration.

SLUDGE CHARACTERISTICS
•     Solids content is 20 percent.

•     Quantity on a dry weight basis =  10  ton/day.

•     Quantity on a wet weight basis =  50  ton/day.

•     Density                        =  1700  Ib/cu  yd

0     Quantity on a wet volume basis =

                 50 ton/day x 2000 Ib/ton  =  58.8 cu  yd/day
                    1700 Ib/cu yd

CLIMATE FACTORS

•     Precipitation                                     = 30 in/yr

•     Evaporation                                       = 25 in/yr

•     Number of  days min temperature freezing  or  below = 55 days

•     Precipitation exceeds evaporation by 5 in/yr

SITE

•     Size  of  property = 280 ac.

•     Uniform  slope of approximately 5  percent.

•     Site  currently covered with native grasses.

                                      B-l

-------
•     No surface  water  on  site.

•     Groundwater at  a  depth  of  12  ft;  soil moderate to slow permeability.

EVALUATION

•     From  the  characteristics listed  in Table  12,  the narrow  trench method  is
      suitable.

•     From  the  design criteria listed  in Table 13, the trench width  should  be  2-3
      ft and  the  final cover  3-4  ft.  There  is  no bulking  agent  required and  no
      important soil. The  application  rate should be 1,200  to 5,600  cu yd/acre.

DESIGN FEATURES

•     Excavation  - allow 4 ft  separation between  trench  bottom and  groundwater;
      therefore,  excavation will  be 8  ft.

•     Spacing - for  stable soil,  allow 1 ft  for each foot  of  depth; therefore,
      spacing between trenches will be 8 ft.

•     Width - trench  width should  be 2 ft (dug with backhoe).

•     Length -  trench length  to prevent  solids  flow to one  end  of  trench  is  200
      ft; 5 ft  should be provided  between trenches for containment.

•     Orientation -  trenches  should be  parallel  to each other.

•     Fill  depth  -  because  of  the depth  of  the  trench,  sludge should  not  ho
      filled closer  than 1.5  ft  to  top of  trench;  therefore, depth  is 6.5  ft  and
      the usual range is 1  to  2  ft.

•     Cover  thickness - cover should  be 3 ft  because  of  the depth  of fill;  the
      usual range is  2  to  3 ft.

SITE DEVELOPMENT

•     The site  should be  divided  into  fill  areas  depending on  the  shape of  the
      area. A wet weather  fill area near  the  entrance  to  the site should be  pro-
      vided  with   a   paved  access   road.  Adequate  buffer  around   the  site   would
      include  trees  and a chain  link  fence.   Access  to the  fill  areas should  be
      gravel roads  leading from  the paved wet weather  access road.  About 50  per-
      cent  of the site  is  actually  usable fill area.

TRENCH UTILIZATION RATE

•     Trench Utilization Rate  = 	sludge volume/day	
                                 cross-sectional area of sludge in  trench

                               =  58.8 cu yd/day x 27 cu ft/cu yd =  122  ft/day
                                           6.5 ft x 2 ft
                                       B-2

-------
Sludge Application Rate
sludge application rate = cross-section area of sludge in  trench
                                   width of trench +  spacing

                        = 6.5 ft x 25 = 13 sq ft  or 13 cu  ft
                          2 ft + 8 ft    10 ft      10 sq  ft

                        = 13 cu ft x 1 cu yd/27 cu ft =  2097 cu yd/ac
                          10 sq ft x 1 ac/43,560  sq ft

Land Utilization Rate
land utilization rate   = sludge volume/day	
                          sludge application rate

                        = 58.8 cu yd/day = 0.028  ac/day
                          22097 cu yd/ac

Site Life
site life               = usable fill area
                        land utilization rate

                        = .5 x 280 acres = 5000 days  =  13.7 yr
                            0.028 ac/day   365 days/yr
                                 B-3

-------
                                APPENDIX C

          EXAMPLE COMBUSTION MASS AND ENERGY BALANCE CALCULATION

This example is based on a methodology presented in a paper  in the  Proceed-
ings of the American Society of Civil Engineers, Journal of  the Sanitary
Engineering Division, by Mark B. Owen entitled "Sludge Incineration".  (10)

This example is for a multiple hearth furnace with no energy recovery.

Sludge Feed

     2500 Ib/day liquid sludge
     80% moisture content
     60% of solids are combustible
     Chemical analysis of combustible solids:
           C - 59.8%, H - 8.5%, O - 27.5%
           N - 4.2%,  £• - negligible

Heat Content of Combustible Solids

     Q = 14,600C + 62,000 (H = |-)
           Q = heat value, Btu/lb
           C = fraction of carbon in fuel (sludge)
           H = fraction of hydrogen in fuel
           O = fraction of oxygen in fuel

     Q = 14,600 (0.598) + 62,000 (0.085 - °'^75)
       = 11,870 Btu/lb

     Note:  Use actual calorimeter test results whenever possible.

Auxiliary Fuel

     Fuel oil with a chemical analysis:
           C - 85%,  H - 12%, S - 1.5%, Ash - 1.5%
     Heat content:  148,000 Btu/gal or 19,000 Btu/lb

Specific Heats
C02
H2°
H2O
N2
so2
Air
Ash

(vapor)
(liquid)




Latent Heat of Water
0.244
0.472
1.00
0.256
0.174
0.250
0.20
Btu/lb/F
Btu/lb/F
Btu/lb/F
Btu/lb/F
Btu/lb/F
Btu/lb/F
Btu/lb/F
Vaporization (1
0
O
O
0
0
O
O
atm, 212°F
     970 Btu/lb

Incinerator Operating Conditions
     Inlet temperature of all inputs - 60°F
     Outlet temperature of stack gas - 900°F
     Outlet temperature of ash       - 700°F
     Excess air                      - 50%
                                    C-l

-------
Dry Solids in Sludge

     M(sludge solids) = 2500 Ib/day  (1-0.80)
                      = 500 Ib/day

Moisture in Sludge

     M(sludge moisture) = 2500 Ib/day  (0.80)
                        = 2000 Ib/day

Combustibles in Sludge

     M(sludge combustibles) = 500 Ib/day  (0.60)
                            =300 Ib/day

Ash Generated by Sludge

     M(sludge ash) = 500 Ib/day  (1-0.60)
                   = 200 Ib/day

Sludge Heat of Combustion

     H(sludge) = 300 Ib/day (11,870 Btu/lb)
               = 3,561,000 Btu/day

Sludge Combustion Reactions

     C + O2 = CO2
    2H + 02 = 2H20
         2N = N2
     M(C in sludge) = 300 Ib/day  (0.598)
                    =179 Ib/day
     M(H in sludge) = 300 Ib/day  (0.085)
                    =25.5 Ib/day
     M(0 in sludge) = 300 Ib/day  (0.275)
                    =82.5 Ib/day
     M(N in sludge) = 300 Ib/day  (0.042)
                    =12.6 Ib/day

     M«C02 produce,, - 179 lb/day
                    =658 Ib/day

     M,H20 produced 25.5 lb/aay
                    = 229.5 Ib/day
     M(N2 produced) =12.6 Ib/day
                      ,_„ ,,  ,.,    ,32 mol. wt. O9.    __  _  ,, .,    ,32  mol.  wt.  O?
     M(02 required) = 179 Ib/day  (^ ^ ^ c?) +  25.5  Ib/day  (2(2mol.  wt.
                      - 82.5 Ib/day
                    =599 Ib/day

Air Requirements  (w/o auxiliary fuel)
                   .  ,          599 Ib/day O?
     M (combustion air)        = 	    	^
                              = 2604 Ib/day
     M(excess air)            = 2604 Ib/day  (0.50 excess)
                              = 1302 Ib/day

                                    C-2

-------
Air Requirements (w/o auxiliary fuel) cont.
     M(air supplied)          = 2604 Ib/day + 1302 Ib/day
                              = 3906 Ib/day
     M(N2 in combustion air)  = (2604 Ib/day - 599 Ib/day)
                              = 2005 Ib/day

Moisture in Outlet

     M(H20 in outlet) = 2000 Ib/day + 230 Ib/day
                      =2230 Ib/day

Latent and Sensible Heat of Free Moisture

     H(Free H2O) = 2000 Ib/day  ((212°F - 60°F) (1.0 Btu/lb/F°)  +  (970  Btu/lb)
                   +  (900°F - 212°F) (0.472 Btu/lb/F°))
                 = 2,893,500 Btu/day

Latent and Sensible Heat of Combustion Products of Sludge
     H(H20 produced) = 230 Ib/day  ((212°F - 60°F)  (1.0 Btu/lb/F°) +  970 Btu/lb
                       + (900°F - 212°F) (0.472 Btu/lb/F0))
                     = 332,700 Btu/day
     H(C02 produced) = 658 Ib/day  (0.244 Btu/lb/F0)  (900°F - 60°F)
                     = 134,900 Btu/day
     H(N2 produced)  = 12.6 Ib/day  (0.256 Btu/lb/F0)  (900°F - 60°F)
                     = 2,700 Btu/day
     H (sludge combus-
     tion products)  = 69,400

Sensible Heat of Excess Air and Nitrogen

     H(excess air)            = 1302 Ib/day  (900°F - 60°F)(0.250 Btu/lb/F0)
                             = 273,400 Btu/day
     H(N2 in combustion air) = 2005 Ib/day  (900°F - 60°F)(0.256 Btu/lb/F0)
                             = 431,200 Btu/day

Sensible Heat of Ash

     H(Ash) = 200 Ib/day (700°F - 60°F)(0.200 Btu/lb/F0)
            = 25,600 Btu/day

Radiation and Conduction
     Determination of Radiation and Conduction losses requires  a detailed
     analysis of the actual construction and installation of the proposed
     incinerator.  For the purpose of this example the losses are assumed
     to be 2% of the total heat evolved from combustion processes.
     H(radiation and conduction) = 3,561,000 Btu/day  (0.02)
                                 = 71,200 Btu/day

Sensible Heat of Shaft Cooling Air
     Determination of shaft cooling air sensible heat and the heat availa-
     ble from recycle of cooling air required a detailed analysis of the
     actual construction and installation of the propsoed incinerator.  For
     the purposes of this example, it is assumed that 10% of the heat
     evolved from combustion is lost to shaft cooling air and that 90% of

                                    C-3

-------
     this loss is recoverable by  recycling the  shaft cooling air to"the
     process.
           H(cooling air)  = 3,561,000  Btu/day  (0.10)
                           = 356,000  Btu/day
           H(recycle)      = 356,100  Btu/day  (0.90)
                           = 320,500

Mass Balance  (w/o auxiliary fuel)
     I: puts                                               Ib/day
           Dry solids in sludge                             500
           Moisture in sludge                              2000
           Air                                             3906
           Auxiliary Fuel                                    -
           Total Inputs                                    6406
     Outputs
           Ash                                              200
           Water                                           2230
           Carbon Dioxide                                   658
           Sulfur Dioxide
           Nitrogen                                        2018
           Excess Air                                      1302
           Total Outputs                                   6408

Latent and Sensible Heat of Combustion  Products  of  Fuel (per_lb ofjfuel)

     h(H 0 produced)  = 1.08 Ib  ((212°F -  60°F)(Btu/lb/F°)
                        + 970 Btu/lb +  (900°F  -  212°F)(0.472  Btu/lb/F°)
                      = 1560 Btu
     h(CO  produced)  = 3.12 Ib  (900°F  - 60°F)(0.744  Btu/lb/F°)
                      = 639 Btu
     h(S02 produced)  = 0.030 Ib  (900°F -  60°F)(0.174 Btu/lb/F°)
                      =4.38 Btu
     h (final combustion
       product)       = 1560 Btu + 639  Btu + 4.38 Btu
                      = 2203 Btu

Sensible Heat of Excess Air and Nitrogen (per  Ib of fuel)

     h(excess air)  = 7.0 Ib  (900 F°- 60°F) (0.250 Btu/lb/F°)
                    = 1470 Btu
     h(nitrogen in
       excess air)  = 10.7 Ib  (900°F -  60°F)(0.256  Btu/lb/F°)
                    = 2340

Sensible Heat of Ash  (per Ib of fuel)
     h(Ash)         = 0.015 Ib  (900 F°- 60°F)(0.20  Btu/lb/F°)
                    =2.52 Btu

Radiation and Conduction  (per Ib of fuel)

     h(radiation and conduction)  =  (19,000 Btu) (0.02)
                                  = 380 Btu
                                   C-4

-------
Sensible Heat of Shaft Cooling Air  (per Ib of fuel)

     h(cooling air  = (19,000 Btu)(0.10)
                    = 1900 Btu
     h(recycle)     = 1900 Btu (0.90)
                    = 1710 Btu

Auxiliary Fuel Heat Available for Sludge Incineration  (per Ib of fuel)

     h(available)  = 19,000 Btu - 1560 Btu - 639 Btu - 4.38 Btu - 1470 Btu
                     - 2340 Btu - 2.52 Btu - 380 Btu - 1900 Btu + 1710 Btu
                   = 12,400 Btu/lb

The mass balance agrees within the accuracy of the assumptions.

Energy Balance (w/o auxiliary fuel)

     Inputs                                               Btu/day
           Solids Heat of Combustion                     3,561,000
           Auxiliary Fuel Heat of Combustion
           Shaft Cooling Air Recycle                       320,500
           Total Inputs                                  3,881,500
     Outputs
           Latent and Sensible Heat of Free Moisture     2,893,500
           Latent and Sensible Heat of Sludge
             Combustion Products                           469,400
           Latent and Sensible Heat of Auxiliary
             Fuel Combustion Products
           Sensible Heat of Excess Air                     273,400
           Sensible Heat of Nitrogen in Combustion
             Air                                           431,200
           Sensible Heat of Ash                             25,600
           Radiation and Conduction                         71,200
           Sensible Heat of Shaft Cooling Air              356,100
           Total Outputs                                 4,520,400
The outputs exceed the inputs by 638,900 Btu/day.  In order to maintain
the operating conditions specified for the incinerator auxiliary fuel
will be required.  Had the inputs exceeded the outputs, it would have
indicated higher operating temperatures than specified.  In order to
balance the energy balance equations, new higher outlet temperatures
would have to be specified and the energy balance recalculated.

Since in our example, auxiliary fuel is required to maintain the specified
conditions, the mass and energy balance must be recalculated to take into
consideration the effects of the auxiliary fuel added.

Ash Produced by Fuel (per Ib of fuel)
     m(Ash)  = 0.015 Ib

Fuel Combustion Reactions (per Ib of fuel)

     C + 02    = C02


                                   C-5

-------
     2H2 + 02     = 2H20
     S + O2       = SO2
     m(C in fuel)    = 0.850  Ib
     m(H in fuel)    = 0.120  Ib
     m(S in fuel)    = 0.015  lb
     B(C02 p^ucea, . 0.350  ^
              j,   J^   ^  -,™
           produced) = 0.120
                     =  3.12  Ib
                                mol.  wt.
                              (2 mol.  wt.  H2)
                     = 1.08  Ib
     m(S(X produced) = oW64 mol.  wt.  S0?)
         2                   (32 mol.  wt.  S)
                     = 0.030  Ib
     m(09 produced)  =0.850  lb<^ ^ Wt" °2)  + 0.120 Ib <32 mol.  wt. O2)
        2 c                     (12 mol. wt. C)              2(2 mol.  wt. H )
                       + 0.015 Ib  (32 mol. wt.  02)
                                   (32 mol. wt.  S)
                     = 3.24  Ib

Air Required by Auxiliary Fuel  (per  Ib of fuel)
     m (combustion air)         = — '- —   — —

                               = 14.1 Ib
     m(excess air)             =  (14.1 lb)(0.50 excess)
                               = 7.0  Ib
     m(air required)           = 14.1 Ib  + 7.0  Ib
                               = 21.1 Ib
     m(N  in combustion air)   = 14.1 Ib  - 3.24 Ib
                               = 10.9 Ib

Auxiliary Fuel Required

     M(fuel)  = 638,900 Btu/day
     M(tUei;     12,400 Btu/lb
              =52 Ib/day

The mass and energy balances  are rewritten adjusting  the figures for the
addition of 52 Ib/day of auxiliary fuel.

Mass Balance, (final)
     Inputs                                                      Ib/day
           Dry solids in sludge                                    500
           Moisture in sludge                                     2000
           Air                                                    5003
           Auxiliary Fuel                                           52
           Total Inputs                                           7555
                                   C-6

-------
Mass Balance  (final) cont.

     Outputs                                                    Ib/day
           Ash                                                    201
           Water                                                  2286
           Carbon Dioxide                                         820
           Sulfur Dioxide                                            2
           Nitrogen                                               2585
           Excess Air                                             1666
           Total Ouputs                                           7560


This agrees within the accuracy of the assumptions made.

Energy Balance (final)

     Inputs                                                    Btu/day
           Solids Heat of Combustion                           3,561,000
           Auxiliary Fuel Heat of Combustion  (Total)            988,000
           Shaft Cooling Air Recycle                            409,400
           Total Inputs                                        4,958,400
     Outputs
           Latent and Sensible Hfeat of Free Moisture          2,893,000
           Latent and Sensible Heat of Sludge
             Combustion Products                                469,400
           Latent and Sensible Heat of Auxiliary Fuel
             Combustion Products                                114,600
           Sensible Heat of Excess Air                          349,800
           Sensible Heat of Nitrogen in Combustion Air          552,900
           Sensible Heat of Ash                                  25,700
           Radiation and Conduction                              91,000
           Sensible Heat of Shaft Cooling Air                   455,000
           Total Outputs                                      4,951,900
This agrees within the accuracy of the assumptions made.
                                   C-7

-------